837af5afc14fd16f3f190a12466e2c5e84d49974
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.83"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2014
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1989 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1990 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1991 support has not been tested for some time.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2036 building process fails if it is set.
2037
2038 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2039 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2040 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2041 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2042 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2043 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2044 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2045 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2046
2047 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2048 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2049 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2050
2051
2052
2053 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2054 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2055 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2056 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2057 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2058 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2059 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2060 .code
2061 FULLECHO='' make -e
2062 .endd
2063 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2064 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2065 given in addition to the short output.
2066
2067
2068
2069 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2070 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2071 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2072 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2073 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2074 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2075 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2076 order:
2077 .display
2078 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2079 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile_&
2081 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2083 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2084 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2085 .endd
2086 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2087 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2088 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2089 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2090 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2091 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2092 and are often not needed.
2093
2094 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2095 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2096 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2097 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2098 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2099 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2100 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2101 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2102 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2103
2104
2105 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2106 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2107 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2108 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2109 default values are.
2110
2111
2112 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2113 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2114 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2115 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2116 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2117 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2118 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2119 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2120 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2121 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2122 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2123 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2124 containing the lines
2125 .code
2126 CC=cc
2127 CFLAGS=-std1
2128 .endd
2129 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2130 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2131
2132 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2133 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2134 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2135
2136
2137 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2138 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2140 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2141 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2142 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2143 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2144 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2145 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2146 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2147 .code
2148 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2149 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2150 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2151 .endd
2152 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2153 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2154 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2155 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2156 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2157 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2158 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2159 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2160 errors.
2161
2162 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2163 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2164 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2165 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2166 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2167 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2168 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2169 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2170 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2171 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2172 syntax. For instance:
2173 .code
2174 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2175 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2176 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2177 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2178 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2179 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2180 .endd
2181
2182 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2183 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2184 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2185 .code
2186 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2187 .endd
2188 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2189 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2190
2191 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2192 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2193 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2194 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2195 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2196 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2197 .code
2198 X11=/usr/X11R6
2199 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2200 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2201 .endd
2202 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2203 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2204 .code
2205 X11=/usr/openwin
2206 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2207 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2208 .endd
2209 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2210 definition of all three of these variables into your
2211 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2212
2213 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2214 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2215 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2216 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2217 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2218
2219 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2220 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2221 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2222 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2223 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2224 libraries.
2225
2226 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2227 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2228 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2229 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2230 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2231
2232
2233 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2234 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2235 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2236 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2237 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2238 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2239 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2240 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2241
2242
2243
2244 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2245 .cindex "building Eximon"
2246 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2247 where the files that are involved are
2248 .display
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2250 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2254 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2255 .endd
2256 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2257 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2259 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2260 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2261 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2262 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2263 .ecindex IIDbuex
2264
2265
2266 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2267 .cindex "installing Exim"
2268 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2269 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2270 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2271 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2272 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2273 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2274 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2275 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2276 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2277 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2278 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2279 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2280
2281 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2282 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2283 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2284 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2285 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2286 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2287 alternative files, no default is installed.
2288
2289 .cindex "system aliases file"
2290 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2291 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2292 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2293 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2294 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2295 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2296 and outputs a comment to the user.
2297
2298 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2299 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2300 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2301 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2302 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2303
2304 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2305 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2306 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2307 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2308 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2309 over SMTP.
2310
2311 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2312 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2313 command such as
2314 .code
2315 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2316 .endd
2317 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2318 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2319 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2320 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2321 but this usage is deprecated.
2322
2323 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2324 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2325 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2326 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2327 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2328 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2329
2330 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2331 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2332 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2333 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2334 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2335 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2336 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2337
2338 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2339 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2340 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2341 command:
2342 .code
2343 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2344 .endd
2345 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2346 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2347 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2348 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2349 command:
2350 .code
2351 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2352 .endd
2353 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2354 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2355
2356 .ilist
2357 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2358 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2359 .next
2360 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2361 installed binary.
2362 .endlist
2363
2364 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2365 .code
2366 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2367 .endd
2368 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2369 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2370 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2371 .code
2372 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2373 .endd
2374
2375
2376
2377 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2378 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2379 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2380 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2381 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2382 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2383
2384 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2385 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2386 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2387
2388
2389
2390 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2391 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2392 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2393 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2394 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2395 necessary.
2396
2397
2398
2399
2400 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2401 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2402 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2403 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2404 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2405 .code
2406 exim -bV
2407 .endd
2408 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2409 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2410 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2411 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2412 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2413 example,
2414 .display
2415 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2416 .endd
2417 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2418 .display
2419 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2420 .endd
2421 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2422 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2423 user agent. For example:
2424 .code
2425 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2426 From: user@your.domain.example
2427 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2428 Subject: Testing Exim
2429
2430 This is a test message.
2431 ^D
2432 .endd
2433 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2434 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2435 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2436
2437 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2438 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2439 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2440 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2441 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2442 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2443 .display
2444 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2445 .endd
2446 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2447 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2448 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2449 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2450 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2451
2452 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2453 .cindex "lock files"
2454 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2455 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2456 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2457 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2458 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2459 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2460 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2461 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2462 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2463 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2464 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2465 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2466
2467 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2468 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2469 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2470 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2471 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2472 incoming SMTP mail.
2473
2474 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2475 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2476 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2477 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2478 production version.
2479
2480
2481 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2482 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2483 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2484 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2485 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2486 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2487 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2488 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2489 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2490 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2491 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2492 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2493 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2494
2495 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2496 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2497 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2498 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2499 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2500 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2501 as follows:
2502 .code
2503 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2504 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2505 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2506 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2507 .endd
2508 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2509 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2510 favourite user agent.
2511
2512 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2513 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2514 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2515 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2516 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2517 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2518
2519
2520
2521 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2522 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2523 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2524 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2525 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2526 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2527 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2528 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2529 configuration file.
2530
2531
2532
2533
2534 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2535 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2536 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2537 .code
2538 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2539 .endd
2540 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2541 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2542 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2543 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2544 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2545 .code
2546 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2547 .endd
2548 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2549
2550 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2551 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2552 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2553
2554
2555
2556
2557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2559
2560 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2561 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2562 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2563 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2564 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2565 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2566 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2567 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2568 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2569
2570
2571 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2572 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2573 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2574 were present before any other options.
2575 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2576 standard output.
2577 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2578 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2579 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2580
2581 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2582 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2583 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2584 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2585 format.
2586
2587 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2588 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2589 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2590 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2591
2592 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2593 .cindex "queue runner"
2594 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2595 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2596 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2597
2598 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2599 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2600 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2601 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2602 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2603 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2604 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2605 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2606
2607
2608 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2609 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2610 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2611 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2612 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2613 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2614
2615 .ilist
2616 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2617 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2618 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2619 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2620 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2621 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2622
2623 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2624 .cindex "envelope sender"
2625 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2626 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2627 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2628 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2629 users to set envelope senders.
2630
2631 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2632 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2633 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2634 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2635 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2636
2637 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2638 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2639 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2640 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2641 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2642 that are available to trusted users.
2643 .next
2644 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2645 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2646 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2647 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2648 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2649
2650 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2651 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2652 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2653 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2654
2655 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2656 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2657 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2658 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2659
2660 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2661 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2662 false.
2663 .endlist
2664
2665
2666 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2667 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2668 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2669 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2675 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2676 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2677 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2678 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2679 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2680 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2681 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2682
2683 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2684 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2685 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2686 . creates a man page for the options.
2687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2688
2689 .literal xml
2690 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2691 .literal off
2692
2693
2694 .vlist
2695 .vitem &%--%&
2696 .oindex "--"
2697 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2698 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2699 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2700 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2701
2702 .vitem &%--help%&
2703 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2704 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2705 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2706 no arguments.
2707
2708 .vitem &%--version%&
2709 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2710 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2711 displayed.
2712
2713 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2714 &%-Am%&
2715 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2716 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2717 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2718 ignored by Exim.
2719
2720 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2721 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2722 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2723 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2724 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2725 clean; it ignores this option.
2726
2727 .vitem &%-bd%&
2728 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2729 .cindex "daemon"
2730 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2731 .cindex "queue runner"
2732 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2733 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2734 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2735
2736 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2737 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2738 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2739 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2740
2741 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2742 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2743 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2744 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2745
2746 When a listening daemon
2747 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2748 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2749 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2750 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2751 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2752 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2753 running as root.
2754
2755 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2756 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2757 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2758
2759 The SIGHUP signal
2760 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2761 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2762 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2763 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2764 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2765 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2766 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2767 because these are reread each time they are used.
2768
2769 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2770 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2771 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2772 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2773
2774 .vitem &%-be%&
2775 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2776 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2777 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2778 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2779 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2780 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2781 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2782
2783 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2784 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2785 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2786 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2787 test data. A line history is supported.
2788
2789 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2790 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2791 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2792 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2793 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2794 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2795 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2796
2797 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2798 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2799 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2800 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2801
2802 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2803 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2804 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2805 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2806 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2807 of a file. For example:
2808 .code
2809 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2810 .endd
2811 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2812 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2813 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2814 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2815 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2816 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2817 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2818 &%-be%&).
2819
2820 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2821 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2822 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2823 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2824 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2825 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2826 system filters are recognized.
2827
2828 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2829 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2830 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2831 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2832 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2833 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2834 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2835 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2836 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2837 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2838 supplied.
2839
2840 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2841 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2842 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2843 .code
2844 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2845 .endd
2846 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2847 variables that are used by the user filter.
2848
2849 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2850 .code
2851 # Exim filter
2852 # Sieve filter
2853 .endd
2854 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2855 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2856 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2857 redirection lists.
2858
2859 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2860 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2861 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2862 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2863
2864 When testing a filter file,
2865 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2866 .cindex "envelope sender"
2867 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2868 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2869 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2870 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2871 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2872 options).
2873
2874 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2875 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2876 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2877 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2878 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2879 &$qualify_domain$&.
2880
2881 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2882 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2883 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2884 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2885 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2886 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2887 actually being delivered.
2888
2889 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2890 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2891 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2892 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2893 prefix.
2894
2895 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2896 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2897 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2898 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2899 suffix.
2900
2901 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2902 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2903 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2904 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2905 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2906 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2907 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2908 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2909 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2910 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2911 after a full stop. For example:
2912 .code
2913 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2914 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2915 .endd
2916 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2917 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2918 conversion to the canonical form is
2919 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2920
2921 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2922 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2923 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2924 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2925 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2926
2927 &*Warning 1*&:
2928 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2929 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2930 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2931 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2932 connection.
2933
2934 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2935 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2936 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2937
2938 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2939 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2940 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2941 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2942 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2943 session were authenticated.
2944
2945 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2946 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2947 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2948
2949 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2950 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2951 specialized SMTP test program such as
2952 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2953
2954 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2955 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2956 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2957 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2958 updating the callout cache database.
2959
2960 .vitem &%-bi%&
2961 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2962 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2963 .cindex "building alias file"
2964 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2965 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2966 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2967 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2968 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2969 recognized.
2970
2971 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2972 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2973 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2974 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2975 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2976 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2977 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2978
2979 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2980 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2981 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2982 .cindex "querying exim information"
2983 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2984 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2985 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2986 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2987 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2988
2989 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2990 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2991 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2992 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2993 recognised DSCP names.
2994
2995 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2996 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2997 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2998 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2999 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3000 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3001 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3002 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3003 way to guarantee a correct response.
3004
3005 .vitem &%-bm%&
3006 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3007 .cindex "local message reception"
3008 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3009 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3010 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3011 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3012 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3013 if no other conflicting option is present.
3014
3015 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3016 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3017 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3018 suppressing this for special cases.
3019
3020 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3021 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3022
3023 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3024 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3025 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3026
3027 The format
3028 .cindex "message" "format"
3029 .cindex "format" "message"
3030 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3031 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3032 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3033 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3034 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3035 .code
3036 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3037 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3038 .endd
3039 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3040 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3041 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3042 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3043 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3044
3045 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3046 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3047 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3048 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3049 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3050
3051 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3052 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3053 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3054 .cindex "malware scan test"
3055 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3056 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3057 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3058 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3059 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3060 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3061
3062 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3063 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3064 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3065 This option requires admin privileges.
3066
3067 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3068 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3069 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3070
3071 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3072 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3073 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3074 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3075 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3076 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3077 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3078 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3079 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3080
3081 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3082 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3083 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3084 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3085 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3086
3087 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3088 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3089 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3090 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3091
3092
3093 .vitem &%-bP%&
3094 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3095 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3096 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3097 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3098 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3099 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3100 arguments, for example:
3101 .code
3102 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3103 .endd
3104 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3105 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3106 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3107 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3108 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3109 users, the output is as in this example:
3110 .code
3111 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3112 .endd
3113 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output.
3115 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3116 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3117
3118 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3119 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3120 name will not be output.
3121
3122 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3123 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3124 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3125 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3126 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3127 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3128 written directly into the spool directory.
3129
3130 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3131 .code
3132 exim -bP +local_domains
3133 .endd
3134 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3135 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3136
3137 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3138 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3140 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3141 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3142 that driver are output. For example:
3143 .code
3144 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3145 .endd
3146 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3147 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3148 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3149 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3150 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3151 &%authenticators%&.
3152
3153 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3154 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3155 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3156 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3157 The output format is one item per line.
3158
3159 .vitem &%-bp%&
3160 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3161 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3162 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3163 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3164 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3165 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3166 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3167 to allow any user to see the queue.
3168
3169 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3170 .code
3171 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3172 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3173 <other addresses>
3174 .endd
3175 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3176 .cindex "size" "of message"
3177 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3178 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3179 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3180 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3181 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3182 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3183 before the sender address.
3184
3185 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3186 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3187 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3188
3189 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3190 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3191 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3192 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3193 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3194 complete.
3195
3196
3197 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3198 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3199 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3200 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3201 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3202 of just &"D"&.
3203
3204
3205 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3206 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3207 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3208 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3209 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3210 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3211
3212
3213 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3214 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3215 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3216 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3217 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3218 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3219
3220 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3221 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3222 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3223
3224 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3225 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3226 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3227
3228
3229 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3230 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3231 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3232 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3233 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3234 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3235
3236
3237 .vitem &%-brt%&
3238 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3239 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3240 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3241 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3242 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3243 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3244 .code
3245 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3246 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3247 .endd
3248 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3249 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3250 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3251 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3252 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3253 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3254 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3255 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3256 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3257 .code
3258 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3259 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3260 .endd
3261
3262 .vitem &%-brw%&
3263 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3264 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3265 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3266 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3267 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3268 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3269 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3270 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3271
3272 .vitem &%-bS%&
3273 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3274 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3275 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3276 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3277 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3278 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3279 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3280 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3281 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3282 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3283
3284 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3285 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3286 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3287
3288 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3289 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3290 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3291 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3292
3293 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3294 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3295 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3296
3297 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3298 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3299 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3300 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3301 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3302
3303 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3304 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3305
3306 .vitem &%-bs%&
3307 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3308 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3309 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3310 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3311 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3312 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3313 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3314 messages to the MTA.
3315
3316 In
3317 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3318 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3319 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3320 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3321 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3322 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3323 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3324
3325 .cindex "inetd"
3326 The
3327 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3328 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3329 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3330 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3331 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3332 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3333 the listening daemon.
3334
3335 .vitem &%-bt%&
3336 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3337 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3338 .cindex "address" "testing"
3339 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3340 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3341 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3342 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3343 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3344
3345 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3346 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3347
3348 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3349 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3350 security issues.
3351
3352 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3353 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3354 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3355 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3356 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3357 program.
3358
3359 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3360 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3361 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3362 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3363
3364 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3365 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3366 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3367 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3368 always shown.
3369
3370 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3371 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3372 message,
3373 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3374 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3375 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3376 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3377 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3378 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3379 doing such tests.
3380
3381 .vitem &%-bV%&
3382 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3383 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3384 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3385 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3386 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3387 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3388 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3389
3390 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3391 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3392 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3393 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3394 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3395 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3396 dynamic testing facilities.
3397
3398 .vitem &%-bv%&
3399 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3400 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3401 .cindex "address" "verification"
3402 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3403 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3404 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3405 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3406 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3407 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3408
3409 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3410 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3411 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3412
3413 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3414 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3415
3416 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3417 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3418 security issues.
3419
3420 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3421 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3422 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3423 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3424 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3425
3426 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3427 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3428 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3429 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3430 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3431 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3432 to succeed.
3433
3434 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3435 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3436 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3437
3438 The
3439 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3440 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3441 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3442 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3443
3444 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3445 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3446 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3447 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3448
3449 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3450 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3451 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3452 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3453 might happen.
3454
3455 .vitem &%-bw%&
3456 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3457 .cindex "daemon"
3458 .cindex "inetd"
3459 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3460 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3461 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3462 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3463
3464 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3465 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3466 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3467 each port only when the first connection is received.
3468
3469 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3470 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3471
3472 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3473 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3474 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3475 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3476 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3477 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3478 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3479 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3480 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3481 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3482 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3483
3484 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3485 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3486 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3487 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3488 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3489 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3490 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3491 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3492 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3493
3494 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3495 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3496 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3497 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3498 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3499 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3500 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3501
3502 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3503 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3504 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3505 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3506 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3507 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3508 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3509
3510 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3511 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3512 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3513 configuration file.
3514
3515 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3516 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3517 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3518 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3519 specified by this option.
3520
3521
3522 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3523 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3524 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3525 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3526 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3527 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3528 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3529 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3530
3531 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3532 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3533 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3534 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3535 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3536 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3537 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3538
3539 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3540 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3541 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3542 synonymous:
3543 .code
3544 exim -DABC ...
3545 exim -DABC= ...
3546 .endd
3547 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3548 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3549 example:
3550 .code
3551 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3552 .endd
3553 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3554
3555
3556 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3557 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3558 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3559 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3560 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3561 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3562 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3563 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3564 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3565 return code.
3566
3567 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3568 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3569 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3570 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3571 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3572 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3573 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3574 are:
3575 .display
3576 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3577 &`auth `& authenticators
3578 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3579 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3580 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3581 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3582 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3583 &`filter `& filter handling
3584 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3585 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3586 &`ident `& ident lookup
3587 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3588 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3589 &`load `& system load checks
3590 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3591 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3592 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3593 &`memory `& memory handling
3594 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3595 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3596 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3597 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3598 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3599 &`retry `& retry handling
3600 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3601 &`route `& address routing
3602 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3603 &`tls `& TLS logic
3604 &`transport `& transports
3605 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3606 &`verify `& address verification logic
3607 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3608 .endd
3609 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3610 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3611 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3612 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3613 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3614 turn everything off.
3615
3616 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3617 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3618 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3619 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3620 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3621 rather than stderr.
3622
3623 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3624 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3625 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3626 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3627 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3628 run in parallel.
3629
3630 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3631 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3632 in processing.
3633
3634 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3635 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3636
3637 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3638 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3639 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3640 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3641 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3642 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3643
3644 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3645 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3646 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3647 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3648 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3649
3650 .vitem &%-E%&
3651 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3652 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3653 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3654 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3655 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3656 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3657 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3658 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3659 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3660
3661 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3662 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3663 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3664 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3665 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3666 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3667
3668 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3669 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3670 .cindex "sender" "name"
3671 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3672 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3673 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3674 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3675 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3676 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3677
3678 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3679 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3680 .cindex "sender" "address"
3681 .cindex "address" "sender"
3682 .cindex "trusted users"
3683 .cindex "envelope sender"
3684 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3685 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3686 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3687 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3688 users to use it.
3689
3690 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3691 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3692 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3693 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3694 domain.
3695
3696 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3697 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3698 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3699 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3700 examples of shell commands:
3701 .code
3702 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3703 exim -f "" user@domain
3704 .endd
3705 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3706 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3707 &%-bv%& options.
3708
3709 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3710 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3711 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3712 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3713
3714 White
3715 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3716 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3717 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3718 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3719 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3720 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3721
3722 .vitem &%-G%&
3723 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3724 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3725 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3726 .code
3727 control = suppress_local_fixups
3728 .endd
3729 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3730 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3731 in future.
3732
3733 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3734 this option.
3735
3736 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3737 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3738 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3739 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3740 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3741 headers.)
3742
3743 .vitem &%-i%&
3744 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3745 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3746 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3747 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3748 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3749 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3750 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3751
3752 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3753 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3754 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3755 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3756 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3757 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3758 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3759 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3760
3761 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3762
3763 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3764 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3765 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3766 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3767 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3768 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3769 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3770 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3771 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3772
3773 Retry
3774 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3775 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3776 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3777 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3778 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3779 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3780
3781 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3782 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3783 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3784 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3785
3786 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3787 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3788 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3789 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3790 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3791 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3792 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3793 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3794 can be used only by an admin user.
3795
3796 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3797 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3798 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3799 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3800 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3801 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3802 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3803 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3804 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3805 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3806 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3807
3808 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3809 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3810 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3812 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3813
3814 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3815 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3818 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3819
3820 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3821 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3824 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3825 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3826 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3827 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3828
3829 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3830 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3831 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3833 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3834 connection.
3835
3836 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3837 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3838 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3839 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3840 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3841
3842 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3843 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3844 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3845 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3846 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3847 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3848 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3849 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3850 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3851 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3852 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3853 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3854 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3855 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3856 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3857
3858 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3859 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3860 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3861 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3862 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3863 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3864 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3865 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3866 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3867 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3868
3869 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3870 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3871 .cindex "freezing messages"
3872 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3873 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3874 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3875 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3876 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3877 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3878 user.
3879
3880 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3881 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3882 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3883 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3884 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3885 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3886 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3887 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3888 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3889 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3890 user.
3891
3892 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3893 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3894 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3895 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3896 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3897 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3898 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3899
3900 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3901 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3902 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3903 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3904 .cindex "removing recipients"
3905 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3906 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3907 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3908 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3909 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3910 can be used only by an admin user.
3911
3912 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3913 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3914 .cindex "removing messages"
3915 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3916 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3917 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3918 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3919 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3920 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3921 placed on the queue.
3922
3923 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3924 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3925 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3926 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3927 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3928 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3929 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3930 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3931 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3932 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3933 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3934
3935 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3936 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3937 .cindex "thawing messages"
3938 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3939 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3940 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3941 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3942 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3943 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3944 by an admin user.
3945
3946 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3947 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3948 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3949 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3950 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3951 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3952
3953 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3954 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3955 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3956 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3957 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3958 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3959 only by an admin user.
3960
3961 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3962 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3963 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3964 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3965 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3966 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3967 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3968
3969 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3970 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3971 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3972 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3973 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3974 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3975
3976 .vitem &%-m%&
3977 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3978 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3979 treats it that way too.
3980
3981 .vitem &%-N%&
3982 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3983 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3984 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3985 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3986 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3987 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3988 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3989 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3990 than &"=>"&.
3991
3992 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3993 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3994 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3995 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3996 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3997 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3998 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3999 for that message.
4000
4001 .vitem &%-n%&
4002 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4003 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4004 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4005 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4006
4007 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4008 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4009 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4010 Exim.
4011
4012 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4013 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4014 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4015 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4016 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4017 description above.
4018
4019 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4020 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4021 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4022 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4023 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4024 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4025 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4026 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4027
4028 .vitem &%-odb%&
4029 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4030 .cindex "background delivery"
4031 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4032 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4033 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4034 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4035 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4036 processes to finish.
4037
4038 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4039 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4040 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4041 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4042
4043 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4044 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4045 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4046 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4047
4048 .vitem &%-odf%&
4049 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4050 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4051 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4052 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4053 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4054 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4055 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4056
4057 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4058 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4059 during deliveries.
4060
4061 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4062 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4063
4064 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4065 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4066 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4067 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4068
4069
4070 .vitem &%-odi%&
4071 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4072 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4073 Sendmail.
4074
4075 .vitem &%-odq%&
4076 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4077 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4078 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4079 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4080 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4081 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4082 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4083 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4084 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4085 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4086 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4087 forces queueing.
4088
4089 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4090 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4091 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4092 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4093 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4094 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4095 configuration file is in effect.
4096
4097 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4098 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4099 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4100 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4101 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4102 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4103 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4104 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4105 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4106 &%-qq%& option.
4107
4108 .vitem &%-oee%&
4109 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4110 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4111 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4112 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4113 message.
4114
4115 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4116 Provided
4117 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4118 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4119 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4120 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4121
4122 .vitem &%-oem%&
4123 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4124 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4125 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4126 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4127 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4128 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4129
4130 .vitem &%-oep%&
4131 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4132 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4133 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4134 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4135 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4136 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4137
4138 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4139 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4140 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4141 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4142 effect as &%-oep%&.
4143
4144 .vitem &%-oew%&
4145 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4146 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4147 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4148 effect as &%-oem%&.
4149
4150 .vitem &%-oi%&
4151 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4152 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4153 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4154 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4155 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4156 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4157 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4158
4159 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4160 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4161 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4162
4163 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4164 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4165 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4166 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4167 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4168 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4169 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4170 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4171
4172 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4173 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4174 .code
4175 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4176 .endd
4177 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4178 followed by a colon and the port number:
4179 .code
4180 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4181 .endd
4182 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4183 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4184 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4185 whichever one is last.
4186
4187 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4188 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4189 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4190 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4191 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4192 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4193 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4194 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4195
4196 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4197 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4198 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4199 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4200 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4201 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4202 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4203 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4204
4205 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4206 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4207 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4208 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4209 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4210 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4211 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4212 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4213 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4214 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4215
4216 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4217 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4218 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4219 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4220 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4221 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4222 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4223
4224 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4225 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4226 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4227 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4228 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4229 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4230 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4231 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4232 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4233
4234 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4235 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4236 is sending the bounce.
4237
4238 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4239 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4240 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4241 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4242 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4243 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4244 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4245 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4246 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4247 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4248 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4249 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4250
4251 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4252 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4253 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4254 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4255 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4256 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4257 uses the name it is given.
4258
4259 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4260 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4261 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4262 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4263 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4264 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4265 used, when there is no default.
4266
4267 .vitem &%-om%&
4268 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4269 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4270 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4271 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4272 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4273
4274 .vitem &%-oo%&
4275 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4276 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4277 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4278 whatever that means.
4279
4280 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4281 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4282 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4283 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4284 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4285 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4286 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4287 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4288 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4289
4290 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4291 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4292 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4293 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4294 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4295 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4296 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4297
4298 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4299 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4300 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4301 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4302 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4303 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4304 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4305 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4306
4307 .vitem &%-ov%&
4308 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4309 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4310
4311 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4312 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4313 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4314 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4315 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4316 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4317 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4318 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4319 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4320 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4321
4322 .vitem &%-pd%&
4323 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4324 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4325 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4326 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4327 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4328 needed.
4329
4330 .vitem &%-ps%&
4331 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4332 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4333 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4334 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4335 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4336 started.
4337
4338 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4339 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4340 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4341 .display
4342 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4343 .endd
4344 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4345 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4346 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4347 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4348 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4349
4350 .vitem &%-q%&
4351 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4352 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4353 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4354 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4355 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4356 and &%-S%& options).
4357
4358 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4359 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4360 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4361 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4362 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4363 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4364
4365 If
4366 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4367 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4368 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4369 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4370 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4371 proceeding.
4372
4373 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4374 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4375 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4376 this to be repeated periodically.
4377
4378 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4379 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4380 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4381 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4382
4383 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4384 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4385 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4386
4387 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4388 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4389 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4390 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4391
4392 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4393 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4394 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4395 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4396 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4397 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4398 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4399 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4400 transports are run.
4401
4402 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4403 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4404 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4405 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4406 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4407 delivered down a single SMTP
4408 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4409 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4410 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4411 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4412 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4413 intermittently.
4414
4415 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4416 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4417 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4418 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4419 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4420 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4421 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4422
4423 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4424 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4425 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4426 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4427 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4428 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4429 their retry times are tried.
4430
4431 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4432 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4433 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4434 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4435 frozen or not.
4436
4437 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4438 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4439 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4440 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4441 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4442 for later delivery.
4443
4444 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4445 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4446 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4447 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4448 starting message id. For example:
4449 .code
4450 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4451 .endd
4452 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4453 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4454 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4455 .code
4456 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4457 .endd
4458 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4459 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4460 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4461 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4462 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4463 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4464
4465 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4466 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4467 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4468 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4469 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4470 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4471 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4472 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4473 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4474 .code
4475 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4476 .endd
4477 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4478 process every 30 minutes.
4479
4480 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4481 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4482
4483 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4484 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4485 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4486 compatibility.
4487
4488 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4489 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4490 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4491
4492 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4493 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4494 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4495 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4496 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4497 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4498 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4499 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4500 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4501
4502 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4503 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4504 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4505 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4506 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4507 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4508
4509 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4510 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4511 .code
4512 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4513 .endd
4514 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4515 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4516 applied to each queue run.
4517
4518 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4519 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4520 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4521 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4522 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4523 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4524 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4525 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4526 address will be skipped.
4527
4528 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4529 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4530 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4531 &'ff'& is present.
4532
4533 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4534 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4535 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4536 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4537 an arbitrary command instead.
4538
4539 .vitem &%-r%&
4540 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4541 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4542
4543 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4544 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4545 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4546 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4547 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4548 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4549 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4550 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4551
4552 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4553 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4554 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4555 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4556 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4557
4558 .vitem &%-t%&
4559 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4560 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4561 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4562 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4563 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4564 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4565 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4566 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4567 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4568 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4569
4570 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4571 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4572 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4573 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4574 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4575 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4576 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4577 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4578 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4579 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4580 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4581
4582 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4583 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4584 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4585 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4586 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4587 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4588
4589 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4590 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4591 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4592 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4593 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4594 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4595 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4596 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4597 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4598
4599 .vitem &%-ti%&
4600 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4601 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4602 compatibility with Sendmail.
4603
4604 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4605 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4606 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4607 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4608 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4609 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4610 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4611 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4612
4613
4614 .vitem &%-U%&
4615 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4616 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4617 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4618 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4619 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4620 set. Exim ignores this option.
4621
4622 .vitem &%-v%&
4623 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4624 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4625 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4626 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4627 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4628 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4629 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4630 unconditional.
4631
4632 .vitem &%-x%&
4633 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4634 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4635 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4636 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4637 this option.
4638
4639 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4640 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4641 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4642 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4643 .endlist
4644
4645 .ecindex IIDclo1
4646 .ecindex IIDclo2
4647
4648
4649 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4650 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4651 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4652 . creates a man page for the options.
4653 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4654
4655 .literal xml
4656 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4657 .literal off
4658
4659
4660
4661
4662
4663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4665
4666
4667 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4668 "The runtime configuration file"
4669
4670 .cindex "run time configuration"
4671 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4672 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4673 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4674 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4675 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4676 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4677 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4678 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4679 control.
4680
4681 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4682 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4683 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4684 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4685 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4686 actually alter the string.
4687
4688 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4689 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4690 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4691 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4692 existing file in the list.
4693
4694 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4695 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4696 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4697 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4698 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4699 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4700 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4701 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4702 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4703 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4704 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4705
4706 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4707 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4708 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4709 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4710 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4711
4712 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4713 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4714 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4715 compromise the Exim user account.
4716
4717 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4718 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4719 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4720 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4721 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4722 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4723 configuration.
4724
4725
4726
4727 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4728 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4729 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4730 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4731 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4732 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4733 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4734 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4735 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4736 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4737 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4738
4739 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4740 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4741 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4742 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4743 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4744 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4745 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4746 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4747 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4748 &%-M%&).
4749
4750 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4751 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4752 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4753 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4754 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4755
4756 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4757 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4758 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4759 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4760 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4761 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4762
4763 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4764 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4765 necessarily be discarded.
4766 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4767 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4768 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4769 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4770 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4771 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4772
4773 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4774 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4775 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4776 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4777 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4778 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4779 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4780
4781 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4782 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4783 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4784
4785
4786
4787 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4788 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4789 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4790 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4791 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4792 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4793 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4794 optional parts are:
4795
4796 .ilist
4797 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4798 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4799 .next
4800 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4801 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4802 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4803 .next
4804 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4805 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4806 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4807 .next
4808 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4809 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4810 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4811 .next
4812 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4813 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4814 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4815 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4816 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4817 .next
4818 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4819 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4820 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4821 .next
4822 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4823 want to use this feature, you must set
4824 .code
4825 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4826 .endd
4827 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4828 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4829 .endlist
4830
4831 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4832 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4833 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4834 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4835
4836 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4837 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4838 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4839 and does not introduce a comment.
4840
4841 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4842 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4843 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4844 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4845 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4846
4847 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4848 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4849 change settings as required.
4850
4851 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4852 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4853 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4854 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4855 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4856 described.
4857
4858
4859
4860 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4861 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4862 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4863 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4864 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4865 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4866 using this syntax:
4867 .display
4868 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4869 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4870 .endd
4871 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4872 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4873 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4874 name is required.
4875
4876 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4877 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4878 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4879 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4880
4881 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4882 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4883 for example:
4884 .code
4885 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4886 .include /some/file
4887 .endd
4888 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4889 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4890 inclusion appears.
4891
4892
4893
4894 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4895 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4896 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4897 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4898 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4899 definition, and must be of the form
4900 .display
4901 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4902 .endd
4903 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4904 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4905 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4906 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4907 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4908
4909 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4910 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4911 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4912
4913 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4914 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4915 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4916 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4917 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4918 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4919 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4920 define
4921 .display
4922 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4923 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4924 .endd
4925 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4926 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4927 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4928 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4929 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4930 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4931
4932
4933 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4934 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4935 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4936 &'='&. For example:
4937 .code
4938 MAC = initial value
4939 ...
4940 MAC == updated value
4941 .endd
4942 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4943 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4944 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4945 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4946 .code
4947 MAC = initial value
4948 ...
4949 MAC == MAC and something added
4950 .endd
4951 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4952 from a number of other files.
4953
4954 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4955 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4956 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4957 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4958 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4959 file to be ignored.
4960
4961
4962
4963 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4964 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4965 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4966 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4967 .code
4968 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4969 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4970 .endd
4971 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4972 .code
4973 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4974 .endd
4975 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4976 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4977 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4978
4979
4980 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4981 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4982 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4983 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4984 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4985 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4986 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4987
4988 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4989 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4990 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4991 line. Thus:
4992 .code
4993 .ifdef AAA
4994 message_size_limit = 50M
4995 .else
4996 message_size_limit = 100M
4997 .endif
4998 .endd
4999 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
5000 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5001 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5002 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5003
5004 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5005 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5006 in this line"& will always be true.
5007
5008 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5009 to clarify complicated nestings.
5010
5011
5012
5013 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5014 .cindex "common option syntax"
5015 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5016 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5017 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5018 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5019 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5020 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5021 space) and then the value. For example:
5022 .code
5023 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5024 .endd
5025 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5026 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5027 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5028 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5029 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5030 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5031 word &"hide"&. For example:
5032 .code
5033 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5034 .endd
5035 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5036 .code
5037 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5038 .endd
5039 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5040 all instances of the same driver.
5041
5042 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5043 that are found in option settings.
5044
5045
5046 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5047 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5048 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5049 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5050 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5051 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5052 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5053 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5054 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5055 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5056 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5057 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5058 .code
5059 queue_only
5060 queue_only = true
5061 .endd
5062 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5063 .code
5064 no_queue_only
5065 queue_only = false
5066 .endd
5067 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5068
5069
5070
5071
5072 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5073 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5074 .cindex "format" "integer"
5075 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5076 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5077 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5078 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5079 hexadecimal number.
5080
5081 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5082 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5083 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5084 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5085 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5086 used.
5087
5088
5089 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5090 .cindex "integer format"
5091 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5092 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5093 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5094 Such options are always output in octal.
5095
5096
5097 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5098 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5099 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5100 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5101 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5102
5103
5104
5105 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5106 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5107 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5108 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5109 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5110
5111 .table2 30pt
5112 .irow &%s%& seconds
5113 .irow &%m%& minutes
5114 .irow &%h%& hours
5115 .irow &%d%& days
5116 .irow &%w%& weeks
5117 .endtable
5118
5119 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5120 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5121 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5122
5123
5124
5125 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5126 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5127 .cindex "format" "string"
5128 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5129 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5130 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5131 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5132 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5133 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5134 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5135 therefore equivalent:
5136 .code
5137 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5138 trusted_users = uucp:\
5139 # This comment line is ignored
5140 mail
5141 .endd
5142 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5143 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5144 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5145 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5146 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5147
5148 .table2 100pt
5149 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5150 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5151 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5152 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5153 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5154 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5155 character"
5156 .endtable
5157
5158 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5159 character, that character replaces the pair.
5160
5161 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5162 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5163 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5164 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5165 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5166 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5167
5168
5169 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5170 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5171 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5172 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5173 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5174 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5175 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5176 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5177 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5178 within a quoted configuration string.
5179
5180
5181 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5182 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5183 .cindex "format" "user name"
5184 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5185 .cindex "format" "group name"
5186 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5187 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5188 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5189 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5190
5191
5192 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5193 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5194 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5195 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5196 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5197 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5198 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5199 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5200 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5201 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5202 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5203
5204 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5205 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5206 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5207 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5208 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5209 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5210 example, the list
5211 .code
5212 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5213 .endd
5214 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5215
5216 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5217 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5218 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5219 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5220
5221 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5222 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5223 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5224 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5225 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5226 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5227 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5228 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5229 .code
5230 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5231 .endd
5232 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5233 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5234 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5235
5236 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5237 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5238 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5239 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5240 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5241 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5242 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5243 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5244 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5245 .code
5246 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5247 .endd
5248 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5249 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5250 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5251 the value in quotes. For example:
5252 .code
5253 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5254 .endd
5255 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5256 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5257 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5258 enclosing an empty list item.
5259
5260
5261
5262 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5263 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5264 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5265 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5266 .code
5267 senders = user@domain :
5268 .endd
5269 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5270 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5271 items, the second of which is empty:
5272 .code
5273 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5274 .endd
5275 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5276 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5277 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5278 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5279 .code
5280 senders = :
5281 .endd
5282 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5283 is at the end of the list.
5284
5285
5286
5287
5288 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5289 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5290 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5291 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5292 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5293 a sequence of lines like this:
5294 .display
5295 <&'instance name'&>:
5296 <&'option'&>
5297 ...
5298 <&'option'&>
5299 .endd
5300 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5301 followed by three options settings:
5302 .code
5303 localuser:
5304 driver = accept
5305 check_local_user
5306 transport = local_delivery
5307 .endd
5308 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5309 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5310 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5311 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5312 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5313 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5314
5315 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5316 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5317
5318 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5319 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5320 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5321 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5322 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5323 server.
5324
5325 .cindex "generic options"
5326 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5327 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5328 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5329 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5330 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5331 .cindex "private options"
5332 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5333 they all have default values.
5334
5335 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5336 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5337 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5338
5339 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5340 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5341 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5342 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5343 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5344 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5345 configuration lines:
5346 .code
5347 remote_smtp:
5348 driver = smtp
5349 .endd
5350 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5351 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5352 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5353 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5354 thus:
5355 .code
5356 special_smtp:
5357 driver = smtp
5358 port = 1234
5359 command_timeout = 10s
5360 .endd
5361 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5362 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5363 lines.
5364
5365 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5366 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5367 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5368 option.
5369
5370
5371
5372
5373
5374
5375 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5376 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5377
5378 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5379 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5380 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5381 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5382 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5383 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5384 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5385 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5386 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5387 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5388 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5389
5390
5391
5392 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5393 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5394 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5395 the line
5396 .code
5397 # primary_hostname =
5398 .endd
5399 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5400 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5401 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5402 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5403
5404 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5405 .code
5406 domainlist local_domains = @
5407 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5408 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5409 .endd
5410 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5411 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5412 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5413 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5414
5415 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5416 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5417 on the local host.
5418
5419 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5420 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5421 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5422 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5423 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5424 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5425
5426 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5427 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5428 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5429 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5430 domain is permitted.
5431
5432 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5433 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5434 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5435 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5436 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5437 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5438
5439 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5440 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5441 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5442
5443 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5444 .code
5445 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5446 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5447 .endd
5448 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5449 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5450 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5451 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5452 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5453 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5454 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5455 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5456 contents of a message to be checked.
5457
5458 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5459 .code
5460 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5461 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5462 .endd
5463 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5464 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5465 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5466 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5467
5468 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5469 .code
5470 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5471 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5472 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5473 .endd
5474 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5475 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5476 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5477 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5478 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5479 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5480 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5481
5482 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5483 .code
5484 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5485 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5486 .endd
5487 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5488 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5489 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5490 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5491 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5492 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5493 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5494 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5495 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5496 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5497 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5498 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5499 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5500 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5501 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5502 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5503
5504 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5505 .code
5506 # qualify_domain =
5507 # qualify_recipient =
5508 .endd
5509 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5510 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5511 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5512 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5513 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5514 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5515
5516 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5517 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5518 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5519 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5520 .code
5521 # allow_domain_literals
5522 .endd
5523 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5524 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5525 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5526 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5527 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5528 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5529
5530 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5531 .code
5532 never_users = root
5533 .endd
5534 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5535 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5536 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5537 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5538 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5539 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5540 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5541 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5542
5543 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5544 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5545 line,
5546 .code
5547 host_lookup = *
5548 .endd
5549 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5550 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5551 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5552 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5553 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5554 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5555 unreachable.
5556
5557 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5558 1413 (hence their names):
5559 .code
5560 rfc1413_hosts = *
5561 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5562 .endd
5563 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5564 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5565 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5566 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5567 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5568 information, you can change this.
5569
5570 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negociated by clients
5571 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5572 .code
5573 prdr_enable = true
5574 .endd
5575
5576 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5577 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5578 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5579 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5580 .code
5581 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5582 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5583 .endd
5584 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5585 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5586
5587 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5588 .code
5589 # percent_hack_domains =
5590 .endd
5591 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5592 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5593 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5594
5595 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5596 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5597 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5598 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5599 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5600 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5601 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5602 always bounce messages.
5603 .code
5604 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5605 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5606 .endd
5607 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5608 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5609 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5610 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5611 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5612
5613
5614
5615 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5616 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5617 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5618 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5619 It starts with the line
5620 .code
5621 begin acl
5622 .endd
5623 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5624 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5625 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5626
5627 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5628 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5629 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5630 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5631 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5632 result of the ACL processing.
5633 .code
5634 acl_check_rcpt:
5635 .endd
5636 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5637 ACL, and names it.
5638 .code
5639 accept hosts = :
5640 .endd
5641 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5642 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5643 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5644 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5645 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5646 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5647
5648 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5649 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5650 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5651 manner.
5652 .code
5653 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5654 domains = +local_domains
5655 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5656
5657 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5658 domains = !+local_domains
5659 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5660 .endd
5661 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5662 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5663 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5664 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5665 in Internet mail addresses.
5666
5667 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5668 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5669 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5670 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5671 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5672 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5673 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5674 policy of being as safe as possible.
5675
5676 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5677 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5678 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5679 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5680 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5681 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5682
5683 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5684 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5685 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5686 have to modify this rule.
5687
5688 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5689 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5690 common convention of local parts constructed as
5691 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5692 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5693 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5694 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5695 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5696 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5697
5698 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5699 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5700 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5701 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5702 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5703 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5704 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5705 .code
5706 accept local_parts = postmaster
5707 domains = +local_domains
5708 .endd
5709 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5710 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5711 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5712 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5713 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5714
5715 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5716 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5717 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5718 .code
5719 require verify = sender
5720 .endd
5721 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5722 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5723 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5724 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5725 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5726 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5727 discusses the details of address verification.
5728 .code
5729 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5730 control = submission
5731 .endd
5732 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5733 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5734 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5735 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5736 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5737 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5738 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5739 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5740 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5741 .code
5742 accept authenticated = *
5743 control = submission
5744 .endd
5745 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5746 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5747 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5748 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5749 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5750 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5751 .code
5752 require message = relay not permitted
5753 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5754 .endd
5755 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5756 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5757 .code
5758 require verify = recipient
5759 .endd
5760 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5761 fails, the address is rejected.
5762 .code
5763 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5764 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5765 # $dnslist_text
5766 # dnslists = black.list.example
5767 #
5768 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5769 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5770 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5771 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5772 .endd
5773 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5774 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5775 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5776 line.
5777 .code
5778 # require verify = csa
5779 .endd
5780 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5781 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5782 records.
5783 .code
5784 accept
5785 .endd
5786 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5787 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5788 .code
5789 acl_check_data:
5790 .endd
5791 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5792 of this ACL are commented out:
5793 .code
5794 # deny malware = *
5795 # message = This message contains a virus \
5796 # ($malware_name).
5797 .endd
5798 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5799 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5800 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5801 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5802 .code
5803 # warn spam = nobody
5804 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5805 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5806 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5807 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5808 .endd
5809 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5810 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5811 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5812 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5813 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5814 whatever the spam score.
5815 .code
5816 accept
5817 .endd
5818 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5819
5820
5821 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5822 .cindex "default" "routers"
5823 .cindex "routers" "default"
5824 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5825 by the line
5826 .code
5827 begin routers
5828 .endd
5829 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5830 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5831 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5832 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5833 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5834 .code
5835 # domain_literal:
5836 # driver = ipliteral
5837 # domains = !+local_domains
5838 # transport = remote_smtp
5839 .endd
5840 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5841 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5842 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5843 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5844 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5845 .code
5846 dnslookup:
5847 driver = dnslookup
5848 domains = ! +local_domains
5849 transport = remote_smtp
5850 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5851 no_more
5852 .endd
5853 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5854 domains. This is specified by the line
5855 .code
5856 domains = ! +local_domains
5857 .endd
5858 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5859 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5860 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5861 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5862 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5863 passed on to the following routers.
5864
5865 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5866 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5867 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5868 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5869 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5870
5871 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5872 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5873 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5874 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5875 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5876 the address fails and is bounced.
5877
5878 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5879 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5880 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5881 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5882 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5883 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5884 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5885 out.
5886 .code
5887 system_aliases:
5888 driver = redirect
5889 allow_fail
5890 allow_defer
5891 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5892 # user = exim
5893 file_transport = address_file
5894 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5895 .endd
5896 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5897 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5898 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5899 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5900 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5901 the next router.
5902
5903 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5904 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5905 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5906 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5907 .code
5908 userforward:
5909 driver = redirect
5910 check_local_user
5911 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5912 # local_part_suffix_optional
5913 file = $home/.forward
5914 # allow_filter
5915 no_verify
5916 no_expn
5917 check_ancestor
5918 file_transport = address_file
5919 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5920 reply_transport = address_reply
5921 .endd
5922 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5923 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5924 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5925 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5926 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5927 namely:
5928 .code
5929 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5930 # local_part_suffix_optional
5931 .endd
5932 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5933 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5934 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5935 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5936 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5937 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5938 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5939
5940 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5941 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5942 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5943 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5944
5945 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5946 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5947 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5948 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5949 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5950 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5951 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5952
5953 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5954 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5955 There are two reasons for doing this:
5956
5957 .olist
5958 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5959 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5960 unnecessary work.
5961 .next
5962 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5963 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5964 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5965 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5966 this time.
5967 .endlist
5968
5969 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5970 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5971 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5972 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5973
5974 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5975 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5976 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5977 .code
5978 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5979 .endd
5980 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5981 transport.
5982 .code
5983 localuser:
5984 driver = accept
5985 check_local_user
5986 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5987 # local_part_suffix_optional
5988 transport = local_delivery
5989 .endd
5990 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5991 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5992 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5993 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5994 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5995
5996
5997 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5998 .cindex "default" "transports"
5999 .cindex "transports" "default"
6000 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6001 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6002 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6003 .code
6004 begin transports
6005 .endd
6006 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6007 .code
6008 remote_smtp:
6009 driver = smtp
6010 hosts_try_prdr = *
6011 .endd
6012 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6013 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6014 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6015 It is negotiated between client and server
6016 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6017 All other options are defaulted.
6018 .code
6019 local_delivery:
6020 driver = appendfile
6021 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6022 delivery_date_add
6023 envelope_to_add
6024 return_path_add
6025 # group = mail
6026 # mode = 0660
6027 .endd
6028 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6029 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6030 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6031 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6032 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6033 show how this can be done.
6034
6035 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6036 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6037 similarly-named options above.
6038 .code
6039 address_pipe:
6040 driver = pipe
6041 return_output
6042 .endd
6043 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6044 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6045 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6046 sender.
6047 .code
6048 address_file:
6049 driver = appendfile
6050 delivery_date_add
6051 envelope_to_add
6052 return_path_add
6053 .endd
6054 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6055 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6056 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6057 .code
6058 address_reply:
6059 driver = autoreply
6060 .endd
6061 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6062 filter files.
6063
6064
6065
6066 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6067 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6068 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6069 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6070 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6071 introduced by the line
6072 .code
6073 begin retry
6074 .endd
6075 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6076 errors:
6077 .code
6078 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6079 .endd
6080 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6081 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6082 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6083 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6084
6085 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6086 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6087 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6088
6089
6090 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6091 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6092 .code
6093 begin rewrite
6094 .endd
6095 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6096 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6097
6098
6099
6100 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6101 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6102 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6103 .code
6104 begin authenticators
6105 .endd
6106 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6107 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6108 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6109 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6110 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6111 to support most MUA software.
6112
6113 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6114 .code
6115 #PLAIN:
6116 # driver = plaintext
6117 # server_set_id = $auth2
6118 # server_prompts = :
6119 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6120 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6121 .endd
6122 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6123 .code
6124 #LOGIN:
6125 # driver = plaintext
6126 # server_set_id = $auth1
6127 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6128 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6129 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6130 .endd
6131
6132 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6133 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6134 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6135 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6136 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6137 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6138 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6139 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6140
6141 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6142 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6143 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6144 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6145
6146 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6147 usercode and password are in different positions.
6148 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6149
6150 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6151
6152
6153
6154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6155 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6156
6157 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6158
6159 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6160 .cindex "PCRE"
6161 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6162 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6163 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6164 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6165 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6166 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6167
6168 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6169 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6170 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6171 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6172 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6173 case-insensitive.
6174
6175 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6176 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6177 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6178 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6179 .code
6180 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6181 .endd
6182 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6183 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6184 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6185 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6186 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6187 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6188 matched.
6189
6190 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6191 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6192 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6193 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6194 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6195 match anywhere in the subject string.
6196
6197 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6198 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6199 .code
6200 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6201 .endd
6202 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6203 You need to use:
6204 .code
6205 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6206 .endd
6207 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6208 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6209
6210
6211
6212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6214
6215 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6216 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6217 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6218 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6219 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6220 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6221
6222 .olist
6223 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6224 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6225 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6226 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6227 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6228 .next
6229 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6230 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6231 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6232 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6233 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6234 .endlist
6235
6236 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6237 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6238 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6239 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6240 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6241 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6242
6243 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6244 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6245 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6246 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6247 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6248 .code
6249 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6250 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6251 .endd
6252 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6253 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6254 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6255 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6256 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6257 .code
6258 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6259 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6260 .endd
6261 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6262 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6263
6264 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6265 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6266 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6267 .code
6268 domain1:
6269 domain2:
6270 .endd
6271 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6272 matches the list item.
6273
6274 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6275 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6276 .code
6277 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6278 .endd
6279 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6280 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6281 causes a second lookup to occur.
6282
6283 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6284 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6285 lookup is permitted.
6286
6287
6288 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6289 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6290 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6291 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6292
6293 .ilist
6294 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6295 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6296 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6297 .next
6298 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6299 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6300 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6301 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6302 .endlist
6303
6304 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6305 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6306 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6307 .code
6308 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6309 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6310 .endd
6311 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6312 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6313 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6314
6315
6316
6317
6318 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6319 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6320 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6321 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6322
6323 .ilist
6324 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6325 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6326 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6327 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6328 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6329 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6330 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6331 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6332 be found in several places:
6333 .display
6334 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6335 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6336 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6337 .endd
6338 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6339 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6340 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6341 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6342 .next
6343 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6344 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6345 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6346 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6347 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6348 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6349 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6350
6351 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6352 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6353 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6354 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6355 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6356 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6357 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6358 .next
6359 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6360 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6361 .cindex "sasldb2"
6362 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6363 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6364 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6365 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6366 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6367 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6368 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6369 .next
6370 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6371 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6372 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6373 .cindex "Courier"
6374 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6375 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6376 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6377 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6378 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6379 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6380 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6381 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6382 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6383 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6384 .next
6385 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6386 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6387 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6388 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6389 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6390 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6391 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6392 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6393 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6394 .next
6395 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6396 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6397 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6398 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6399 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6400 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6401 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6402 .code
6403 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6404 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6405 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6406 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6407 .endd
6408 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6409 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6410 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6411 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6412 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6413
6414 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6415 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6416 lookup types support only literal keys.
6417
6418 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6419 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6420 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6421 .next
6422 .cindex "linear search"
6423 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6424 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6425 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6426 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6427 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6428 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6429 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6430 in the file is used.
6431
6432 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6433 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6434 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6435 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6436 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6437 colon, for example:
6438 .code
6439 baduser: :fail:
6440 .endd
6441 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6442 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6443 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6444 wildcarding of any kind.
6445
6446 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6447 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6448 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6449 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6450 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6451 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6452 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6453 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6454 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6455
6456 .next
6457 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6458 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6459 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6460 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6461 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6462 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6463 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6464 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6465
6466 .next
6467 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6468 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6469 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6470 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6471 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6472 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6473 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6474 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6475 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6476
6477 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6478 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6479 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6480 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6481
6482 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6483 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6484
6485 .olist
6486 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6487 .code
6488 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6489 *fish data for anythingfish
6490 .endd
6491 .next
6492 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6493 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6494 .code
6495 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6496 .endd
6497 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6498 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6499 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6500 .code
6501 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6502 .endd
6503 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6504 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6505 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6506 .code
6507 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6508 .endd
6509
6510 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6511 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6512 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6513 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6514 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6515
6516 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6517 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6518 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6519 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6520 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6521
6522 .next
6523 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6524 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6525 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6526 example:
6527 .code
6528 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6529 .endd
6530 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6531 .endlist olist
6532
6533 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6534 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6535 be followed by optional colons.
6536
6537 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6538 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6539 lookup types support only literal keys.
6540 .endlist ilist
6541
6542
6543 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6544 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6545 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6546 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6547 many of them are given in later sections.
6548
6549 .ilist
6550 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6551 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6552 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6553 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6554 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6555 .next
6556 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6557 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6558 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6559 .next
6560 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6561 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6562 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6563 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6564 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6565 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6566 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6567 .next
6568 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6569 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6570 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6571 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6572 .next
6573 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6574 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6575 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6576 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6577 .next
6578 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6579 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6580 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6581 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6582 .next
6583 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6584 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6585 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6586 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6587 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6588 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6589 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6590 password value. For example:
6591 .code
6592 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6593 .endd
6594 .next
6595 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6596 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6597 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6598 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6599
6600 .next
6601 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6602 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6603 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6604 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6605
6606 .next
6607 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6608 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6609 .next
6610 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6611 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6612 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6613 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6614 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6615 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6616 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6617 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6618 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6619 .code
6620 require condition = \
6621 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6622 .endd
6623 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6624 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6625 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6626 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6627 .endlist
6628
6629
6630
6631 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6632 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6633 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6634 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6635 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6636 options such as a list of local domains.
6637
6638 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6639 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6640 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6641 or may give up altogether.
6642
6643
6644
6645 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6646 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6647 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6648 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6649 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6650 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6651 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6652 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6653
6654 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6655 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6656 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6657
6658 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6659 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6660 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6661
6662 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6663 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6664 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6665 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6666 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6667 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6668 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6669 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6670 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6671 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6672 .code
6673 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6674 .endd
6675 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6676 looks up these keys, in this order:
6677 .code
6678 jane@eyre.example
6679 *@eyre.example
6680 *
6681 .endd
6682 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6683 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6684 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6685 Exim move on to try the next key.
6686
6687
6688
6689 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6690 .cindex "partial matching"
6691 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6692 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6693 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6694 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6695 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6696 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6697 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6698 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6699 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6700 a key in a DBM file is
6701 .code
6702 *.dates.fict.example
6703 .endd
6704 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6705 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6706 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6707 file.
6708
6709 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6710 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6711 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6712
6713 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6714 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6715 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6716 partial matching keys
6717 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6718 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6719 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6720
6721 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6722 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6723 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6724 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6725 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6726 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6727 remains.
6728
6729 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6730 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6731 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6732 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6733 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6734 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6735 .code
6736 2250.dates.fict.example
6737 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6738 *.dates.fict.example
6739 *.fict.example
6740 .endd
6741 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6742 finishes.
6743
6744 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6745 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6746 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6747 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6748 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6749 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6750 .code
6751 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6752 .endd
6753 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6754 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6755 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6756 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6757 .code
6758 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6759 .endd
6760 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6761 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6762
6763 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6764 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6765 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6766
6767 .ilist
6768 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6769 .next
6770 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6771 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6772 .next
6773 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6774 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6775 for &"*"& on its own.
6776 .next
6777 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6778 .endlist
6779
6780
6781 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6782 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6783 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6784 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6785 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6786 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6787 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6788
6789 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6790 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6791 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6792 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6793 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6794
6795
6796
6797
6798 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6799 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6800 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6801 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6802 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6803 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6804 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6805
6806 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6807 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6808 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6809 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6810 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6811 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6812
6813 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6814 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6815 complete.
6816
6817
6818
6819
6820 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6821 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6822 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6823 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6824 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6825 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6826 .code
6827 [name=$local_part]
6828 .endd
6829 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6830 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6831 .code
6832 [name="$local_part"]
6833 .endd
6834 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6835 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6836 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6837 of the following form is provided:
6838 .code
6839 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6840 .endd
6841 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6842 .code
6843 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6844 .endd
6845 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6846 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6847 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6848
6849
6850
6851
6852 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6853 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6854 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6855 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6856 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6857 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6858 an expansion string could contain:
6859 .code
6860 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6861 .endd
6862 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6863 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6864 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6865 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6866
6867 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, TLSA and TXT,
6868 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6869 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6870 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6871 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6872 .code
6873 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6874 .endd
6875 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6876 altered and nothing is added.
6877
6878 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6879 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6880 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6881 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6882 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6883
6884 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6885 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6886 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6887 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6888 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6889 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6890 .code
6891 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6892 .endd
6893 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6894 white space is ignored.
6895
6896 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6897 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6898 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6899 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6900 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6901 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6902 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6903 .code
6904 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6905 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6906 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6907 .endd
6908 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6909 white space is ignored.
6910
6911 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6912 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6913 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6914 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6915 the pseudo-type MXH:
6916 .code
6917 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6918 .endd
6919 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6920 returned.
6921
6922 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6923 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6924 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6925 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6926 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6927 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6928 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6929 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6930 .code
6931 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6932 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6933 .endd
6934 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6935 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6936 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6937
6938 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6939 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6940 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6941 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6942 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6943 such a list.
6944
6945 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6946 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6947 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6948 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6949 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6950 result of a successful lookup such as:
6951 .code
6952 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6953 .endd
6954 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6955 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6956 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6957
6958 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6959 The pseudo-type A+ performs an A6 lookup (if configured) followed by an AAAA
6960 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
6961 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
6962 .code
6963 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
6964 .endd
6965
6966
6967 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6968 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6969 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6970 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6971 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6972 .code
6973 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6974 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6975 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6976 .endd
6977 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6978 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6979 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6980 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6981
6982 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6983 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6984 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6985
6986 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are givien by optional keywords,
6987 each followed by a comma,
6988 that may appear before the record type.
6989
6990 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6991 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6992 a defer-option modifier.
6993 The possible keywords are
6994 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6995 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6996 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6997 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6998 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6999 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7000 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7001 .code
7002 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7003 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7004 .endd
7005 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7006 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7007
7008 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7009 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7010 The possible keywords are
7011 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7012 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7013 with the lookup.
7014 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7015 is not labelled as authenticated data
7016 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7017 The default is &"never"&.
7018
7019 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7020
7021
7022
7023
7024 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7025 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7026 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7027 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7028 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7029 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7030 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7031 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7032 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7033 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7034 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7035 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7036 .code
7037 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7038 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7039 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7040 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7041 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7042 .endd
7043 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7044 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7045
7046 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7047 the way they handle the results of a query:
7048
7049 .ilist
7050 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7051 gives an error.
7052 .next
7053 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7054 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7055 .next
7056 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7057 from all of them are returned.
7058 .endlist
7059
7060
7061 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7062 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7063 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7064 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7065
7066
7067 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7068 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7069 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7070 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7071 .code
7072 data = ${lookup ldap \
7073 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7074 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7075 .endd
7076 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7077 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7078 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7079 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7080
7081 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7082 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7083 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7084
7085 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7086 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7087 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7088 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7089 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7090 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7091 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7092 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7093 &_exim.conf_&.
7094
7095
7096 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7097 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7098 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7099 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7100 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7101 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7102
7103 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7104 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7105 the string:
7106 .code
7107 * => \2A
7108 ( => \28
7109 ) => \29
7110 \ => \5C
7111 .endd
7112 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7113 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7114 .code
7115 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7116 .endd
7117 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7118 .code
7119 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7120 .endd
7121 yields
7122 .code
7123 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7124 .endd
7125 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7126 .code
7127 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7128 .endd
7129 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7130 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7131 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7132 .code
7133 , + " \ < > ;
7134 .endd
7135 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7136 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7137 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7138 .code
7139 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7140 .endd
7141 yields
7142 .code
7143 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7144 .endd
7145 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7146 .code
7147 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7148 .endd
7149 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7150 authentication below.
7151
7152
7153 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7154 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7155 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7156 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7157 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7158 by starting it with
7159 .code
7160 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7161 .endd
7162 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7163 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7164 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7165 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7166 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7167 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7168 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7169 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7170 failures, and timeouts.
7171
7172 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7173 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7174 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7175 doubled. For example
7176 .code
7177 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7178 .endd
7179 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7180 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7181 the local host) is used.
7182
7183 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7184 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7185 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7186 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7187 not available.
7188
7189 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7190 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7191 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7192 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7193 .code
7194 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7195 .endd
7196 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7197 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7198 .code
7199 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7200 .endd
7201 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7202 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7203 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7204 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7205 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7206 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7207 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7208 backup host.
7209
7210 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7211 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7212 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7213
7214 .ilist
7215 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7216 interface.
7217 .next
7218 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7219 .endlist
7220
7221
7222 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7223 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7224
7225
7226
7227 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7228 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7229 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7230 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7231 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7232 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7233 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7234 them. The following names are recognized:
7235 .display
7236 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7237 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7238 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7239 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7240 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7241 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7242 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7243 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7244 .endd
7245 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7246 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7247 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7248 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7249
7250 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7251 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7252 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7253 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7254 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7255 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7256 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7257 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7258 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7259
7260 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7261 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7262
7263 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7264 to use for an individual lookup. The global ldap_servers option provides a
7265 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7266 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7267 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7268 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7269 alternate list (colon-separated).
7270
7271 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7272 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7273 .code
7274 ${lookup ldap
7275 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7276 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7277 {$value}fail}
7278 .endd
7279 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7280 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7281 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7282 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7283
7284 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7285 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7286 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7287
7288 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7289 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7290 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7291 quoting has two advantages:
7292
7293 .ilist
7294 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7295 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7296 .next
7297 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7298 .endlist
7299
7300 For example, a setting such as
7301 .code
7302 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7303 .endd
7304 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7305
7306 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7307 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7308 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7309 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7310 .code
7311 PASS=${quote:$3}
7312 .endd
7313 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7314 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7315 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7316
7317
7318
7319 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7320 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7321 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7322 as a sequence of values, for example
7323 .code
7324 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7325 .endd
7326 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7327 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7328 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7329 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7330 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7331 directory.
7332
7333 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7334 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7335 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7336
7337 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7338 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7339 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7340 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7341 .new
7342 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7343 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7344 .wen
7345 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7346 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7347 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7348
7349 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7350 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7351 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7352 .code
7353 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7354 value1.1,value1.2
7355
7356 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7357 value two
7358
7359 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7360 attr1="value1.1,value1.2" attr2="value two"
7361
7362 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7363 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1.2" attr2="value two"
7364 .endd
7365 You can
7366 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7367 results of LDAP lookups.
7368 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7369 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7370 .new
7371 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7372 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7373 .wen
7374
7375
7376
7377
7378 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7379 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7380 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7381 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7382 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7383 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7384 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7385 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7386 .code
7387 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7388 .endd
7389 might return the string
7390 .code
7391 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7392 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7393 .endd
7394 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7395 .code
7396 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7397 .endd
7398 would just return
7399 .code
7400 Martin Guerre
7401 .endd
7402 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7403 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7404 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7405
7406
7407
7408 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7409 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7410 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7411 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7412 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7413 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7414 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7415 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7416 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7417 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7418 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7419 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7420 might be
7421 .code
7422 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7423 {$value}fail}
7424 .endd
7425 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7426 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7427 .code
7428 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7429 {$value}}
7430 .endd
7431 might be
7432 .code
7433 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7434 .endd
7435 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7436 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7437 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7438 .code
7439 Mister X
7440 .endd
7441 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7442 with a newline between the data for each row.
7443
7444
7445 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7446 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7447 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7448 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7449 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7450 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7451 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7452 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7453 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7454 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7455 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7456 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7457 information.
7458 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7459 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7460 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7461 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7462 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7463 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7464 .code
7465 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7466 .endd
7467 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7468 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7469 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7470 .code
7471 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7472 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7473 .endd
7474 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7475 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7476 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7477 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7478 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7479 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7480
7481 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7482 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7483 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7484 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7485 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7486 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7487 characters are not special.
7488
7489 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7490 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7491 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7492 done by starting the query with
7493 .display
7494 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7495 .endd
7496 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7497 .olist
7498 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7499 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7500 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7501 taken from there.
7502 .next
7503 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7504 .endlist
7505 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7506 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7507 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7508
7509 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7510 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7511 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7512 like this:
7513 .code
7514 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7515 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7516 master/db/name/pw
7517 .endd
7518 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7519 .code
7520 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7521 .endd
7522 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7523 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7524 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7525 .code
7526 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7527 .endd
7528
7529
7530 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7531 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7532 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7533 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7534 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7535 .display
7536 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7537 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7538 .endd
7539 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7540 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7541
7542 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7543 the queries.
7544
7545 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7546 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7547
7548 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7549 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7550 is zero because no rows are affected.
7551
7552
7553 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7554 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7555 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7556 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7557 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7558 looks like this:
7559 .code
7560 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7561 .endd
7562 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7563 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7564 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7565
7566 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7567 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7568 affected.
7569
7570 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7571 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7572 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7573 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7574 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7575 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7576 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7577 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7578 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7579 .code
7580 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7581 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7582 .endd
7583 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7584 .code
7585 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7586 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7587 .endd
7588 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7589 quote, which it doubles.
7590
7591 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7592 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7593 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7594 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7595 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7596 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7597 option.
7598 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7599 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7600
7601
7602 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7603 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7604
7605 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7606 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7607 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7608 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7609 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7610 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7611 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7612 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7613 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7614
7615 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7616 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7617 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7618 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7619
7620
7621
7622 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7623 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7624 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7625 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7626 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7627 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7628 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7629 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7630
7631
7632 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7633 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7634 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7635
7636 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7637 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7638 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7639 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7640 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7641 .code
7642 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7643 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7644 .endd
7645 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7646 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7647 senders based on the receiving domain.
7648
7649
7650
7651
7652 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7653 .cindex "list" "negation"
7654 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7655 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7656 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7657 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7658 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7659 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7660
7661 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7662 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7663 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7664 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7665 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7666 .code
7667 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7668 .endd
7669 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7670 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7671 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7672 .code
7673 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7674 .endd
7675 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7676 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7677 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7678
7679 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7680 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7681 item.
7682
7683
7684
7685 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7686 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7687 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7688 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7689 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7690 file names are not allowed,
7691 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7692 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7693 lines:
7694
7695 .ilist
7696 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7697 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7698 .next
7699 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7700 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7701 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7702 .code
7703 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7704 .endd
7705 .endlist
7706
7707 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7708 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7709 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7710 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7711
7712 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7713 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7714 .code
7715 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7716 .endd
7717 and the file contains the lines
7718 .code
7719 !a.b.c
7720 *.b.c
7721 .endd
7722 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7723 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7724
7725
7726
7727 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7728 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7729 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7730 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7731 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7732 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7733 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7734 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7735
7736 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7737 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7738 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7739 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7740
7741
7742
7743
7744 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7745 .cindex "named lists"
7746 .cindex "list" "named"
7747 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7748 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7749 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7750 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7751 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7752 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7753 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7754 .code
7755 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7756 .endd
7757 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7758 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7759 configured with the line
7760 .code
7761 domains = +local_domains
7762 .endd
7763 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7764 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7765 .code
7766 dnslookup:
7767 driver = dnslookup
7768 domains = ! +local_domains
7769 transport = remote_smtp
7770 no_more
7771 .endd
7772 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7773 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7774 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7775 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7776 .code
7777 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7778 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7779 .endd
7780 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7781 .code
7782 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7783 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7784 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7785 .endd
7786 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7787 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7788 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7789 .code
7790 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7791 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7792 .endd
7793 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7794 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7795 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7796 .code
7797 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7798 .endd
7799 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7800 referenced lists if you can.
7801
7802 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7803 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7804 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7805 .code
7806 domains = +local_domains
7807 .endd
7808 on several of your routers
7809 or in several ACL statements,
7810 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7811 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7812 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7813 the same each time they are referenced.
7814
7815 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7816 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7817 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7818 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7819
7820
7821
7822 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7823 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7824 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7825 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7826 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7827 write
7828 .code
7829 ALIST = host1 : host2
7830 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7831 .endd
7832 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7833 .code
7834 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7835 .endd
7836 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7837 list, and write
7838 .code
7839 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7840 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7841 .endd
7842 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7843 .code
7844 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7845 .endd
7846
7847
7848 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7849 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7850 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7851 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7852 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7853 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7854 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7855 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7856 message. For example:
7857 .code
7858 domainlist special_domains = \
7859 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7860 .endd
7861 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7862 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7863 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7864 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7865 same list each time.
7866
7867 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7868 cache the result anyway. For example:
7869 .code
7870 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7871 .endd
7872 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7873 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7874
7875
7876
7877 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7878 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7879 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7880 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7881 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7882
7883 .ilist
7884 .cindex "primary host name"
7885 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7886 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7887 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7888 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7889 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7890 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7891 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7892 differ only in their names.
7893 .next
7894 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7895 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7896 .cindex "domain literal"
7897 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7898 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7899 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7900 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7901 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7902 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7903 .next
7904 .cindex "@mx_any"
7905 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7906 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7907 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7908 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7909 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7910 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7911 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7912 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7913 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7914 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7915 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7916
7917 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7918 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7919 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7920 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7921 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7922
7923 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7924 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7925 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7926 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7927 on a router). For example:
7928 .code
7929 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7930 .endd
7931 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7932 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7933
7934 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7935 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7936 contain negative items.
7937
7938 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7939 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7940 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7941 .code
7942 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7943 an.other.domain : ...
7944 .endd
7945 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7946 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7947 .code
7948 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7949 an.other.domain ? ...
7950 .endd
7951 .next
7952 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7953 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7954 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7955 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7956 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7957 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7958 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7959 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7960 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7961 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
7962
7963 .next
7964 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7965 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7966 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7967 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7968 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7969 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7970 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7971 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7972 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7973
7974 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7975 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7976 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7977 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7978 expression by expansion, of course).
7979 .next
7980 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7981 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7982 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7983 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7984 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7985 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7986 .code
7987 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7988 .endd
7989 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7990 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7991 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7992 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7993 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7994 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7995 other statements in the same ACL.
7996
7997 .next
7998 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7999 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8000 .code
8001 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8002 .endd
8003 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8004 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8005
8006 .next
8007 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8008 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8009 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8010 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8011 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8012 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8013 expansion variable.
8014 .next
8015 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8016 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8017 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8018 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8019 .code
8020 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8021 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8022 .endd
8023 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8024 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8025 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8026 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8027 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8028 .next
8029 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8030 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8031 between the pattern and the domain.
8032 .endlist
8033
8034 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8035 .code
8036 domainlist funny_domains = \
8037 @ : \
8038 lib.unseen.edu : \
8039 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8040 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8041 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8042 nis;domains.byname : \
8043 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8044 .endd
8045 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8046 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8047 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8048 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8049 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8050 patterns earlier.
8051
8052
8053
8054 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8055 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8056 .cindex "list" "host list"
8057 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8058 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8059 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8060 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8061 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8062 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8063 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8064
8065
8066 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8067 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8068 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8069 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8070 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8071 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8072 not used.
8073
8074 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8075 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8076 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8077
8078
8079
8080 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8081 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8082 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8083 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8084 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8085 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8086 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8087 concerns.)
8088
8089 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8090 inspecting its IP address:
8091
8092 .ilist
8093 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8094 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8095 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8096 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8097 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8098 with the IP address of the subject host.
8099
8100 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8101 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8102 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8103 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8104 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8105
8106 .next
8107 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8108 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8109 domain name, as just described.
8110
8111 .next
8112 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8113 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8114 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8115 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8116 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8117 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8118 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8119 that can never match a client host.
8120
8121 .next
8122 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8123 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8124 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8125 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8126 .code
8127 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8128 accept hosts = @[]
8129 .endd
8130 .next
8131 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8132 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8133 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8134 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8135 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8136 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8137 significant end of the address.
8138
8139 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8140 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8141 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8142 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8143 .code
8144 192.168.23.236/31
8145 .endd
8146 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8147 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8148 matches.
8149
8150 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8151 .code
8152 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8153 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8154 .endd
8155 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8156 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8157 For example:
8158 .code
8159 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8160 .endd
8161 could make use of a file containing
8162 .code
8163 172.16.0.0/12
8164 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8165 .endd
8166 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8167 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8168 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8169 .code
8170 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8171 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8172 .endd
8173 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8174 list.
8175 .endlist
8176
8177
8178
8179 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8180 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8181 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8182 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8183 address, the pattern takes this form:
8184 .display
8185 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8186 .endd
8187 For example:
8188 .code
8189 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8190 .endd
8191 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8192 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8193 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8194 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8195 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8196 returned by the lookup is not used.
8197
8198 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8199 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8200 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8201 patterns of this form:
8202 .display
8203 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8204 .endd
8205 For example:
8206 .code
8207 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8208 .endd
8209 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8210 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8211 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8212 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8213 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8214
8215 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8216 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8217 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8218 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8219 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8220 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8221 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8222 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8223 addresses are always used.
8224
8225 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8226 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8227 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8228 configurations.
8229
8230 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8231 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8232 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8233 case the IP address is used on its own.
8234
8235
8236
8237 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8238 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8239 .cindex "unknown host name"
8240 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8241 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8242 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8243 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8244 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8245 above.)
8246
8247 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8248 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8249 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8250 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8251 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8252 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8253 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8254
8255 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8256 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8257
8258 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8259 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8260 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8261 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8262 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8263 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8264 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8265 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8266 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8267
8268 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8269 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8270
8271 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8272 .cindex "alias for host"
8273 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8274 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8275
8276 .ilist
8277 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8278 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8279 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8280 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8281 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8282 expression.
8283 .next
8284 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8285 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8286 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8287 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8288 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8289 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8290 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8291 example,
8292 .code
8293 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8294 .endd
8295 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8296 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8297 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8298 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8299 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8300 .code
8301 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8302 .endd
8303 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8304 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8305 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8306 required.
8307 .endlist
8308
8309
8310
8311
8312 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8313 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8314 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8315 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8316 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8317 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8318
8319 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8320 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8321
8322 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8323 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8324 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8325 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8326 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8327 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8328 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8329 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8330 not recognized in an indirected file).
8331
8332 .ilist
8333 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8334 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8335 .code
8336 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8337 .endd
8338 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8339 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8340
8341 .next
8342 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8343 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8344 example:
8345 .code
8346 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8347 192.168.4.5
8348 .endd
8349 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8350 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8351 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8352 .endlist
8353
8354 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8355 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8356 list.
8357
8358 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8359 "SECTmixwilhos"
8360 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8361
8362 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8363 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8364 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8365
8366 .ilist
8367 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8368 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8369 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8370 .code
8371 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8372 .endd
8373 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8374 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8375 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8376 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8377 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8378 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8379 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8380
8381 .next
8382 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8383 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8384 .code
8385 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8386 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8387 .endd
8388 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8389 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8390 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8391 this section.
8392 .endlist
8393
8394
8395 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8396 "SECTtemdnserr"
8397 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8398 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8399 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8400 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8401 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8402 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8403 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8404 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8405 host lists such as whitelists.
8406
8407
8408
8409 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8410 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8411 .cindex "unknown host name"
8412 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8413 If a pattern is of the form
8414 .display
8415 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8416 .endd
8417 for example
8418 .code
8419 dbm;/host/accept/list
8420 .endd
8421 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8422 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8423 is not used.
8424
8425 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8426 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8427 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8428 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8429 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8430 lookup, both using the same file.
8431
8432
8433
8434 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8435 If a pattern is of the form
8436 .display
8437 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8438 .endd
8439 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8440 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8441 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8442 .code
8443 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8444 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8445 .endd
8446 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8447 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8448 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8449 operator.
8450
8451 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8452 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8453 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8454
8455 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8456 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8457 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8458 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8459 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8460 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8461
8462
8463
8464
8465
8466 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8467 .cindex "list" "address list"
8468 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8469 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8470 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8471 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8472 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8473 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8474 using this option setting:
8475 .code
8476 senders = :
8477 .endd
8478 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8479 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8480 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8481 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8482
8483 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8484 example:
8485 .code
8486 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8487 .endd
8488 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8489 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8490 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8491 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8492 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8493 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8494 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8495 .code
8496 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8497 *@+hostile_domains:\
8498 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8499 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8500 .endd
8501 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8502 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8503 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8504 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8505 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8506
8507 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8508 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8509 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8510 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8511 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8512 .code
8513 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8514 .endd
8515
8516 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8517 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8518 senders:
8519
8520 .ilist
8521 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8522 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8523 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8524 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8525 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8526 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8527 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8528 .code
8529 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8530 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8531 .endd
8532 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8533 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8534
8535 .next
8536 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8537 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8538 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8539 example:
8540 .code
8541 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8542 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8543 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8544 .endd
8545 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8546 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8547 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8548 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8549
8550 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8551 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8552 panic log.
8553 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8554 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8555 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8556 default. For example, with this lookup:
8557 .code
8558 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8559 .endd
8560 the file could contains lines like this:
8561 .code
8562 user1@domain1.example
8563 *@domain2.example
8564 .endd
8565 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8566 that are tried is:
8567 .code
8568 nimrod@jaeger.example
8569 *@jaeger.example
8570 *
8571 .endd
8572 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8573 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8574
8575 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8576 .code
8577 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8578 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8579 .endd
8580 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8581 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8582 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8583 .endlist
8584
8585
8586 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8587 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8588 always fails.
8589
8590
8591 .ilist
8592 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8593 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8594 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8595 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8596 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8597 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8598 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8599 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8600 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8601
8602 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8603 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8604 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8605 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8606 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8607 with
8608 .code
8609 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8610 .endd
8611 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8612 .code
8613 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8614 .endd
8615 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8616
8617 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8618 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8619 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8620 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8621 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8622 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8623 .code
8624 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8625 spammer3 : spammer4
8626 .endd
8627 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8628 doubling.
8629
8630 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8631 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8632 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8633 might have entries like
8634 .code
8635 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8636 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8637 *: ^\d{8}$
8638 .endd
8639 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8640 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8641 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8642 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8643
8644 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8645 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8646 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8647
8648 .next
8649 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8650 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8651 can only return a single list of local parts.
8652 .endlist
8653
8654 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8655 in these two examples:
8656 .code
8657 senders = +my_list
8658 senders = *@+my_list
8659 .endd
8660 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8661 example it is a named domain list.
8662
8663
8664
8665
8666 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8667 .cindex "case of local parts"
8668 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8669 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8670 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8671 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8672 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8673 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8674 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8675 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8676 default.
8677
8678 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8679 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8680 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8681 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8682 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8683 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8684 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8685 case-independent.
8686
8687 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8688 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8689 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8690 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8691 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8692 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8693 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8694 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8695
8696
8697
8698 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8699 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8700 .cindex "local part" "list"
8701 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8702 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8703 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8704 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8705 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8706 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8707 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8708 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8709
8710 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8711 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8712 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8713 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8714 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8715 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8716 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8717 types.
8718 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8719
8720
8721
8722
8723 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8724 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8725
8726 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8727 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8728 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8729 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8730
8731 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8732 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8733 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8734 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8735 escape character, as described in the following section.
8736
8737 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8738 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8739 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8740 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8741 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8742 reasons.
8743
8744
8745
8746 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8747 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8748 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8749 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8750 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8751 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8752 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8753 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8754
8755 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8756 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8757 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8758 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8759 .code
8760 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8761 .endd
8762 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8763 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8764 string.
8765
8766
8767
8768 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8769 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8770 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8771 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8772 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8773 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8774 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8775 encoding.
8776
8777 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8778 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8779 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8780
8781
8782 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8783 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8784 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8785 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8786 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8787 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8788 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8789 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8790 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8791 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8792 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8793 and &%nhash%&.
8794
8795 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8796 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8797 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8798
8799 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8800 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8801 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8802 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8803 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8804 .code
8805 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8806 .endd
8807 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8808 Exim message identifier. For example:
8809 .code
8810 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8811 .endd
8812 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8813 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8814
8815
8816 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8817 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8818 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8819 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8820 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8821 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8822 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8823 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8824 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8825 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8826 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8827 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8828 being expanded.
8829
8830
8831
8832
8833 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8834 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8835 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8836 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8837 white space is significant.
8838
8839 .vlist
8840 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8841 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8842 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8843 .code
8844 $local_part
8845 ${domain}
8846 .endd
8847 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8848 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8849 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8850 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8851 given, the expansion fails.
8852
8853 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8854 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8855 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8856 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8857 .code
8858 ${lc:$local_part}
8859 .endd
8860 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8861 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8862 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8863 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8864 string easier to understand.
8865
8866 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8867 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8868 expansion item below.
8869
8870
8871 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8872 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8873 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8874 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8875 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8876 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8877 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8878 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8879 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8880 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8881 the result of the expansion.
8882 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8883 the expansion result is an empty string.
8884 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8885
8886
8887 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8888 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8889 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8890 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8891 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8892 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8893 The field name is expanded and used to retrive the relevant field from
8894 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8895 .display
8896 &`version `&
8897 &`serial_number `&
8898 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8899 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8900 &`notbefore `& time
8901 &`notafter `& time
8902 &`sig_algorithm `&
8903 &`signature `&
8904 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8905 &`ocsp_uri `& list
8906 &`crl_uri `& list
8907 .endd
8908 If the field is found,
8909 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8910 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8911 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8912 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8913
8914 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8915 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8916 extracted is used.
8917
8918 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8919
8920 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8921 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8922 not quite
8923 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8924 (the exceptions being elements containin commas).
8925 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8926 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8927 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8928 The separator may be changed by another modifer of
8929 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8930 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8931
8932 The field selectors marked as "time" above
8933 may output a number of seconds since epoch
8934 if the modifier "int" is used.
8935
8936 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
8937 newline-separated by default,
8938 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
8939 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
8940 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8941
8942 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
8943 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
8944 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
8945 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
8946 if so the elenment tags are omitted.
8947
8948 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
8949
8950 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8951 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8952 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
8953 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8954 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8955 .code
8956 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8957 .endd
8958 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8959 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8960 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8961
8962 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8963 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8964 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8965 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8966 must have the following type:
8967 .code
8968 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8969 .endd
8970 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8971 function should return one of the following values:
8972
8973 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8974 into the expanded string that is being built.
8975
8976 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8977 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8978
8979 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8980 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8981
8982 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8983
8984 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8985 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8986 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8987
8988 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8989 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8990 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8991 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8992 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8993 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8994 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8995 form:
8996 .display
8997 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8998 .endd
8999 .vindex "&$value$&"
9000 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9001 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9002 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9003 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9004 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9005 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9006 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9007 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9008 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9009
9010 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9011 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9012 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9013 yield &"2001"&:
9014 .code
9015 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9016 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9017 .endd
9018 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9019 appear, for example:
9020 .code
9021 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9022 .endd
9023 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9024 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9025
9026
9027 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9028 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9029 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9030 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9031 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9032 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9033 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9034 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9035 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9036 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9037 <&'string3'&> as before.
9038
9039 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9040 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9041 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9042 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9043 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9044 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9045 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9046 provided. For example:
9047 .code
9048 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9049 .endd
9050 yields &"42"&, and
9051 .code
9052 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9053 .endd
9054 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9055 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9056
9057
9058 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9059 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9060 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9061 .vindex "&$item$&"
9062 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9063 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9064 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9065 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9066 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9067 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9068 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9069 .code
9070 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9071 .endd
9072 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9073 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9074
9075
9076 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9077 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9078 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9079 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9080 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9081 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9082
9083 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9084 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9085 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9086 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9087 .code
9088 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9089 .endd
9090 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9091 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9092 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9093 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9094 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9095 .code
9096 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9097 .endd
9098 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9099 letters appear. For example:
9100 .display
9101 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9102 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9103 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9104 .endd
9105
9106 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9107 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9108 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9109 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9110 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9111 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9112 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9113 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9114 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9115 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9116 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9117 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9118 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9119 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9120 .code
9121 $header_reply-to:
9122 .endd
9123 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9124 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9125 lines) may be present.
9126
9127 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9128 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9129
9130 .ilist
9131 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9132 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9133 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9134
9135 .next
9136 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9137 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9138 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9139 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9140 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9141 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9142 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9143 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9144
9145 .next
9146 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9147 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9148 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9149 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9150 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9151 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9152 .endlist ilist
9153
9154 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9155 command of the following form:
9156 .code
9157 headers charset "UTF-8"
9158 .endd
9159 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9160 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9161 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9162 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9163 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9164 ISO-8859-1.
9165
9166 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9167 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9168 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9169 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9170
9171 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9172 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9173 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9174 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9175 router or transport are not accessible.
9176
9177 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9178 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9179 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9180 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9181 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9182 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9183
9184 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9185 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9186 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9187 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9188 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9189 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9190 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9191
9192 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9193 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9194 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9195 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9196 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9197 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9198 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9199 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9200
9201
9202 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9203 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9204 .cindex &%hmac%&
9205 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9206 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9207 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9208 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9209 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9210 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9211 present. For example:
9212 .code
9213 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9214 .endd
9215 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9216 produces:
9217 .code
9218 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9219 .endd
9220 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9221 an Exim configuration:
9222 .code
9223 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9224 .endd
9225 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9226 .code
9227 headers_add = \
9228 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9229 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9230 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9231 .endd
9232 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9233 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9234 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9235 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9236 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9237 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9238
9239
9240 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9241 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9242 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9243 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9244 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9245 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9246 .code
9247 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9248 .endd
9249 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9250 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9251 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9252 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9253 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9254
9255 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9256 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9257 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9258 .code
9259 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9260 .endd
9261 you can use
9262 .code
9263 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9264 .endd
9265
9266 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9267 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9268 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9269 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9270 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9271 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9272 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9273 some of the braces:
9274 .code
9275 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9276 .endd
9277 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9278 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9279 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9280
9281
9282 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9283 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9284 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9285 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9286 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9287 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9288 apart from an optional leading minus,
9289 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9290
9291 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9292 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9293
9294 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9295 If the number is negative, the fields are
9296 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9297 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9298 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9299
9300 If the modulus of the
9301 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9302 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9303
9304 For example:
9305 .code
9306 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9307 .endd
9308 yields &"42"&, and
9309 .code
9310 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9311 .endd
9312 yields &"result: 99"&.
9313
9314 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9315 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9316 extracted is used.
9317 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9318
9319
9320 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9321 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9322 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9323 described in the next item.
9324
9325 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9326 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9327 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9328 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9329 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9330 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9331 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9332 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9333 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9334
9335 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9336 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9337 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9338 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9339 out by the system administrator.
9340
9341 .vindex "&$value$&"
9342 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9343 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9344 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9345 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9346 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9347 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9348 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9349 original lookup fails.
9350
9351 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9352 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9353 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9354 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9355 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9356 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9357 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9358 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9359
9360 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9361 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9362 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9363 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9364
9365 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9366 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9367 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9368 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9369
9370 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9371 .code
9372 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9373 .endd
9374 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9375 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9376 .code
9377 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9378 {$value}fail}
9379 .endd
9380
9381
9382 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9383 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9384 .vindex "&$item$&"
9385 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9386 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9387 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9388 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9389 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9390 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9391 .code
9392 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9393 .endd
9394 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9395 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9396 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9397
9398 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9399 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9400 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9401 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9402 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9403 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9404 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9405 .code
9406 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9407 .endd
9408 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9409 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9410 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9411 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9412 example,
9413 .code
9414 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9415 .endd
9416 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9417
9418
9419
9420 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9421 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9422 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9423 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9424 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9425 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9426 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9427 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9428
9429 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9430 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9431 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9432 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9433 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9434 not its contents.
9435
9436 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9437 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9438 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9439
9440 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9441 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9442
9443
9444 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9445 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9446 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9447 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9448 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9449 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9450 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9451 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9452
9453 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9454 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9455 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9456 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9457 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9458 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9459 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9460 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9461 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9462 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9463
9464 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9465 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9466 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9467 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9468
9469 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9470 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9471 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9472 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9473 is the expansion of the third argument.
9474
9475 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9476 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9477 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9478
9479 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9480 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9481 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9482 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9483 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9484 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9485 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9486 newlines are left in the string.
9487 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9488 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9489 the string expansion fails.
9490
9491 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9492 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9493
9494
9495
9496 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9497 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9498 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9499 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9500 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9501 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9502 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9503 examples:
9504 .code
9505 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9506 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9507 .endd
9508 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9509 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9510 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9511 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9512 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9513 example:
9514 .code
9515 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9516 .endd
9517 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9518 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9519 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9520 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9521 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9522 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9523 .code
9524 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9525 .endd
9526 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9527 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9528 turns them into spaces:
9529 .code
9530 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9531 .endd
9532 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9533 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9534 addition, the following errors can occur:
9535
9536 .ilist
9537 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9538 .next
9539 Failure to connect the socket;
9540 .next
9541 Failure to write the request string;
9542 .next
9543 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9544 .endlist
9545
9546 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9547 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9548 errors occurs. For example:
9549 .code
9550 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9551 {socket failure}}
9552 .endd
9553 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9554 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9555 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9556 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9557 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9558
9559 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9560 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9561
9562
9563 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9564 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9565 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9566 .vindex "&$value$&"
9567 .vindex "&$item$&"
9568 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9569 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9570 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9571 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9572 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9573 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9574 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9575 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9576 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9577 .code
9578 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9579 .endd
9580 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9581 can be found:
9582 .code
9583 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9584 .endd
9585 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9586 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9587 expansion items.
9588
9589 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9590 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9591 expansion item above.
9592
9593 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9594 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9595 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9596 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9597 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9598 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9599 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9600 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9601 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9602
9603 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9604 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9605 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9606 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9607 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9608 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9609 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9610 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9611 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9612 character.
9613
9614 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9615 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9616 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9617 .vindex "&$value$&"
9618 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9619 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9620 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9621 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9622 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9623 &$value$&.
9624
9625 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9626 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9627 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9628 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9629
9630 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9631 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9632 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9633 troubleshoot:
9634 .code
9635 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9636 log_message = Output of id: $value
9637 .endd
9638 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9639 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9640 .code
9641 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9642 .endd
9643
9644 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9645 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9646 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9647 .code
9648 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9649 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9650 ...
9651 endif
9652 .endd
9653 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9654 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9655 commands.
9656
9657 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9658 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9659 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9660 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9661
9662 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9663 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9664
9665
9666 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9667 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9668 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9669 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9670 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9671 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9672 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9673 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9674 .code
9675 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9676 .endd
9677 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9678 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9679 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9680 .code
9681 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9682 .endd
9683 yields &"defabc"&, and
9684 .code
9685 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9686 .endd
9687 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9688 the regular expression from string expansion.
9689
9690
9691
9692 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9693 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9694 .cindex "substring extraction"
9695 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9696 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9697 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9698 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9699 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9700 .code
9701 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9702 .endd
9703 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9704 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9705 omitted.
9706
9707 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9708 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9709 length required. For example
9710 .code
9711 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9712 .endd
9713 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9714 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9715 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9716 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9717
9718 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9719 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9720 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9721 .code
9722 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9723 .endd
9724 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9725 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9726 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9727 .code
9728 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9729 .endd
9730 yields an empty string, but
9731 .code
9732 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9733 .endd
9734 yields &"1"&.
9735
9736 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9737 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9738 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9739 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9740 .code
9741 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9742 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9743 .endd
9744 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9745
9746
9747
9748 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9749 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9750 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9751 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9752 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9753 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9754 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9755 replacement list. For example
9756 .code
9757 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9758 .endd
9759 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9760 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9761 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9762 place.
9763 .endlist
9764
9765
9766
9767 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9768 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9769 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9770 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9771 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9772 following operations can be performed:
9773
9774 .vlist
9775 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9776 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9777 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9778 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9779 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9780 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9781
9782
9783 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9784 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9785 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9786 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9787 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9788 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9789 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9790 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9791 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9792
9793 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9794 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9795 character. For example:
9796 .code
9797 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9798 .endd
9799 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9800 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9801 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9802 processing lists.
9803
9804 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9805 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9806 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9807 email address seperator. For the example header line:
9808 .code
9809 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9810 .endd
9811 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9812 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9813 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9814 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9815 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9816 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9817 quoted.
9818 .code
9819 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9820 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9821 user@example.com
9822 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9823 Last:user@example.com
9824 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9825 user@example.com
9826 .endd
9827
9828 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9829 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9830 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9831 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9832 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9833 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9834 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9835 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9836 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9837
9838 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9839 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9840 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9841 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9842 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9843 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9844 string.
9845
9846
9847 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9848 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9849 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9850 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9851 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9852
9853
9854 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9855 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9856 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9857 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9858 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9859 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9860 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9861
9862
9863 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9864 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9865 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9866 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9867 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9868 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9869 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9870 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9871 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9872 C programming language):
9873 .table2 70pt 300pt
9874 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9875 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9876 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9877 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9878 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9879 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9880 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9881 .endtable
9882 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9883 space is permitted before or after operators.
9884
9885 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9886 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9887 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9888 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9889 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9890
9891 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9892 or 1024*1024*1024,
9893 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9894 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9895
9896 .display
9897 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9898 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9899 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9900 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9901 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9902 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9903 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9904 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9905 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9906 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9907 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9908 .endd
9909
9910 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9911 .code
9912 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9913 condition = \
9914 ${if and { \
9915 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9916 { \
9917 < \
9918 {$recipients_count} \
9919 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9920 } \
9921 }{yes}{no}}
9922 .endd
9923 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9924 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9925
9926
9927 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9928 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9929 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9930 example,
9931 .code
9932 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9933 .endd
9934 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9935 and then re-expands what it has found.
9936
9937
9938 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9939 .cindex "Unicode"
9940 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9941 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9942 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9943 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9944 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9945 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9946 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9947 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9948 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9949
9950 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9951 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9952 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9953 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9954 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9955 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9956 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9957
9958
9959 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9960 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9961 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9962 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9963 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9964 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9965 .code
9966 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9967 .endd
9968 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9969 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9970
9971
9972
9973 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9974 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9975 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9976 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9977 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9978 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9979
9980
9981
9982 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9983 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
9984 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
9985 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
9986 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
9987 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
9988 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
9989
9990
9991 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9992 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9993 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9994 .cindex "lower casing"
9995 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9996 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9997 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9998 .code
9999 ${lc:$local_part}
10000 .endd
10001
10002 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10003 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10004 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10005 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10006 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10007 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10008 .code
10009 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10010 .endd
10011 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10012 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10013 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10014
10015
10016 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10017 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10018 .cindex "list" "item count"
10019 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10020 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10021 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10022
10023
10024 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10025 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10026 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10027 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10028 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10029 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10030 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10031 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10032 matching list is returned.
10033
10034
10035 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10036 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10037 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10038 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10039 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10040 empty.
10041
10042
10043 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10044 .cindex "masked IP address"
10045 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10046 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10047 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10048 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10049 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10050 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10051 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10052 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10053 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10054 .code
10055 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10056 .endd
10057 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10058 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10059 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10060 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10061 .code
10062 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10063 .endd
10064 returns the string
10065 .code
10066 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10067 .endd
10068 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10069
10070
10071 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10072 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10073 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10074 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10075 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10076 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10077 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10078
10079
10080 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10081 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10082 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10083 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10084 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10085 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10086 .code
10087 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10088 .endd
10089 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10090
10091
10092 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10093 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10094 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10095 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10096 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10097 is an empty string or
10098 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10099 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10100 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10101 respectively For example,
10102 .code
10103 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10104 .endd
10105 becomes
10106 .code
10107 "ab\"*\"cd"
10108 .endd
10109 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10110 variable or a message header.
10111
10112 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10113 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10114 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10115 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10116 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10117 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10118 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10119
10120
10121 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10122 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10123 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10124 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10125 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10126 .code
10127 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10128 .endd
10129 returns
10130 .code
10131 two%20%5C2A%20two
10132 .endd
10133 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10134 yields an unchanged string.
10135
10136
10137 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10138 .cindex "random number"
10139 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10140 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10141 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10142 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10143 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10144 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10145 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10146 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10147 random().
10148
10149
10150 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10151 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10152 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10153 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10154 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10155 for DNS. For example,
10156 .code
10157 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10158 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10159 .endd
10160 returns
10161 .code
10162 4.2.0.192
10163 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10164 .endd
10165
10166
10167 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10168 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10169 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10170 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10171 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10172 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10173 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10174 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10175 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10176 characters
10177 .code
10178 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10179 .endd
10180 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10181 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10182 characters.
10183
10184
10185 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10186 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10187 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10188 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10189 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10190 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10191 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10192 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10193
10194 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10195 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10196 to use this operator as well.
10197
10198
10199
10200 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10201 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10202 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10203 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10204 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10205 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10206 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10207
10208
10209 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10210 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10211 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10212 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10213 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10214 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10215 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10216
10217
10218 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10219 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10220 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10221 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10222 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10223 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10224 certificate,
10225 and returns
10226 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10227 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10228
10229
10230 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10231 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10232 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10233 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10234 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10235 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10236 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10237 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10238 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10239 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10240 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10241 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10242 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10243
10244 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10245 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10246 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10247
10248 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10249 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10250 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10251 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10252 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10253
10254
10255
10256 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10257 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10258 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10259 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10260 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10261 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10262
10263
10264 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10265 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10266 .cindex "substring extraction"
10267 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10268 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10269 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10270 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10271 .code
10272 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10273 .endd
10274 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10275 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10276
10277 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10278 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10279 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10280 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10281 seconds.
10282
10283 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10284 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10285 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10286 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10287 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10288 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10289 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10290
10291 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10292 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10293 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10294 .cindex "upper casing"
10295 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10296 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10297 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10298
10299 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10300 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10301 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10302 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10303 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10304 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10305 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10306 .endlist
10307
10308
10309
10310
10311
10312
10313 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10314 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10315 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10316 while expanding strings:
10317
10318 .vlist
10319 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10320 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10321 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10322 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10323 condition.
10324
10325 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10326 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10327 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10328 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10329 are:
10330 .display
10331 &`= `& equal
10332 &`== `& equal
10333 &`> `& greater
10334 &`>= `& greater or equal
10335 &`< `& less
10336 &`<= `& less or equal
10337 .endd
10338 For example:
10339 .code
10340 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10341 .endd
10342 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10343 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10344 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10345 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10346 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10347 zero.
10348
10349 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10350 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10351 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10352
10353
10354 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10355 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10356 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10357 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10358 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10359 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10360 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10361 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10362 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10363 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10364 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10365 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10366 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10367 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10368
10369 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10370 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10371 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10372 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10373 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10374 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10375 false if zero.
10376 An empty string is treated as false.
10377 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10378 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10379 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10380
10381 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10382 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10383 For example:
10384 .code
10385 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10386 .endd
10387
10388
10389 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10390 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10391 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10392 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10393 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10394 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10395 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10396 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10397
10398 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10399
10400 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10401 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10402 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10403 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10404 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10405 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10406 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10407 included in the binary.
10408
10409 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10410 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10411 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10412 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10413 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10414 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10415 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10416 string in LDAP form is:
10417 .code
10418 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10419 .endd
10420 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10421 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10422 .code
10423 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10424 .endd
10425 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10426 supported:
10427
10428 .ilist
10429 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10430 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10431 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10432 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10433 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10434 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10435 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10436 comparison fails.
10437
10438 .next
10439 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10440 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10441 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10442 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10443 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10444 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10445
10446 .next
10447 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10448 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10449 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10450 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10451 whatever its length.
10452
10453 .next
10454 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10455 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10456 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10457 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10458 .endlist
10459 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10460 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10461 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10462 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10463 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10464 support &[crypt16()]&.
10465
10466 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10467 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10468 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10469 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10470 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10471
10472 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10473 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10474 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10475
10476 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10477 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10478 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10479 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10480 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10481
10482 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10483 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10484 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10485 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10486 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10487 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10488 .code
10489 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10490 .endd
10491 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10492 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10493
10494 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10495 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10496 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10497 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10498 exists in the message. For example,
10499 .code
10500 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10501 .endd
10502 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10503 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10504
10505 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10506 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10507 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10508 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10509 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10510 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10511 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10512 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10513 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10514
10515 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10516 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10517 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10518 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10519 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10520 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10521 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10522 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10523
10524 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10525 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10526 .cindex "first delivery"
10527 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10528 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10529 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10530 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10531
10532
10533 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10534 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10535 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10536 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10537 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10538 .vindex "&$item$&"
10539 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10540 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10541 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10542 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10543 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10544 .ilist
10545 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10546 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10547 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10548 .next
10549 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10550 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10551 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10552 .endlist
10553 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10554 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10555 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10556 list separator is changed to a comma:
10557 .code
10558 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10559 .endd
10560 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10561 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10562
10563 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10564
10565
10566 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10567 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10568 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10569 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10570 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10571 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10572 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10573 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10574 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10575 case-independent.
10576
10577 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10578 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10579 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10580 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10581 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10582 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10583 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10584 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10585 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10586 case-independent.
10587
10588 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10589 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10590 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10591 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10592 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10593 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10594 is true.
10595
10596 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10597 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10598 .code
10599 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10600 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10601 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10602 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10603 .endd
10604
10605 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10606 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10607 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10608 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10609 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10610 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10611 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10612 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10613 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10614 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10615 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10616
10617 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10618 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10619 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10620 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10621 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10622
10623 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10624 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10625 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10626 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10627 .code
10628 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10629 .endd
10630 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10631
10632 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10633 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10634 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10635 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10636 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10637 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10638 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10639 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10640 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10641 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10642 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10643 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10644 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10645 this can be used.
10646
10647
10648 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10649 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10650 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10651 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10652 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10653 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10654 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10655 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10656 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10657 case-independent.
10658
10659 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10660 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10661 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10662 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10663 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10664 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10665 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10666 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10667 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10668 case-independent.
10669
10670
10671 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10672 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10673 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10674 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10675 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10676 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10677 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10678 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10679 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10680 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10681 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10682 For example,
10683 .code
10684 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10685 .endd
10686 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10687 backslashes is also required.
10688
10689 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10690 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10691 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10692 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10693 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10694 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10695
10696 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10697 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10698 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10699 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10700 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10701 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10702 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10703 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10704
10705 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10706 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10707 See &*match_local_part*&.
10708
10709 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10710 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10711 See &*match_local_part*&.
10712
10713 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10714 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10715 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10716 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10717 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10718 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10719 .code
10720 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10721 .endd
10722 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10723
10724 .ilist
10725 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10726 .next
10727 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10728 .next
10729 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10730 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10731 in a single test such as
10732 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10733 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10734 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10735 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10736 .code
10737 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10738 .endd
10739 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10740 .next
10741 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10742 .next
10743 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10744 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10745 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10746 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10747 masks. For example:
10748 .code
10749 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10750 .endd
10751 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10752 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10753 address mask, for example:
10754 .code
10755 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10756 .endd
10757 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10758 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10759 .code
10760 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10761 .endd
10762 .endlist ilist
10763
10764 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10765 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10766
10767 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10768
10769 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10770 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10771 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10772 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10773 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10774 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10775 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10776 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10777 example is:
10778 .code
10779 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10780 .endd
10781 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10782 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10783 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10784 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10785 .code
10786 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10787 .endd
10788 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10789 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10790 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10791 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10792 caselessly.
10793
10794 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10795 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10796
10797 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10798 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10799 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10800 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10801
10802 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10803 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10804 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10805 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10806 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10807 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10808 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10809 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10810 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10811 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10812 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10813 .code
10814 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10815 .endd
10816 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10817 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10818
10819 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10820 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10821 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10822 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10823 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10824 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10825 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10826
10827 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10828 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10829 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10830 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10831 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10832 .code
10833 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10834 .endd
10835 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10836 .code
10837 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10838 .endd
10839 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10840 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10841 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10842 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10843 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10844 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10845 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10846 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10847
10848
10849 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10850 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10851 .cindex "Cyrus"
10852 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10853 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10854 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10855 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10856 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10857 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10858
10859 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10860 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10861 building Exim. For example:
10862 .code
10863 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10864 .endd
10865 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10866 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10867 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10868 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10869
10870 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10871 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10872 configuration, you might have this:
10873 .code
10874 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10875 .endd
10876 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10877 .code
10878 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10879 .endd
10880 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10881 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10882 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10883 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10884 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10885 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10886
10887
10888 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10889 .cindex "Radius"
10890 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10891 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10892 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10893 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10894 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10895 support.
10896
10897 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10898 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10899 this library, you need to set
10900 .code
10901 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10902 .endd
10903 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10904 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10905 .code
10906 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10907 .endd
10908 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10909 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10910 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10911
10912 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10913 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10914 the authentication is successful. For example:
10915 .code
10916 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10917 .endd
10918
10919
10920 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10921 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10922 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10923 .cindex "Cyrus"
10924 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10925 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10926 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10927 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10928 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10929 by a process that is not running as root.
10930
10931 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10932 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10933 building Exim. For example:
10934 .code
10935 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10936 .endd
10937 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10938 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10939 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10940
10941 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10942 two are mandatory. For example:
10943 .code
10944 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10945 .endd
10946 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10947 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10948 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10949 .endlist vlist
10950
10951
10952
10953 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10954 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10955 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10956 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10957 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10958 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10959 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10960
10961
10962 .vlist
10963 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10964 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10965 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10966 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10967 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10968 For example,
10969 .code
10970 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10971 .endd
10972 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10973 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10974 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10975
10976 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10977 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10978 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10979 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10980 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10981 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10982 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10983 parsed but not evaluated.
10984 .endlist
10985 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10986
10987
10988
10989
10990 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10991 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10992 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10993 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10994 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10995
10996 .vlist
10997 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10998 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10999 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11000 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11001 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11002 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11003 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11004 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11005 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11006 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11007 matching condition.
11008
11009 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11010 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11011 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11012 any unused variables being made empty.
11013
11014 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11015 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11016 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11017 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11018 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11019 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11020 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11021 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11022 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11023 during subsequent delivery.
11024
11025 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11026 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11027 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11028 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11029 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11030 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11031 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11032 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11033 delivery.
11034
11035 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11036 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11037 this variable has the number of arguments.
11038
11039 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11040 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11041 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11042 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11043 be preserved by coding like this:
11044 .code
11045 warn !verify = sender
11046 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11047 .endd
11048 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11049 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11050 failure.
11051
11052 .vitem &$address_data$&
11053 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11054 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11055 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11056 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11057 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11058 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11059 user filter files.
11060
11061 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11062 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11063 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11064 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11065 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11066 from the child's routing.
11067
11068 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11069 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11070 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11071 address.
11072
11073 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11074 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11075 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11076
11077 .vitem &$address_file$&
11078 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11079 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11080 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11081 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11082 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11083 .code
11084 /home/r2d2/savemail
11085 .endd
11086 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11087 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11088 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11089 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11090 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11091 to the relevant file.
11092
11093 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11094 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11095 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11096 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11097
11098 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11099 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11100 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11101 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11102
11103 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11104 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11105 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11106 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11107 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11108 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11109 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11110 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11111 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11112 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11113 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11114 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11115 command line option.
11116
11117 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11118 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11119 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11120 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11121 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11122 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11123 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11124 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11125 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11126 the ACL's as well.
11127
11128
11129 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11130 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11131 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11132 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11133 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11134 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11135 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11136 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11137 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11138 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11139 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11140
11141 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11142 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11143 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11144 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11145 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11146
11147
11148 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11149 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11150 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11151 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11152 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11153 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11154 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11155 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11156 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11157 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11158 an undefined mechanism.
11159
11160 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11161 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11162 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11163 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11164 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11165 the ACL malware condition.
11166
11167 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11168 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11169 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11170 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11171 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11172 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11173
11174 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11175 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11176 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11177 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11178 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11179 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11180 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11181
11182 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11183 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11184 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11185 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11186 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11187
11188 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11189 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11190 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11191 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11192 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11193
11194 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11195 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11196 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11197 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11198 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11199 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11200 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11201
11202 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11203 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11204 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11205 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11206 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11207 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11208 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11209
11210 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11211 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11212 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11213
11214 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11215 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11216 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11217 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11218 compilations of the same version of the program.
11219
11220 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11221 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11222 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11223 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11224 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11225
11226 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11227 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11228 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11229 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11230 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11231
11232 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11233 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11234 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11235 &$dnslist_value$&
11236 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11237 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11238 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11239 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11240 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11241 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11242 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11243 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11244 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11245
11246 .vitem &$domain$&
11247 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11248 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11249 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11250 case for &$domain$&.
11251
11252 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11253 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11254 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11255 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11256
11257 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11258 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11259 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11260 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11261 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11262 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11263
11264 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11265 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11266 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11267
11268 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11269
11270 .ilist
11271 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11272 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11273 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11274 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11275 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11276 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11277 the &(smtp)& transport.
11278
11279 .next
11280 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11281 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11282 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11283 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11284
11285 .next
11286 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11287 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11288 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11289 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11290 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11291 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11292
11293 .next
11294 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11295 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11296 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11297 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11298 .endlist
11299
11300
11301 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11302 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11303 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11304 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11305 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11306 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11307 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11308 used.
11309
11310 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11311 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11312 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11313 to nothing.
11314
11315 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11316 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11317 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11318
11319 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11320 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11321 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11322
11323 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11324 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11325 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11326
11327 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11328 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11329 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11330 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11331 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11332
11333 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11334 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11335 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11336 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11337 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11338
11339 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11340 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11341 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11342 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11343 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11344
11345 .vitem &$home$&
11346 .vindex "&$home$&"
11347 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11348 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11349 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11350 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11351 by a setting on the transport itself.
11352
11353 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11354 of the environment variable HOME.
11355
11356 .vitem &$host$&
11357 .vindex "&$host$&"
11358 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11359 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11360 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11361 to local and remote transports.
11362
11363 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11364 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11365 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11366 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11367 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11368 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11369 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11370 is connected.
11371
11372 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11373 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11374 client is connected.
11375
11376
11377 .vitem &$host_address$&
11378 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11379 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11380 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11381 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11382
11383 .vitem &$host_data$&
11384 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11385 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11386 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11387 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11388 .code
11389 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11390 message = $host_data
11391 .endd
11392 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11393 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11394 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11395 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11396 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11397 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11398 variables is set to &"1"&.
11399
11400 .ilist
11401 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11402 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11403
11404 .next
11405 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11406 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11407 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11408 .endlist ilist
11409
11410 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11411 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11412 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11413 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11414 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11415 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11416 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11417 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11418 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11419 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11420
11421 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11422 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11423 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11424
11425 .vitem &$host_port$&
11426 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11427 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11428 for an outbound connection.
11429
11430
11431 .vitem &$inode$&
11432 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11433 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11434 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11435 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11436 a unique name for the file.
11437
11438 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11439 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11440 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11441
11442 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11443 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11444 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11445
11446 .vitem &$item$&
11447 .vindex "&$item$&"
11448 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11449 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11450 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11451 empty.
11452
11453 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11454 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11455 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11456 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11457 lookup.
11458
11459 .vitem &$load_average$&
11460 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11461 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11462 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11463 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11464
11465 .vitem &$local_part$&
11466 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11467 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11468 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11469 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11470 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11471
11472 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11473 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11474 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11475 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11476 once.
11477
11478 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11479 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11480 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11481 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11482 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11483 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11484
11485 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11486 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11487 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11488 &$address_pipe$&).
11489
11490 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11491 local part of the recipient address.
11492
11493 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11494 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11495 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11496
11497 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11498 the addresses
11499 .code
11500 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11501 abc\:xyz@test.example
11502 .endd
11503 the value of &$local_part$& is
11504 .code
11505 abc:xyz
11506 .endd
11507 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11508 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11509 have:
11510 .code
11511 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11512 .endd
11513 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11514 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11515 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11516
11517 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11518 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11519 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11520 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11521 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11522 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11523 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11524
11525 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11526 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11527 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11528 variable expands to nothing.
11529
11530 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11531 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11532 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11533 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11534 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11535
11536 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11537 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11538 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11539 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11540 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11541
11542 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11543 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11544 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11545 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11546
11547 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11548 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11549 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11550
11551 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11552 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11553 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11554 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11555 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11556 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11557 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11558 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11559
11560 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11561 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11562 This contains the expanded value of the
11563 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11564 been read.
11565
11566 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11567 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11568 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11569 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11570 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11571 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11572
11573 .vitem &$log_space$&
11574 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11575 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11576 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11577 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11578 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11579 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11580
11581
11582 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11583 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11584 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11585 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11586 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11587 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11588 and &"yes"& if it was.
11589
11590 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11591 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11592 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11593 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11594 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11595 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11596 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11597 variable is empty.
11598
11599 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11600 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11601 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11602 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11603 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11604
11605 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11606 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11607 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11608 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11609 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11610 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11611 character(s).
11612
11613 .vitem &$message_age$&
11614 .cindex "message" "age of"
11615 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11616 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11617 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11618 delivery attempt.
11619
11620 .vitem &$message_body$&
11621 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11622 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11623 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11624 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11625 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11626 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11627 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11628 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11629 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11630
11631 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11632 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11633 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11634 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11635 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11636
11637 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11638 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11639 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11640 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11641 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11642 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11643 &$message_body$&.
11644
11645 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11646 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11647 .cindex "message body" "size"
11648 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11649 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11650 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11651 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11652 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11653
11654 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11655 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11656 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11657 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11658 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11659 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11660 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11661 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11662
11663 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11664 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11665 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11666 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11667 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11668 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11669
11670 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11671 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11672 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11673 contents of header lines is done.
11674
11675 .vitem &$message_id$&
11676 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11677
11678 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11679 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11680 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11681 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11682 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11683 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11684 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11685 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11686 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11687 from the body is not counted.
11688
11689 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11690 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11691 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11692 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11693 header and the body).
11694
11695 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11696 .code
11697 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11698 condition = \
11699 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11700 .endd
11701 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11702 message has not yet been received.
11703
11704 .vitem &$message_size$&
11705 .cindex "size" "of message"
11706 .cindex "message" "size"
11707 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11708 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11709 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11710 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11711 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11712 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11713 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11714 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11715 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11716
11717 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11718 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11719 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11720 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11721
11722 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11723 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11724 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11725 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11726
11727 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11728 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11729 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11730
11731 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11732 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11733 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11734 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11735 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11736 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11737 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11738 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11739 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11740 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11741
11742 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11743 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11744 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11745
11746 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11747 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11748 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11749 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11750 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11751 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11752 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11753 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11754 the original address.
11755
11756 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11757 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11758 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11759 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11760 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11761
11762 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11763 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11764 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11765
11766 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11767 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11768 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11769 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11770 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11771 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11772 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11773 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11774 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11775
11776 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11777 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11778 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11779 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11780 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11781 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11782 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11783 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11784 user.
11785
11786 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11787 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11788 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11789 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11790
11791 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11792 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11793 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11794 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11795
11796 .vitem &$pid$&
11797 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11798 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11799 This variable contains the current process id.
11800
11801 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11802 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11803 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11804 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11805 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11806 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11807 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11808 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11809 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11810 variable"& error if encountered.
11811
11812 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11813 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11814 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11815 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11816 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11817 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11818 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11819
11820
11821 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11822 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11823 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11824 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11825
11826 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11827 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11828 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11829 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11830
11831 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11832 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11833 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11834 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11835
11836 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11837 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11838 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11839
11840 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11841 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11842 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11843 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11844
11845 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11846 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11847 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11848 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11849 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11850
11851 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11852 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11853 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11854 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11855 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11856 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11857
11858 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11859 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11860 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11861 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11862 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11863
11864 .vitem &$received_count$&
11865 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11866 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11867 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11868 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11869 delivering.
11870
11871 .vitem &$received_for$&
11872 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11873 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11874 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11875 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11876 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11877
11878 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11879 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11880 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11881 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11882 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11883 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11884 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11885 option.
11886
11887 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11888 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11889 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11890 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11891 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11892 time.
11893
11894 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11895 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11896 &(smtp)& transport).
11897
11898 .vitem &$received_port$&
11899 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11900 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11901
11902 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11903 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11904 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11905 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11906 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11907 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11908 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11909 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11910 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11911
11912 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11913 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11914 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11915 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11916 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11917 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11918
11919 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11920 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11921 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11922
11923 .vitem &$received_time$&
11924 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11925 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11926 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11927
11928 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11929 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11930 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11931 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11932 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11933 .display
11934 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11935 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11936 .endd
11937 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11938 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11939 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11940 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11941
11942 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11943 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11944 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11945 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11946
11947 .ilist
11948 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11949 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11950
11951 .next
11952 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11953
11954 .next
11955 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11956 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11957 MAIL).
11958
11959 .next
11960 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11961 .next
11962
11963 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11964 .endlist
11965
11966 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11967 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11968
11969 .vitem &$recipients$&
11970 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11971 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11972 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11973 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11974 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11975 cases:
11976
11977 .olist
11978 In a system filter file.
11979 .next
11980 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11981 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11982 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11983 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11984 .next
11985 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11986 .endlist
11987
11988
11989 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11990 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11991 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11992 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11993 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11994 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11995
11996
11997 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11998 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11999 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12000 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12001
12002
12003 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12004 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12005 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12006 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12007 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12008 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12009 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12010
12011 .vitem &$return_path$&
12012 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12013 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12014 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12015 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12016 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12017 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12018 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12019 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12020 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12021 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12022 envelope sender.
12023
12024 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12025 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12026 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12027
12028 .vitem &$router_name$&
12029 .cindex "router" "name"
12030 .cindex "name" "of router"
12031 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12032 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12033
12034 .vitem &$runrc$&
12035 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12036 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12037 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12038 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12039 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12040 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12041 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12042 another.
12043
12044 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12045 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12046 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12047 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12048 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12049 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12050 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12051 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12052
12053 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12054 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12055 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12056 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12057 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12058 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12059
12060 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12061 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12062 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12063 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12064 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12065 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12066 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12067 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12068
12069 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12070 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12071 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12072
12073 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12074 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12075 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12076
12077 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12078 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12079 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12080 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12081 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12082 this:
12083 .display
12084 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12085 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12086 .endd
12087 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12088 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12089 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12090 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12091
12092 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12093 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12094 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12095 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12096 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12097 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12098 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12099 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12100 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12101 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12102 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12103 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12104 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12105
12106 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12107 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12108 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12109 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12110 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12111 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12112
12113 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12114 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12115 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
12116 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
12117
12118 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12119 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12120 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12121 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12122 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12123 &$authenticated_id$&.
12124
12125 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12126 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12127 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12128 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12129 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12130 resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
12131 other times, this variable is false.
12132
12133 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12134 library, by setting:
12135 .code
12136 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12137 .endd
12138
12139 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12140 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12141
12142 Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
12143 with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
12144
12145 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12146 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12147
12148
12149 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12150 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12151 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12152 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12153 other means, this variable is empty.
12154
12155 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12156 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12157 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12158 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12159 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12160 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12161 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12162
12163 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12164 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12165 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12166 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12167
12168 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12169 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12170 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12171 is set to &"1"&.
12172
12173 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12174 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12175 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12176 following are true:
12177
12178 .ilist
12179 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12180 .next
12181 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12182 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12183 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12184 .next
12185 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12186 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12187 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12188 .next
12189 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12190 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12191 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12192 .next
12193 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12194 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12195 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12196 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12197 .code
12198 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12199 .endd
12200 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12201 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12202 .endlist
12203
12204
12205 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12206 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12207 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12208 number that was used on the remote host.
12209
12210 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12211 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12212 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12213 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12214 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12215 called Exim.
12216
12217 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12218 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12219 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12220 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12221
12222 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12223 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12224 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12225 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12226 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12227 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12228 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12229 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12230 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12231 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12232 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12233 the parentheses.
12234
12235 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12236 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12237 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12238 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12239 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12240
12241 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12242 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12243 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12244 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12245 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12246
12247 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12248 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12249 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12250 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12251 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12252 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12253 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12254
12255 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12256 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12257 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12258 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12259 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12260
12261 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12262 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12263 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12264 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12265 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12266 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12267
12268 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12269 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12270 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12271 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12272 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12273 .code
12274 MAIL FROM:<>
12275 MAIL FROM: <>
12276 .endd
12277 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12278 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12279 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12280 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12281
12282 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12283 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12284 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12285 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12286 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12287 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12288 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12289
12290 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12291 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12292 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12293 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12294 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12295 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12296 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12297 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12298 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12299 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12300 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12301
12302 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12303 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12304 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12305 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12306 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12307 message is junk mail.
12308
12309 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12310 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12311 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12312 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12313
12314
12315 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12316 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12317 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12318
12319 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12320 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12321 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12322 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12323 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12324 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12325
12326 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12327 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12328 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12329 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12330 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12331 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12332 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12333 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12334 .code
12335 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12336 .endd
12337 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12338
12339
12340 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12341 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12342 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12343 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12344 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12345 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12346
12347 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12348 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12349 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12350 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12351 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12352 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12353 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12354 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12355
12356 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12357 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12358 the outbound.
12359
12360 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12361 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12362 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12363 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12364 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12365 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12366
12367 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12368 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12369 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12370 inbound connection when the message was received.
12371 It is only useful as the argument of a
12372 .new
12373 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12374 .wen
12375 or a &%def%& condition.
12376
12377 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12378 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12379 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12380 inbound connection when the message was received.
12381 It is only useful as the argument of a
12382 .new
12383 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12384 .wen
12385 or a &%def%& condition.
12386
12387 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12388 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12389 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12390 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12391 .new
12392 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12393 .wen
12394 or a &%def%& condition.
12395
12396 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12397 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12398 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12399 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12400 .new
12401 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12402 .wen
12403 or a &%def%& condition.
12404
12405 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12406 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12407 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12408 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12409
12410 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12411 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12412 the outbound.
12413
12414 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12415 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12416 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12417 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12418 and &"0"& otherwise.
12419
12420 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12421 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12422 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12423 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12424 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12425 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12426 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12427 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12428 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12429
12430 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12431 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12432 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12433
12434 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12435 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12436 This variable is
12437 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12438 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12439 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12440 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12441
12442 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12443 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12444 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12445 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12446 .code
12447 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12448 1 No response to request
12449 2 Response not verified
12450 3 Verification failed
12451 4 Verification succeeded
12452 .endd
12453
12454 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12455 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12456 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12457 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12458 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12459
12460 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12461 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12462 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12463 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12464 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12465 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12466 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12467
12468 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12469 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12470 the outbound.
12471
12472 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12473 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12474 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12475 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12476 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12477 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12478
12479 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12480 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12481 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12482 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12483 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12484 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12485 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12486 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12487 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12488 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12489 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12490
12491 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12492 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12493 the outbound.
12494
12495 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12496 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12497 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12498 During outbound
12499 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12500 the transport.
12501
12502 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12503 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12504 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12505 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12506
12507 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12508 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12509 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12510
12511 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12512 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12513 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12514
12515 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12516 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12517 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12518 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12519 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12520 values for those that are behind (west).
12521
12522 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12523 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12524 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12525 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12526
12527 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12528 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12529 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12530 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12531 flag.
12532
12533 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12534 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12535 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12536 -0500.
12537
12538 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12539 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12540 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12541 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12542
12543 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12544 .cindex "transport" "name"
12545 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12546 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12547 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12548
12549 .vitem &$value$&
12550 .vindex "&$value$&"
12551 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12552 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12553 &*reduce*& expansion.
12554
12555 .vitem &$version_number$&
12556 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12557 The version number of Exim.
12558
12559 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12560 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12561 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12562 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12563
12564 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12565 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12566 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12567 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12568 .endlist
12569 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12570
12571
12572
12573 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12574 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12575
12576 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12577 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12578 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12579 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12580 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12581 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12582 the line
12583 .code
12584 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12585 .endd
12586 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12587
12588
12589 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12590 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12591 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12592 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12593 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12594 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12595 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12596 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12597 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12598
12599 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12600 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12601 should usually be something like
12602 .code
12603 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12604 .endd
12605 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12606 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12607 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12608 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12609 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12610 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12611 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12612 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12613 two ways:
12614
12615 .ilist
12616 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12617 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12618 a startup when Exim is entered.
12619 .next
12620 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12621 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12622 .endlist
12623
12624 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12625 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12626
12627
12628 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12629 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12630 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12631 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12632 forms:
12633 .code
12634 ${perl{foo}}
12635 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12636 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12637 .endd
12638 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12639 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12640 with an error message of the form
12641 .code
12642 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12643 .endd
12644 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12645 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12646 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12647 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12648 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12649 that was passed to &%die%&.
12650
12651
12652 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12653 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12654 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12655 the Perl code
12656 .code
12657 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12658 .endd
12659 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12660 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12661 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12662
12663 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12664 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12665 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12666 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12667
12668 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12669 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12670 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12671 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12672 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12673 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12674 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12675
12676
12677 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12678 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12679 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12680 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12681 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12682 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12683 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12684 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12685 avoided, but the output is lost.
12686
12687 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12688 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12689 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12690 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12691 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12692 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12693 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12694 .code
12695 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12696 .endd
12697 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12698 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12699 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12700 as the first subroutine argument.
12701 .ecindex IIDperl
12702
12703
12704 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12705 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12706
12707 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12708 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12709 "Starting the daemon"
12710 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12711 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12712 .cindex "network interface"
12713 .cindex "interface" "network"
12714 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12715 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12716 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12717 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12718 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12719 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12720 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12721 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12722 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12723 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12724 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12725
12726 .olist
12727 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12728 and ports to listen on.
12729 .next
12730 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12731 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12732 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12733 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12734 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12735 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12736 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12737 as an error situation.
12738 .next
12739 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12740 for the outgoing connection.
12741 .endlist
12742
12743
12744 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12745 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12746 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12747 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12748 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12749
12750 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12751 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12752 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12753 chapter describes how they operate.
12754
12755 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12756 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12757
12758
12759
12760 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12761 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12762 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12763 following options:
12764
12765 .ilist
12766 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12767 or service names.
12768 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12769 .next
12770 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12771 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12772 .endlist
12773
12774 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12775 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12776 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12777 colons. For example:
12778 .code
12779 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12780 192.168.23.65 ; \
12781 ::1 ; \
12782 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12783 .endd
12784 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12785 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12786
12787 .olist
12788 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12789 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12790 .code
12791 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12792 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12793 .endd
12794 .next
12795 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12796 with a colon separator, for example:
12797 .code
12798 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12799 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12800 .endd
12801 .endlist
12802
12803 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12804 default setting contains just one port:
12805 .code
12806 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12807 .endd
12808 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12809 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12810 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12811 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12812 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12813
12814
12815
12816 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12817 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12818 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12819 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12820 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12821 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12822 .code
12823 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12824 .endd
12825 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12826 .code
12827 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12828 .endd
12829 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12830
12831
12832
12833 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12834 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12835 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12836 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12837 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12838 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12839 exim.
12840
12841 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12842 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12843 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12844 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12845 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12846 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12847 .code
12848 -oX 1225
12849 .endd
12850 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12851 whereas
12852 .code
12853 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12854 .endd
12855 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12856 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12857 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12858
12859
12860
12861 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12862 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12863 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12864 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12865 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12866 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12867 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12868 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12869 list of port numbers or service names,
12870 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12871 common use of this option is expected to be
12872 .code
12873 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12874 .endd
12875 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12876 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12877 this way when a daemon is started.
12878
12879 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12880 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12881 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12882 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12883 connections via the daemon.)
12884
12885
12886
12887
12888 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12889 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12890 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12891 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12892 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12893 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12894 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12895 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12896 .code
12897 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12898 .endd
12899 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12900 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12901 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12902 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12903 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12904 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12905 .code
12906 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12907 .endd
12908 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12909 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12910 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12911 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12912 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12913
12914 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12915 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12916 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12917 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12918 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12919 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12920 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12921 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12922 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12923 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12924 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12925 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12926
12927 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12928 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12929 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12930 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12931 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12932
12933
12934
12935 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12936 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12937 .code
12938 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12939 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12940 .endd
12941 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12942 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12943 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12944 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12945
12946 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12947 .code
12948 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12949 .endd
12950 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12951 .code
12952 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12953 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12954 .endd
12955 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12956 IPv4 loopback address only:
12957 .code
12958 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12959 .endd
12960 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12961 .code
12962 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
12963 .endd
12964 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12965
12966
12967
12968 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12969 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12970 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12971 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12972 treated as local.
12973
12974 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12975 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12976 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12977 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12978
12979 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12980 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12981 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12982 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12983 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12984 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12985 used for listening. Consider this example:
12986 .code
12987 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12988 192.168.53.235 ; \
12989 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12990
12991 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12992 .endd
12993 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12994 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12995 Exim is routing.
12996
12997 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12998 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12999 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13000 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13001 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13002 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13003 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13004 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13005
13006
13007
13008 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13009 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13010 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13011 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13012 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13013 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13014 details.
13015
13016
13017
13018
13019 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13020 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13021
13022 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13023 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13024 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13025 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13026
13027 .ilist
13028 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13029 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13030 .next
13031 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13032 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13033 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13034 .next
13035 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13036 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13037 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13038 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13039 settings.
13040 .endlist
13041
13042 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13043 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13044 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13045 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13046 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13047 listed in more than one group.
13048
13049 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13050 .table2
13051 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13052 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13053 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13054 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13055 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13056 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13057 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13058 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13059 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13060 .endtable
13061
13062
13063 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13064 .table2
13065 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13066 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13067 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13068 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13069 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13070 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13071 .endtable
13072
13073
13074
13075 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13076 .table2
13077 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13078 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13079 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13080 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13081 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13082 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13083 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13084 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13085 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13086 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13087 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13088 .endtable
13089
13090
13091
13092 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13093 .table2
13094 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13095 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13096 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13097 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13098 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13099 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13100 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13101 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13102 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13103 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13104 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13105 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13106 .endtable
13107
13108
13109
13110 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13111 .table2
13112 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13113 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13114 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13115 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13116 .endtable
13117
13118
13119
13120 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13121 .table2
13122 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13123 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13124 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13125 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13126 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13127 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13128 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13129 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13130 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13131 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13132 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13133 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13134 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13135 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13136 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13137 .endtable
13138
13139
13140
13141 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13142 .table2
13143 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13144 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13145 .endtable
13146
13147
13148
13149 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13150 .table2
13151 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13152 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13153 .endtable
13154
13155
13156
13157 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13158 .table2
13159 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13160 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13161 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13162 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13163 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13164 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13165 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13166 .endtable
13167
13168
13169
13170 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13171 .table2
13172 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13173 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13174 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13175 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13176 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13177 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13178 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13179 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13180 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13181 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13182 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13183 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13184 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13185 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13186 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13187 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13188 connection"
13189 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13190 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13191 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13192 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13193 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13194 .endtable
13195
13196
13197
13198 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13199 .table2
13200 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13201 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13202 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13203 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13204 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13205 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13206 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13207 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13208 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13209 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13210 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13211 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13212 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13213 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13214 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13215 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13216 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13217 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13218 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13219 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13220 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13221 words""&"
13222 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13223 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13224 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13225 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13226 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13227 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13228 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13229 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13230 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13231 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13232 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13233 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13234 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13235 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13236 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13237 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13238 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13239 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13240 .endtable
13241
13242
13243
13244 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13245 .table2
13246 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13247 item"
13248 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13249 item"
13250 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13251 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13252 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13253 .endtable
13254
13255
13256
13257 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13258 .table2
13259 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13260 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13261 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13262 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13263 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13264 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13265 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13266 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13267 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13268 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13269 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13270 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13271 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13272 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13273 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13274 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13275 .endtable
13276
13277
13278
13279 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13280 .table2
13281 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13282 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13283 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13284 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13285 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13286 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13287 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13288 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13289 .endtable
13290
13291
13292
13293 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13294 .table2
13295 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13296 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13297 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13298 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13299 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13300 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13301 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13302 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13303 .endtable
13304
13305
13306
13307
13308 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13309 .table2
13310 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13311 .endtable
13312
13313
13314
13315
13316
13317 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13318 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13319
13320 .table2
13321 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13322 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13323 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13324 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13325 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13326 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13327 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13328 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13329 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13330 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13331 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13332 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13333 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13334 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13335 connection"
13336 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13337 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13338 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13339 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13340 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13341 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13342 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13343 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13344 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13345 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13346 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13347 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13348 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13349 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13350 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13351 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13352 .endtable
13353
13354
13355
13356 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13357 .table2
13358 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13359 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13360 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13361 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13362 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13363 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13364 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13365 .endtable
13366
13367
13368
13369 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13370 .table2
13371 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13372 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13373 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13374 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13375 words""&"
13376 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13377 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13378 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13379 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13380 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13381 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13382 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13383 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13384 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13385 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13386 .endtable
13387
13388
13389
13390 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13391 .table2
13392 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13393 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13394 directory"
13395 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13396 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13397 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13398 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13399 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13400 .endtable
13401
13402
13403
13404 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13405 .table2
13406 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13407 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13408 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13409 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13410 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13411 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13412 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13413 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13414 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13415 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13416 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13417 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13418 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13419 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13420 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13421 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13422 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13423 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13424 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13425 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13426 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13427 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13428 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13429 .endtable
13430
13431
13432
13433 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13434 .table2
13435 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13436 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13437 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13438 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13439 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13440 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13441 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13442 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13443 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13444 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13445 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13446 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13447 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13448 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13449 .endtable
13450
13451
13452
13453 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13454 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13455 &dagger;.
13456
13457 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13458 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13459 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13460 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13461 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13462 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13463 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13464 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13465 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13466
13467 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13468 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13469 It now defaults to true.
13470 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13471 .display
13472 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13473 .endd
13474
13475 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13476 .code
13477 log_selector = +8bitmime
13478 .endd
13479
13480 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13481 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13482 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13483 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13484 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13485 further details.
13486
13487 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13488 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13489 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13490 SMTP messages.
13491
13492 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13493 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13494 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13495 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13496 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13497
13498 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13499 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13500 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13501 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13502 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13503
13504 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13505 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13506 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13507 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13508
13509 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13510 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13511 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13512 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13513 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13514
13515 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! unset
13516 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13517 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13518 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13519 This option defines the ACL that,
13520 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13521 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13522 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13523 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13524
13525 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13526 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13527 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13528 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13529
13530 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13531 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13532 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13533 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13534
13535 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13536 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13537 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13538 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13539 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13540
13541
13542 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13543 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13544 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13545 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13546
13547 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13548 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13549 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13550 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13551 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13552
13553 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13554 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13555 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13556 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13557 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13558
13559 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13560 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13561 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13562 further details.
13563
13564 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13565 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13566 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13567 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13568
13569 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13570 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13571 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13572 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13573
13574 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13575 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13576 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13577 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13578
13579 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13580 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13581 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13582 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13583
13584 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13585 .cindex "admin user"
13586 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13587 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13588 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13589 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13590 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13591 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13592 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13593
13594 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13595 .cindex "domain literal"
13596 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13597 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13598 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13599 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13600
13601 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13602 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13603 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13604 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13605 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13606 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13607 the local host's IP addresses.
13608
13609
13610 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13611 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13612 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13613 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13614 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13615 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13616 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13617 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13618 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13619
13620 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13621 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13622 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13623 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13624 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13625 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13626 experiment if they wish.
13627
13628 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13629 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13630 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13631 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13632 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13633 suitable setting is:
13634 .code
13635 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13636 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13637 .endd
13638 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13639 .code
13640 dns_check_names_pattern =
13641 .endd
13642 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13643
13644
13645 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13646 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13647 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13648 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13649 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13650 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13651 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13652 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13653 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13654 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13655 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13656
13657 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13658 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13659 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13660 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13661 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13662 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13663
13664 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13665 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13666 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13667 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13668 .code
13669 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13670 .endd
13671 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13672 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13673 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13674 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13675
13676
13677 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13678 .cindex "thawing messages"
13679 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13680 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13681 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13682 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13683 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13684 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13685
13686 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13687 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13688 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13689
13690
13691 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13692 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13693 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13694 .code
13695 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13696 .endd
13697 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13698 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13699
13700
13701 .option bi_command main string unset
13702 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13703 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13704 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13705 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13706 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13707
13708
13709 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13710 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13711 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13712 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13713 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13714 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13715
13716
13717 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13718 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13719 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13720 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13721
13722 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13723 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13724 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13725 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13726 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13727 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13728 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13729 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13730 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13731 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13732
13733 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13734 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13735 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13736 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13737
13738
13739 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13740 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13741 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13742 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13743 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13744 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13745 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13746 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13747 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13748
13749 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13750 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13751 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13752 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13753 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13754 messages.
13755
13756 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13757 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13758 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13759 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13760 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13761 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13762 connection. A typical setting might be:
13763 .code
13764 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13765 .endd
13766 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13767 .code
13768 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13769 .endd
13770 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13771 address.
13772
13773 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13774 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13775 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13776 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13777 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13778 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13779
13780
13781 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13782 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13783 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13784 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13785
13786
13787 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13788 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13789 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13790 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13791
13792
13793 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13794 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13795 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13796 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13797
13798
13799 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13800 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13801 callout verification. The default value is
13802 .code
13803 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13804 .endd
13805 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13806
13807
13808 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13809 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13810
13811
13812 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13813 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13814
13815 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13816 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13817 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13818 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13819 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13820 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13821 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13822 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13823 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13824 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13825
13826
13827 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13828 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13829
13830
13831 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13832 .cindex "checking disk space"
13833 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13834 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13835 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13836 message is accepted.
13837
13838 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13839 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13840 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13841 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13842 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13843 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13844 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13845 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13846
13847
13848 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13849 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13850 .code
13851 check_spool_space = 10M
13852 check_spool_inodes = 100
13853 .endd
13854 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13855 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13856 transit.
13857
13858 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13859 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13860 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13861
13862 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13863 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13864 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13865 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13866 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13867 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13868
13869 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13870 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13871
13872 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13873 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13874 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13875
13876 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13877 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13878 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13879 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13880 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13881 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13882
13883 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13884 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13885 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13886 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13887 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13888 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13889 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13890
13891 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13892 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13893
13894 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13895 .cindex "warning of delay"
13896 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13897 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13898 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13899 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13900 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13901 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13902 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13903 with
13904 .code
13905 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13906 .endd
13907 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13908 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13909 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13910 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13911 .code
13912 delay_warning = 6h
13913 .endd
13914 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13915 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13916 .code
13917 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13918 .endd
13919 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
13920 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
13921 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
13922
13923 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13924 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13925 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13926 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13927 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13928 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13929 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13930 not sent. The default is:
13931 .code
13932 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13933 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13934 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13935 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13936 } {no}{yes}}
13937 .endd
13938 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13939 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13940 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13941 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13942
13943 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13944 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13945 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13946 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13947 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13948 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13949 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13950 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13951
13952 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13953 .cindex "load average"
13954 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13955 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13956 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13957 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13958 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13959
13960
13961 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13962 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13963 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13964 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13965 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13966 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13967 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13968 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13969
13970 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13971 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13972 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13973 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13974 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13975 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13976 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13977 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13978
13979 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13980 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13981 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13982 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13983
13984
13985 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13986 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13987 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13988 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13989 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13990 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13991 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13992
13993
13994 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13995 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13996 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13997 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13998 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13999 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14000 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14001 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14002 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14003 by a setting such as this:
14004 .code
14005 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14006 .endd
14007 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14008 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14009 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14010 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14011 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14012 options are applied after this global option.
14013
14014 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14015 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14016 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14017 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14018 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14019 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14020 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14021 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14022 value of this option. The default pattern is
14023 .code
14024 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14025 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14026 .endd
14027 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14028 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14029 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14030 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14031 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14032 empty string.
14033
14034 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14035 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14036 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14037
14038 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14039 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14040 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14041 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14042
14043
14044 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14045 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14046 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14047 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14048 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14049 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14050
14051 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14052
14053
14054 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14055 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14056 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14057 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14058 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14059 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14060 domain matches this list.
14061
14062 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14063 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14064 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14065
14066
14067 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14068 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14069 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14070 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14071 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14072 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14073 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14074 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14075 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14076 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14077 to set in them.
14078
14079
14080 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14081 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14082
14083
14084 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14085 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14086 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14087 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14088 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14089 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14090 on.
14091
14092 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14093
14094
14095 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14096 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14097 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14098 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14099
14100 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14101 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14102 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14103 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14104 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14105 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14106 .code
14107 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14108 .endd
14109 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14110 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14111
14112 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14113 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14114 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14115 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14116 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14117 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14118 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14119 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14120 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14121
14122
14123 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14124 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14125 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14126 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14127 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14128 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14129 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14130 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14131 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14132
14133 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14134 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14135 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14136 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14137 are examined. For example:
14138 .code
14139 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14140 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14141 postmaster@mydomain.example
14142 .endd
14143 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14144 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14145 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14146 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14147 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14148 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14149 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14150
14151
14152 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14153 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14154 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14155 .display
14156 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14157 .endd
14158 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14159 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14160 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14161 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14162 overrides the default.
14163
14164 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14165 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14166 and warning messages. For example:
14167 .code
14168 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14169 .endd
14170 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14171 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14172 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14173 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14174 not used.
14175
14176
14177 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14178 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14179 .cindex "Exim group"
14180 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14181 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14182 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14183 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14184 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14185 security issues.
14186
14187
14188 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14189 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14190 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14191 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14192 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14193 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14194 other place.
14195 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14196 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14197 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14198 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14199
14200
14201 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14202 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14203 .cindex "Exim user"
14204 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14205 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14206 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14207 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14208
14209 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14210 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14211 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14212 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14213
14214
14215 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14216 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14217 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14218 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14219
14220
14221 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14222 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14223
14224 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
14225 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14226 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14227 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14228 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14229 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14230 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14231 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14232 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14233 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14234 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14235 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14236 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14237 addresses.
14238
14239
14240 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14241 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14242 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14243 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14244 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14245 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14246 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14247 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14248 retries.
14249
14250 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14251 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14252 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14253 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14254
14255
14256
14257 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14258 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14259 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14260 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14261 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14262 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14263 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14264 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14265 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14266 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14267 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14268 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14269 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14270 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14271 logging that you require.
14272
14273
14274 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14275 .cindex "HP-UX"
14276 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14277 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14278 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14279 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14280 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14281 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14282 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14283 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14284
14285 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14286 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14287 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14288 user's name.
14289
14290 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14291 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14292 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14293 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14294 .code
14295 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14296 gecos_name = $1
14297 .endd
14298
14299 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14300 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14301
14302
14303 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14304 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14305 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14306 implementations of TLS.
14307
14308
14309 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14310 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14311 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14312
14313 See
14314 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14315 for documentation.
14316
14317
14318
14319 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14320 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14321 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14322 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14323 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14324 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14325
14326
14327
14328 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14329 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14330 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14331 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14332 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14333 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14334 sections are rejected.
14335
14336
14337 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14338 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14339 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14340 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14341 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14342 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14343 zero means &"no limit"&.
14344
14345
14346
14347
14348 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14349 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14350 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14351 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14352 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14353 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14354 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14355 if you want to do semantic checking.
14356 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14357 set.
14358
14359
14360 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14361 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14362 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14363 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14364 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14365 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14366 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14367 .code
14368 helo_allow_chars = _
14369 .endd
14370 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14371
14372
14373 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14374 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14375 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14376 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14377 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14378 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14379 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14380 do.
14381
14382
14383 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14384 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14385 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14386 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14387 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14388 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14389 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14390 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14391 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14392 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14393 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14394 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14395
14396 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14397 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14398 EHLO command either:
14399
14400 .ilist
14401 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14402 .next
14403 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14404 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14405 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14406 calling host address, or
14407 .next
14408 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
14409 available) yields the calling host address.
14410 .endlist
14411
14412 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14413 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14414 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14415
14416 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14417 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14418 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14419 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14420 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14421 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14422 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14423 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14424 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14425 error.
14426
14427 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14428 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14429 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14430 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14431 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14432 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14433 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14434 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14435 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14436
14437 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14438 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14439 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14440 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14441 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14442
14443 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14444 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14445 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14446 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14447
14448
14449 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14450 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14451 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14452 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14453 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14454 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14455 default configuration file contains
14456 .code
14457 host_lookup = *
14458 .endd
14459 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14460 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14461
14462 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14463 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14464 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14465
14466 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14467 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14468 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14469 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14470 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14471 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14472
14473
14474 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14475 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14476 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14477 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14478 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14479 if you want.
14480
14481 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14482 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14483 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14484 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14485
14486
14487
14488 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14489 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14490 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14491 as soon as the connection is made.
14492 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14493 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14494 connections immediately.
14495
14496 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14497 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14498 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14499 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14500 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14501
14502
14503 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14504 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14505 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14506 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14507 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14508 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14509 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14510 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14511 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14512 .code
14513 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14514 .endd
14515 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14516
14517
14518
14519 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14520 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14521 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14522 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14523 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14524 records
14525 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14526 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14527
14528 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14529 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14530 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14531 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14532 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14533 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14534 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14535
14536
14537 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14538 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14539 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14540 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14541 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14542
14543
14544
14545 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14546 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14547 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14548 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14549 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14550 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14551
14552 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14553 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14554 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14555 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14556 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14557 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14558 for frozen messages. For example,
14559 .code
14560 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14561 .endd
14562 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14563 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14564 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14565 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14566 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14567 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14568
14569
14570 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14571 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14572 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14573 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14574 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14575 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14576 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14577 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14578 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14579 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14580
14581
14582 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14583 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14584
14585
14586 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14587 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14588 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14589 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14590 logged.
14591
14592
14593 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14594 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14595 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14596 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14597 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14598 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14599 and constrained to be a directory.
14600
14601
14602 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14603 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14604 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14605 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14606 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14607 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14608 and constrained to be a file.
14609
14610
14611 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14612 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14613 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14614 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14615 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14616
14617
14618 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14619 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14620 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14621 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14622 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14623 identity to be proven.
14624
14625
14626 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14627 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14628 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14629 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14630 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14631
14632
14633 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14634 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14635 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14636 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14637 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14638 with LDAP support.
14639
14640
14641 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14642 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14643 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14644 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14645 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14646 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14647 to hard/demand.
14648
14649
14650 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14651 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14652 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14653 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14654 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14655 of SSL-on-connect.
14656 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14657 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14658
14659
14660 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14661 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14662 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14663 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14664 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14665 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14666 has been built with LDAP support.
14667
14668
14669
14670 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14671 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14672 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14673 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14674 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14675 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14676 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14677
14678 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14679 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14680 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14681
14682 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14683 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14684 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14685 and the default qualify domain.
14686
14687 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14688 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14689 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14690 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14691
14692 .cindex "envelope sender"
14693 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14694 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14695 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14696
14697 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14698 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14699 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14700
14701
14702
14703
14704 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14705 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14706 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14707 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14708 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14709 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14710 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14711 example, if
14712 .code
14713 local_from_prefix = *-
14714 .endd
14715 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14716 .code
14717 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14718 .endd
14719 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14720 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14721 qualify domain.
14722
14723
14724 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14725 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14726
14727
14728 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14729 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14730 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14731 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14732 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14733 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14734 &%local_interfaces%& is
14735 .code
14736 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14737 .endd
14738 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14739 .code
14740 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14741 .endd
14742
14743 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14744 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14745 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14746 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14747 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14748 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14749 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14750 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14751
14752
14753
14754 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14755 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14756 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14757 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14758 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14759 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14760 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14761 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14762
14763
14764
14765
14766 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14767 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14768 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14769 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14770 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14771 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14772 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14773 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14774 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14775 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14776 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14777 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14778 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14779 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14780 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14781
14782
14783
14784 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14785 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14786 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14787 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14788 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14789 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14790 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14791 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14792 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14793 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14794 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14795 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14796 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14797 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14798
14799
14800 .option log_selector main string unset
14801 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14802 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14803 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14804 minus characters. For example:
14805 .code
14806 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14807 .endd
14808 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14809 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14810
14811
14812 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14813 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14814 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14815 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14816 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14817 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14818 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14819 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14820 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14821 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14822 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14823 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14824 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14825
14826
14827 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14828 .cindex "too many open files"
14829 .cindex "open files, too many"
14830 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14831 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14832 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14833 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14834 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14835 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14836 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14837 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14838 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14839 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14840 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14841 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14842
14843
14844 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14845 .cindex "length of login name"
14846 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14847 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14848 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14849 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14850 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14851 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14852
14853
14854 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14855 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14856 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14857 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14858 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14859 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14860 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14861 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14862
14863
14864 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14865 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14866 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14867 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14868 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14869 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14870 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14871
14872
14873 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14874 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14875 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14876 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14877 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14878 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14879 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14880 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14881 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14882 empty string, the option is ignored.
14883
14884
14885 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14886 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14887 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14888 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14889 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14890 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14891 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14892 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14893 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14894 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14895 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14896 colons will become hyphens.
14897
14898
14899 .option message_logs main boolean true
14900 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14901 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14902 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14903 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14904 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14905 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14906 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14907 which is not affected by this option.
14908
14909
14910 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14911 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14912 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14913 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14914 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14915 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14916 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14917 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14918 optionally followed by K or M.
14919
14920 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14921 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14922 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14923 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14924 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14925
14926 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14927 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14928 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14929 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14930 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14931 message that an individual transport can process.
14932
14933 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14934 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14935 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14936 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14937 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14938 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14939 some problems may result.
14940
14941 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14942 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14943 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14944
14945
14946 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14947 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14948 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14949 .code
14950 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14951 .endd
14952 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14953 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14954 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14955 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14956 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14957
14958
14959 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14960 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14961 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14962 contains a full description of this facility.
14963
14964
14965
14966 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14967 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14968 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14969 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14970 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14971
14972
14973 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14974 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14975 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14976 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14977 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14978 safety precaution.
14979
14980 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14981 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14982 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14983 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14984 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14985
14986 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14987 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14988 example is
14989 .code
14990 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14991 .endd
14992 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14993 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14994 transport driver.
14995
14996
14997 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
14998 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14999 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15000 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15001 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15002
15003 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15004 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15005 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15006 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15007 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15008 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15009 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15010
15011 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15012 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15013 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15014 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15015 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15016
15017 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15018 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15019 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15020 some now infamous attacks.
15021
15022 An example:
15023 .code
15024 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15025 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15026 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15027 .endd
15028
15029 Possible options may include:
15030 .ilist
15031 &`all`&
15032 .next
15033 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15034 .next
15035 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15036 .next
15037 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15038 .next
15039 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15040 .next
15041 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15042 .next
15043 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15044 .next
15045 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15046 .next
15047 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15048 .next
15049 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15050 .next
15051 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15052 .next
15053 &`no_compression`&
15054 .next
15055 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15056 .next
15057 &`no_sslv2`&
15058 .next
15059 &`no_sslv3`&
15060 .next
15061 &`no_ticket`&
15062 .next
15063 &`no_tlsv1`&
15064 .next
15065 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15066 .next
15067 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15068 .next
15069 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15070 .next
15071 &`single_dh_use`&
15072 .next
15073 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15074 .next
15075 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15076 .next
15077 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15078 .next
15079 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15080 .next
15081 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15082 .next
15083 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15084 .endlist
15085
15086 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15087 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15088 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15089 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15090 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15091 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15092
15093
15094 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15095 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15096 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15097 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15098 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15099
15100
15101 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15102 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15103 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15104 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15105 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15106 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15107 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15108 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15109 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15110 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15111 an ACL.
15112
15113 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15114 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15115 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15116 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15117 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15118 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15119 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15120
15121
15122 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15123 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15124 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15125
15126
15127 .option perl_startup main string unset
15128 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15129 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15130
15131
15132 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15133 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15134 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15135 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15136 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15137 PostgreSQL support.
15138
15139
15140 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15141 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15142 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15143 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15144 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15145 to the host name:
15146 .code
15147 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15148 .endd
15149 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15150 spool directory.
15151 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15152 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15153 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15154
15155
15156 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15157 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15158 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15159 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15160 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15161 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15162 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15163 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15164 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15165
15166
15167 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15168 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15169 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15170 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15171 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15172 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15173 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15174 is recieved. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15175
15176 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15177 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15178 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15179 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15180 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15181 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15182 volume of mail. Use with care!
15183
15184
15185 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15186 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15187 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15188 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15189 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15190 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15191 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15192 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15193 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15194 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15195
15196 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15197 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15198 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15199 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15200 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15201 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15202
15203
15204 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15205 .cindex "printing characters"
15206 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15207 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15208 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15209 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15210 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15211 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15212 characters.
15213
15214 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15215 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15216 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15217 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15218 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15219 standards.
15220
15221
15222 .option process_log_path main string unset
15223 .cindex "process log path"
15224 .cindex "log" "process log"
15225 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15226 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15227 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15228 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15229 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15230 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15231 different spool directories.
15232
15233
15234 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15235 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15236 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15237 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15238 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15239 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15240 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15241
15242
15243 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15244 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15245 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15246 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15247 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15248 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15249 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15250 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15251 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15252
15253 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15254 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15255 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15256 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15257 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15258 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15259 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15260
15261
15262 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15263 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15264 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15265
15266
15267
15268 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15269 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15270 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15271 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15272 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15273 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15274 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15275 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15276
15277
15278 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15279 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15280 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15281 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15282 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15283
15284
15285 .option queue_only main boolean false
15286 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15287 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15288 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15289 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15290 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15291 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15292
15293 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15294 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15295 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15296 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15297
15298
15299 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15300 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15301 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15302 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15303 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15304 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15305 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15306 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15307 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15308 .code
15309 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15310 .endd
15311 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15312 &_/some/file_& exists.
15313
15314
15315 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15316 .cindex "load average"
15317 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15318 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15319 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15320 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15321 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15322 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15323 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15324 false.
15325
15326 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15327 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15328 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15329 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15330
15331
15332 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15333 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15334 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15335 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15336 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15337 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15338 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15339 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15340 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15341 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15342 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15343 re-evaluated for each message.
15344
15345
15346 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15347 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15348 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15349 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15350 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15351 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15352
15353
15354 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15355 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15356 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15357 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15358 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15359 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15360 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15361 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15362 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15363 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15364 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15365 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15366 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15367
15368
15369
15370 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15371 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15372 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15373 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15374 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15375 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15376 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15377 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15378 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15379
15380 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15381 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15382 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15383 the daemon's command line.
15384
15385 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15386 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15387 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15388 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15389 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15390 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15391 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15392 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15393 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15394 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15395 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15396 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15397 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15398 &%queue_domains%&.
15399
15400
15401 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15402 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15403 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15404 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15405 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15406 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15407 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15408
15409 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15410 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15411 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15412 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15413 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15414 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15415 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15416 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15417 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15418 header lines. The default setting is:
15419
15420 .code
15421 received_header_text = Received: \
15422 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15423 {${if def:sender_ident \
15424 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15425 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15426 by $primary_hostname \
15427 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15428 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15429 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15430 ${if def:sender_address \
15431 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15432 id $message_exim_id\
15433 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15434 .endd
15435
15436 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15437 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15438 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15439 header lines such as the following:
15440 .code
15441 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15442 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15443 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15444 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15445 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15446 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15447 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15448 .endd
15449 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15450 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15451 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15452 message was accepted.
15453
15454
15455 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15456 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15457 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15458 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15459 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15460 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15461 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15462 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15463
15464
15465 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15466 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15467 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15468 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15469 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15470 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15471 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15472 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15473 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15474 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15475 option was not set.
15476
15477
15478 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15479 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15480 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15481 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15482 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15483 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15484 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15485 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15486 done.
15487
15488 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15489 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15490 RCPT commands in a single message.
15491
15492
15493 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15494 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15495 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15496 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15497 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15498 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15499 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15500
15501
15502 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15503 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15504 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15505 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15506 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15507 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15508 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15509 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15510 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15511 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15512 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15513 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15514 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15515 tagged with its process id.
15516
15517 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15518 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15519 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15520 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15521 is received.
15522
15523 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15524 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15525 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15526 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15527 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15528 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15529 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15530 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15531 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15532 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15533 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15534
15535 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15536 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15537 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15538 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15539
15540
15541 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15542 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15543 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15544 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15545 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15546 .code
15547 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15548 .endd
15549 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15550 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15551
15552
15553 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15554 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15555 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15556 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15557 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15558 past failures.
15559
15560
15561 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15562 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15563 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15564 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15565 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15566 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15567 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15568 the default value.
15569
15570
15571 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15572 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15573 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15574 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15575 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15576 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15577 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15578 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15579 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15580 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15581
15582
15583 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15584 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15585
15586
15587 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15588 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15589 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15590 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15591 in the list.
15592
15593 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15594 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15595 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15596 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15597 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15598
15599
15600 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15601 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15602 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15603 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15604 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15605 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15606 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15607 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15608 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15609 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15610
15611
15612 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15613 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15614 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15615 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15616 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15617 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15618 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15619 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15620 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15621 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15622 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15623
15624
15625
15626 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15627 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15628 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15629 .cindex "inetd"
15630 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15631 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15632 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15633 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15634 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15635 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15636
15637 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15638 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15639 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15640 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15641
15642
15643 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15644 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15645 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15646 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15647 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15648 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15649 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15650 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15651
15652 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15653 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15654 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15655 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15656 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15657 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15658 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15659 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15660
15661
15662 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15663 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15664 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15665 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15666 live with.
15667
15668
15669 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15670 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15671 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15672 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15673 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15674 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15675 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15676 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15677 . the option name to split.
15678
15679 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15680 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15681 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15682 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15683 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15684 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15685 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15686 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15687 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15688 seen).
15689
15690
15691 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15692 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15693 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15694 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15695 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15696 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15697 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15698 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15699 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15700 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15701 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15702
15703 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15704 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15705 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15706 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15707 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15708 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15709
15710
15711
15712 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15713 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15714 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15715 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15716 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15717 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15718 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15719 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15720 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15721 to all messages received in the same connection.
15722
15723 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15724 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15725 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15726 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15727
15728
15729 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15730
15731 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15732 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15733 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15734 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15735 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15736 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15737 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15738 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15739 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15740 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15741 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15742 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15743 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15744
15745
15746 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15747 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15748 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15749 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15750 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15751 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15752 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15753 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15754 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15755 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15756 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15757 individual host.
15758
15759 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15760 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15761 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15762 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15763
15764
15765 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15766 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15767 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15768 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15769 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15770 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15771 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15772 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15773 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15774
15775 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15776 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15777 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15778 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15779
15780 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15781 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15782 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15783 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15784 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15785 For example:
15786 .code
15787 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15788 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15789 .endd
15790
15791 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15792 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15793 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15794 &%helo_data%& value.
15795
15796 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15797 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15798 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15799 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15800 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15801 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15802 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15803 .code
15804 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15805 $version_number $tod_full
15806 .endd
15807 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15808 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15809 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15810 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15811 multiline response).
15812
15813
15814 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15815 .cindex "checking disk space"
15816 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15817 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15818 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15819 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15820 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15821 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15822 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15823
15824
15825 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15826 .cindex "connection backlog"
15827 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15828 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15829 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15830 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15831 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15832 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15833 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15834 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15835 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15836 attacks by SYN flooding.
15837
15838
15839 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15840 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15841 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15842 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15843 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15844 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15845 fewer, but they still exist.
15846
15847 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15848 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15849 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15850 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15851 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15852 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15853 does detect many instances.
15854
15855 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15856 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15857 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15858 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15859
15860
15861
15862 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15863 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15864 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15865 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15866 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15867 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15868 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15869 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15870 example:
15871 .code
15872 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15873 $sender_host_address
15874 .endd
15875 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15876 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15877 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15878 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15879 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15880 the command.
15881
15882
15883 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15884 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15885 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15886 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15887 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15888
15889
15890 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15891 .cindex "load average"
15892 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15893 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15894 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15895 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15896 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15897 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15898
15899
15900
15901 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15902 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15903 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15904 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15905 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15906 .code
15907 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15908 .endd
15909 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15910 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15911 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15912 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15913 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15914
15915 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15916 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15917 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15918 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15919 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15920 not count towards the limit.
15921
15922
15923
15924 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15925 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15926 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15927 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15928 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15929 that subvert web
15930 clients
15931 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15932 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15933
15934
15935
15936 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15937 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15938 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15939 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15940 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15941 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15942 recipients.
15943
15944 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15945 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15946 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15947 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15948
15949 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15950 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15951 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15952 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15953 values:
15954
15955 .ilist
15956 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15957 .next
15958 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15959 fractional parts are allowed here.
15960 .next
15961 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15962 .next
15963 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15964 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15965 .endlist
15966
15967 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15968 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15969 .code
15970 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15971 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15972 .endd
15973 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15974 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15975 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15976 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15977
15978
15979 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15980 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15981
15982
15983 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15984 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15985
15986
15987 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15988 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15989 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15990 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15991 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15992 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15993 the message is abandoned.
15994 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15995 .code
15996 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15997 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15998 .endd
15999 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16000 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16001
16002
16003 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16004 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16005 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16006 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16007 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16008 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16009
16010
16011 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16012 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16013 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16014
16015
16016 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16017 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16018 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16019 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16020 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16021 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16022 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16023 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16024 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16025 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16026 .code
16027 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16028 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16029 .endd
16030
16031 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16032 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16033 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16034 The default value is
16035 .code
16036 127.0.0.1 783
16037 .endd
16038 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16039
16040
16041
16042 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16043 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16044 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16045 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16046 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16047 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16048 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16049 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16050 arrival of the message.
16051
16052 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16053 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16054 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16055 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16056 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16057
16058 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16059 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16060 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16061 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16062 automatically deleted.
16063
16064 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16065 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16066 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16067 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16068 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16069 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16070 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16071 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16072 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16073
16074
16075 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16076 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16077 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16078 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16079 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16080 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16081 &$primary_hostname$&.
16082
16083 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16084 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16085 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16086 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16087 as failures in the configuration file.
16088
16089 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16090 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16091
16092 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16093 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16094 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16095 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16096
16097 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16098 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16099 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16100 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16101 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16102 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16103
16104 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16105 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16106 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16107 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16108 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16109 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16110 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16111
16112
16113 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16114 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16115 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16116 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16117 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16118 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16119 domain causes a syntax error.
16120 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16121 syntax checking.
16122
16123
16124 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16125 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16126 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16127 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16128 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16129 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16130 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16131 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16132 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16133 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16134 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16135 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16136
16137
16138 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16139 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16140 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16141 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16142 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16143 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16144 details of Exim's logging.
16145
16146
16147
16148 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16149 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16150 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16151 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16152 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16153
16154
16155
16156 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16157 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16158 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16159 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16160 details of Exim's logging.
16161
16162
16163 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16164 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16165 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16166 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16167 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16168 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16169 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16170 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16171 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16172 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16173 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16174
16175
16176 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16177 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16178 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16179 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16180 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16181 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16182
16183
16184 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16185 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16186 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16187 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16188 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16189
16190 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16191 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16192 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16193 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16194 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16195
16196 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16197 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16198 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16199 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16200 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16201 contains the pipe command.
16202
16203
16204 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16205 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16206 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16207 is used in a system filter.
16208
16209
16210 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16211 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16212 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16213 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16214 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16215 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16216 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16217 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16218 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16219 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16220
16221 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16222 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16223 transport option overrides.
16224
16225
16226 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16227 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16228 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16229 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16230 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16231 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16232 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16233 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16234 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16235 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16236 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16237 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16238 TCP_NODELAY.
16239
16240
16241 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16242 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16243 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16244 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16245 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16246 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16247 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16248 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16249 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16250 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16251
16252 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16253 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16254 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16255
16256
16257 .option timezone main string unset
16258 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16259 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16260 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16261 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16262 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16263 .code
16264 timezone = UTC
16265 .endd
16266 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16267 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16268 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16269 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16270 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16271 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16272
16273
16274 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16275 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16276 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16277 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16278 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16279 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16280 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16281 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16282
16283
16284 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16285 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16286 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16287 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16288 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16289 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16290 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16291
16292 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16293 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16294 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16295 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16296
16297 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16298 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16299 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16300 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16301
16302 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16303 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16304 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16305 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16306 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16307
16308 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16309
16310
16311 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16312 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16313 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16314 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16315 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16316 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16317
16318 The value must be at least 1024.
16319
16320 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16321 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16322 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16323
16324 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16325 number.
16326
16327 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16328 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16329 larger prime than requested.
16330
16331
16332 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16333 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16334 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16335 to be used by Exim.
16336
16337 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16338 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16339 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16340 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16341 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16342 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16343 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16344
16345 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16346 loaded by Exim.
16347
16348 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16349 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16350 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16351 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16352
16353 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16354 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16355 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16356 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16357
16358 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16359 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16360 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16361 "ike23".
16362
16363 The available primes are:
16364 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16365 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16366 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16367
16368 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16369 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16370
16371 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16372 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16373 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16374 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16375 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16376 userbase.
16377
16378 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16379 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16380 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16381 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16382 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16383 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16384 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16385
16386
16387 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16388 This option
16389 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16390 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16391 Certificate Authority.
16392
16393
16394 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16395 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16396 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16397 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16398 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16399
16400
16401
16402 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16403 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16404 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16405 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16406 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16407 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16408 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16409
16410 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16411
16412
16413 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16414 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16415 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16416 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16417 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16418 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16419 TLS session.
16420
16421
16422 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16423 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16424 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16425 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16426 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16427 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16428 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16429 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16430 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16431 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16432 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16433
16434
16435 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16436 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16437 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16438 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16439
16440
16441 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
16442 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16443 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16444 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
16445 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
16446 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
16447 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
16448 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
16449 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
16450
16451 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16452 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16453 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16454 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16455 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16456 use OpenSSL with a directory.
16457
16458 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16459
16460 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16461 being unset.
16462
16463
16464 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16465 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16466 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16467 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16468 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16469 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16470 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16471 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16472
16473 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16474 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16475 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16476 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16477 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16478 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16479 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16480
16481 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16482 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16483 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16484 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16485 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16486 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16487 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16488 certificate"&.
16489
16490 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16491 certificates.
16492
16493
16494 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16495 .cindex "trusted groups"
16496 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16497 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16498 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16499 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16500 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16501 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16502 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16503 are trusted.
16504
16505 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16506 .cindex "trusted users"
16507 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16508 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16509 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16510 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16511 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16512 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16513 Exim user are trusted.
16514
16515 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16516 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16517 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16518 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16519 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16520 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16521 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16522 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16523 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16524 &%-F%& option.
16525
16526 .option unknown_username main string unset
16527 See &%unknown_login%&.
16528
16529 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16530 .cindex "trusted users"
16531 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16532 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16533 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16534 .cindex "envelope sender"
16535 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16536 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16537 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16538 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16539 is used) is ignored.
16540
16541 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16542 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16543 .code
16544 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16545 .endd
16546 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16547 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16548 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16549 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16550 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16551 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16552 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16553 followed by a hyphen
16554 by a setting like this:
16555 .code
16556 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16557 .endd
16558 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16559 restriction, you can use
16560 .code
16561 untrusted_set_sender = *
16562 .endd
16563 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16564 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16565 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16566 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16567 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16568 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16569 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16570 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16571
16572 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16573 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16574 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16575 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16576 sender address.
16577
16578
16579 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16580 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16581 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16582 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16583 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16584 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16585 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16586 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16587 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16588 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16589 .code
16590 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16591 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16592 .endd
16593 The pattern can be seen by running
16594 .code
16595 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16596 .endd
16597 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16598 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16599 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16600 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16601 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16602 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16603
16604
16605 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16606 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16607
16608
16609 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16610 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16611 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16612 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16613 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16614 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16615 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16616 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16617
16618
16619 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16620 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16621 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16622 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16623 .ecindex IIDconfima
16624 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16625
16626
16627
16628
16629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16631
16632 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16633 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16634 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16635 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16636 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16637
16638 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16639 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16640 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16641 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16642 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16643
16644
16645
16646 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16647 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16648 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16649 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16650 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16651 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16652 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16653
16654 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16655 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16656 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16657 routers, and the eventual transport.
16658
16659 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16660 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16661 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16662 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16663 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16664
16665 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16666 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16667 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16668 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16669 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16670
16671 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16672 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16673 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16674 .code
16675 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16676 .endd
16677 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16678 .code
16679 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16680 .endd
16681 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16682 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16683
16684 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16685 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16686 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16687 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16688 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16689 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16690 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16691
16692
16693
16694 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16695 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
16696 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16697 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16698 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16699 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16700 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16701 routing.
16702
16703
16704
16705 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16706 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16707 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16708 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16709 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16710 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16711 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16712 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16713 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16714 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16715 you could put:
16716 .code
16717 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16718 .endd
16719 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16720 and
16721 .code
16722 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16723 .endd
16724 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16725 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16726 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16727 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16728
16729
16730 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16731 .cindex "case of local parts"
16732 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16733 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16734 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16735 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16736 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16737 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16738 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16739 more details.
16740
16741 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16742 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16743 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16744 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16745 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16746 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16747 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16748 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16749 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16750
16751 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16752 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16753 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16754 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16755
16756
16757
16758 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16759 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16760 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16761 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16762 .vindex "&$home$&"
16763 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16764 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16765 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16766 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16767 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16768 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16769 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16770 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16771 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16772 the router is skipped.
16773
16774 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16775 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16776 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16777 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16778 setting to achieve this. For example:
16779 .code
16780 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16781 .endd
16782 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16783 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16784 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16785
16786
16787
16788 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16789 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16790 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16791 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16792 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16793 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16794 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16795 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16796
16797 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16798 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16799
16800 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16801 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16802
16803 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16804 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16805 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16806 .code
16807 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16808 .endd
16809 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16810 .code
16811 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16812 .endd
16813
16814 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16815 .code
16816 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16817 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16818 condition = foobar
16819 .endd
16820
16821 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16822 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16823 be specified using &%condition%&.
16824
16825
16826 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16827 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16828 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16829 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
16830 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16831 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16832 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16833 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16834 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16835 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16836 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16837 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16838 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16839 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
16840
16841
16842
16843 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16844 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16845 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16846 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16847 transport option of the same name.
16848
16849
16850 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16851 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16852 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16853 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16854 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16855 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16856 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16857 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16858
16859
16860
16861 .option driver routers string unset
16862 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16863 to be used.
16864
16865
16866
16867 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16868 .cindex "envelope sender"
16869 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16870 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16871 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16872 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16873 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16874 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16875 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16876
16877 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16878 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16879 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16880 setting.
16881
16882 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16883 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16884 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16885 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16886
16887 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16888 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16889 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16890 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16891 settings:
16892 .code
16893 errors_to =
16894 errors_to = ""
16895 .endd
16896 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16897 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16898 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16899 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16900 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16901
16902 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16903 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16904 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16905 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16906 setting &%return_path%&.
16907
16908 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16909 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16910 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16911
16912
16913
16914 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16915 .cindex "address" "testing"
16916 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16917 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16918 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16919 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16920 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16921 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16922 on for the system alias file.
16923 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16924 are evaluated.
16925
16926 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16927 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16928 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16929
16930
16931
16932 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16933 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16934 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16935 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16936
16937
16938
16939 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16940 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16941 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16942
16943
16944
16945 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16946 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16947 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16948
16949
16950
16951 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16952 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16953 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16954 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16955 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16956 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16957 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16958 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16959 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16960
16961 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16962 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16963 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16964 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16965 transport for further details.
16966
16967
16968 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16969 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16970 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16971 .cindex "transport" "local"
16972 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16973 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16974 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16975 process.
16976 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16977 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16978 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16979 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16980 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16981
16982
16983
16984 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
16985 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16986 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16987 This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
16988 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
16989 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
16990 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16991 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16992 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16993 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16994 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16995 &"see"& the added header lines.
16996
16997 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16998 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
16999 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17000 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17001
17002 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17003 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17004
17005 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17006 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17007
17008 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17009 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17010 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17011 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17012 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17013 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17014 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17015 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17016 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17017 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17018
17019
17020
17021 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17022 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17023 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17024 This option specifies a list of text headers, colon-separated,
17025 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17026 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17027 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17028 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17029 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17030 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17031 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17032 &"see"& the original header lines.
17033
17034 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17035 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17036 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17037 errors.
17038
17039 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17040 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17041
17042 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17043 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17044
17045 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17046 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17047 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17048 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17049
17050
17051 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17052 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17053 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17054 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17055 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17056 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17057 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17058 like
17059 .code
17060 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17061 .endd
17062 by setting
17063 .code
17064 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17065 .endd
17066 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17067 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17068 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17069 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17070 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17071 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17072
17073 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17074 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17075 .code
17076 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17077 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17078 .endd
17079 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17080 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17081
17082 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17083 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17084 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17085 domain that is being routed.
17086
17087 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17088 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17089 checked.
17090
17091 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17092 .cindex "additional groups"
17093 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17094 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17095 .cindex "transport" "local"
17096 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17097 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17098 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17099 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17100 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17101
17102
17103
17104 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17105 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17106 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17107 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17108 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17109 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17110 evaluated.
17111
17112 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17113 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17114 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17115 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17116 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17117 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17118 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17119 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17120 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17121
17122 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17123 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17124 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17125 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17126 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17127 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17128 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17129 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17130 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17131 the relevant transport.
17132
17133 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17134 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17135 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17136 callout.
17137
17138 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17139 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17140 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17141 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17142 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17143 .code
17144 real_localuser:
17145 driver = accept
17146 local_part_prefix = real-
17147 check_local_user
17148 transport = local_delivery
17149 .endd
17150 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17151 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17152 .code
17153 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17154 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17155 .endd
17156
17157 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17158 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17159 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17160 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17161
17162
17163 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17164 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17165
17166
17167
17168 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17169 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17170 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17171 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17172 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17173 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17174 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17175 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17176 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17177 &%username-foo%&.
17178
17179
17180 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17181 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17182
17183
17184
17185 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17186 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17187 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17188 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17189 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17190 are evaluated, and
17191 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17192 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17193 example:
17194 .code
17195 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17196 .endd
17197 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17198 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17199 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17200 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17201 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17202 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17203 each virtual domain:
17204 .code
17205 postmaster:
17206 driver = redirect
17207 local_parts = postmaster
17208 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17209 .endd
17210
17211
17212 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17213 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17214 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17215 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17216 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17217 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17218 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17219 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17220 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17221 redirect addresses.
17222
17223
17224
17225 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17226 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17227 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17228 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17229 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17230 delivery to be deferred.
17231
17232 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17233 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17234 .oindex "&%self%&"
17235 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17236 means of the setting
17237 .code
17238 self = pass
17239 .endd
17240 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17241 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17242 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17243
17244 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17245 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17246 controls what happens next.
17247
17248
17249 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17250 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17251 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17252 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17253 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17254 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17255 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17256 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17257
17258 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17259 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17260 applies to all of them.
17261
17262
17263
17264 .option pass_router routers string unset
17265 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17266 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17267 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17268 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17269 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17270 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17271 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17272 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17273 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17274 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17275
17276
17277
17278 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17279 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17280 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17281 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17282 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17283 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17284
17285 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17286 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17287 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17288 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17289
17290
17291
17292 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17293 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17294 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17295 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17296 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17297 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17298 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17299
17300 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17301 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17302 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17303 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17304
17305 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17306 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17307 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17308 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17309 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17310
17311 .cindex "NFS"
17312 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17313 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17314 unavailable.
17315
17316 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17317 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17318 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17319 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17320 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17321 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17322 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17323 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17324
17325 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17326 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17327 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17328 operates as follows:
17329
17330 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17331 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17332 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17333 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17334 used. For example:
17335 .code
17336 require_files = mail:/some/file
17337 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17338 .endd
17339 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17340 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17341
17342 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17343 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17344 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17345 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17346
17347 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17348 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17349 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17350 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17351 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17352
17353 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17354 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17355 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17356 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17357 check again in that process.
17358
17359 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17360 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17361 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17362 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17363 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17364 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17365 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17366 .code
17367 require_files = +/some/file
17368 .endd
17369 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17370 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17371 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17372
17373
17374
17375 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17376 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17377 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17378 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17379 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17380 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17381 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17382 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17383 latter kind.
17384
17385 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17386 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17387 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17388 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17389 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17390 same name.
17391
17392 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17393 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17394 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17395
17396
17397
17398 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17399 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17400 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17401 .vindex "&$home$&"
17402 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17403 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17404 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17405 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17406 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17407 cause the router to defer.
17408
17409 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17410 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17411 place.
17412 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17413 are evaluated.)
17414 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17415 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17416
17417 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17418 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17419 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17420 of these values that is set:
17421
17422 .ilist
17423 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17424 .next
17425 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17426 .next
17427 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17428 .next
17429 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17430 .endlist
17431
17432 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17433 router, but not for the transport.
17434
17435
17436
17437 .option self routers string freeze
17438 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17439 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17440 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17441 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17442 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17443 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17444 of remote hosts.
17445 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17446 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17447 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17448 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17449 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17450
17451 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17452 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17453 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17454 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17455 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17456 cases:
17457
17458 .vlist
17459 .vitem &%defer%&
17460 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17461
17462 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17463 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17464 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17465 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17466
17467 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17468 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17469 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17470 rewritten.
17471
17472 .vitem &%pass%&
17473 .oindex "&%more%&"
17474 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17475 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17476 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17477 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17478 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17479 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17480 combination
17481 .code
17482 self = pass
17483 no_more
17484 .endd
17485 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17486 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17487 be passed to the next router.
17488
17489 .vitem &%fail%&
17490 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17491
17492 .vitem &%send%&
17493 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17494 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17495 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17496 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17497 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17498 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17499 .endlist
17500
17501
17502
17503 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17504 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17505 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17506 address matches something on the list.
17507 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17508 are evaluated.
17509
17510 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17511 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17512 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17513 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17514 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17515 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17516 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17517 matters.
17518
17519
17520 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17521 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17522 .cindex "packet radio"
17523 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17524 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17525 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17526 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17527 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17528 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17529 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17530 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17531
17532 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17533 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17534 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17535 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17536 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17537 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17538 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17539 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17540 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17541 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17542 .code
17543 translate_ip_address = \
17544 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17545 {$value}fail}}
17546 .endd
17547 The file would contain lines like
17548 .code
17549 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17550 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17551 .endd
17552 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17553 are doing.
17554
17555
17556
17557 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17558 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17559 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17560 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17561 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17562 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17563 delivery is deferred.
17564
17565 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17566 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17567 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17568
17569
17570
17571 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17572 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17573 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17574 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17575 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17576 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17577 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17578 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17579 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17580 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17581 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17582 environment.
17583
17584
17585
17586
17587 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17588 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17589 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17590 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17591 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17592 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17593 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17594 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17595 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17596 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17597
17598 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17599 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17600 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17601 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17602 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17603
17604 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17605 environment.
17606
17607
17608
17609
17610 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17611 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17612 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17613 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17614 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17615 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17616 delivery to be deferred.
17617
17618 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17619 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17620 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17621 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17622 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17623 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17624
17625 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17626 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17627 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17628 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17629 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17630 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17631 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17632 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17633
17634 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17635 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17636 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17637 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17638 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17639 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17640 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17641 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17642 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17643 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17644
17645 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17646 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17647 subsequent routers.
17648
17649
17650 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17651 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17652 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17653 .cindex "transport" "local"
17654 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17655 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17656 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17657 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17658 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17659 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17660 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17661 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17662 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17663 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17664 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17665 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17666
17667
17668
17669 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17670 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17671 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17672
17673
17674 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17675 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17676 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
17677 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17678 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
17679 delivering in cutthrough mode or
17680 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17681 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17682 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17683 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17684
17685 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17686 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17687 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17688 user or group.
17689
17690
17691 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17692 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17693 addresses,
17694 delivering in cutthrough mode
17695 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17696 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17697 are evaluated.
17698
17699
17700 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17701 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17702 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17703 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17704 are evaluated.
17705 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17706 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17707
17708
17709
17710
17711
17712
17713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17714 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17715
17716 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17717 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17718 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17719 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17720 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17721 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17722 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17723 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17724 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17725 .code
17726 localusers:
17727 driver = accept
17728 domains = mydomain.example
17729 check_local_user
17730 transport = local_delivery
17731 .endd
17732 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17733 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17734 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17735 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17736
17737
17738
17739
17740
17741
17742 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17744
17745 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17746 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17747 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17748 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17749 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17750 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17751
17752 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17753 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17754 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17755 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17756 records.
17757
17758 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17759 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17760 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17761 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17762 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17763 generic option, the router declines.
17764
17765 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17766 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17767 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17768
17769 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17770 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17771 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17772 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17773 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17774 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17775
17776
17777 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17778 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17779 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17780 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17781 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17782 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17783
17784 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17785 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17786 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17787 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17788 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17789 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17790 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17791 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17792 case routing fails.
17793
17794
17795 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17796 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17797 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17798 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17799 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17800
17801 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17802 .ilist
17803 The domain does not exist in DNS
17804 .next
17805 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17806 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17807 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17808 .next
17809 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17810 .next
17811 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17812 .next
17813 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17814 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17815 .next
17816 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17817 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17818 .next
17819 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17820 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17821 .next
17822 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17823 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17824 .endlist
17825
17826
17827
17828
17829 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17830 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17831 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17832
17833 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17834 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17835 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17836 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17837 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17838 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17839 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17840
17841
17842 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17843 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17844 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17845 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17846 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17847 required. For example,
17848 .code
17849 check_srv = smtp
17850 .endd
17851 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17852 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17853 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17854 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17855 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17856 normal way.
17857
17858 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17859 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17860 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17861 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17862 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17863 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17864
17865 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17866 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17867 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17868 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17869 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17870 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17871 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17872 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17873
17874 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17875 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17876
17877
17878
17879 .option dnssec_request_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17880 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17881 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17882 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17883 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17884 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17885 the dnssec request bit set.
17886 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17887
17888
17889
17890 .option dnssec_require_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17891 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17892 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17893 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17894 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17895 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17896 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17897 (AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17898 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17899
17900
17901
17902 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17903 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17904 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17905 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17906 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17907 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17908 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17909 setting:
17910 .code
17911 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17912 .endd
17913 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17914 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17915 the address record.
17916
17917
17918 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17919 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17920 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17921 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17922
17923
17924
17925
17926 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17927 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17928 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17929 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17930 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17931 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17932 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17933 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17934 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17935 &'resolv.conf'&.
17936
17937
17938
17939 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17940 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17941 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17942 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17943 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17944 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17945 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17946 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17947 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17948 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17949 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17950
17951 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17952 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17953 sense.
17954
17955 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17956 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17957 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17958 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17959 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17960 header rewriting.
17961
17962
17963 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17964 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17965 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17966 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17967 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17968 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17969 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17970 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17971
17972 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17973 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17974 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17975 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17976 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17977 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17978 without processing them independently,
17979 provided the following conditions are met:
17980
17981 .ilist
17982 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17983 &%headers_remove%&.
17984 .next
17985 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17986 the domain.
17987 .endlist
17988
17989
17990
17991
17992 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17993 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17994 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17995 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17996 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17997 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17998 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17999 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18000 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18001 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18002
18003 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18004 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18005 local wildcard.
18006
18007
18008
18009 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18010 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18011 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18012 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18013
18014
18015
18016
18017 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18018 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18019 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18020 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18021 if
18022 .code
18023 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18024 .endd
18025 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18026 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18027 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18028 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18029 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18030 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18031
18032
18033 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18034 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18035 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18036 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18037 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18038
18039 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18040 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18041 such as that implied by
18042 .code
18043 domains = @mx_any
18044 .endd
18045 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18046 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18047 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18048 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18049
18050
18051
18052
18053
18054
18055
18056
18057
18058 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18059 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18060
18061 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18062 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18063 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18064 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18065 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18066 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18067 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18068 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18069 router handles the address
18070 .code
18071 root@[192.168.1.1]
18072 .endd
18073 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18074 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18075 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18076 .code
18077 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18078 .endd
18079 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18080 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18081
18082 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18083 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18084 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18085 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18086
18087 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18088 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18089 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18090 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18091
18092
18093
18094 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18095 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18096
18097 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18098 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18099 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18100 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18101 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18102 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18103 must set
18104 .code
18105 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18106 .endd
18107 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18108
18109 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18110 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18111 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18112 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18113 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18114 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18115 must not be specified for it.
18116
18117 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18118 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18119 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18120 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18121 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18122 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18123 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18124
18125
18126 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18127 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18128 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18129 delivery to the address is deferred.
18130
18131
18132 .option port iplookup integer 0
18133 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18134 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18135 call.
18136
18137
18138 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18139 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18140 protocols is to be used.
18141
18142
18143 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18144 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18145 default value is:
18146 .code
18147 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18148 .endd
18149 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18150 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18151
18152
18153 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18154 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18155 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18156 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18157 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18158 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18159 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18160 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18161
18162
18163 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18164 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18165 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18166 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18167 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18168 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18169 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18170 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18171 following could be used:
18172 .code
18173 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18174 reroute = $local_part@$1
18175 .endd
18176
18177 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18178 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18179 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18180 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18181
18182
18183
18184
18185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18186 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18187
18188 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18189 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18190 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18191 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18192 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18193 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18194 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18195 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18196 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18197 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18198
18199 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18200 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18201 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18202 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18203 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18204 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18205 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18206
18207 .vindex "&$host$&"
18208 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18209 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18210 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18211 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18212 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18213 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18214 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18215 text string.
18216
18217 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18218 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18219 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18220 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18221 below, following the list of private options.
18222
18223
18224 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18225
18226 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18227 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18228
18229 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18230 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18231
18232 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18233 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18234 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18235 of the following values:
18236 .code
18237 decline
18238 defer
18239 fail
18240 freeze
18241 ignore
18242 pass
18243 .endd
18244 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18245 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18246 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18247 &%pass_router%&),
18248 .oindex "&%more%&"
18249 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18250 router only if &%more%& is true.
18251
18252 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18253 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18254 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18255 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18256
18257 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18258 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18259 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18260
18261
18262 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18263 .cindex "randomized host list"
18264 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18265 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18266 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18267 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18268 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18269 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18270 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18271 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18272
18273 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18274 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18275 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18276 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18277 .code
18278 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18279 .endd
18280 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18281 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18282 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18283 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18284 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18285
18286
18287 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18288 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18289 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18290 example:
18291 .code
18292 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18293 .endd
18294 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18295 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18296 deferred.
18297
18298
18299 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18300 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18301 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18302 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18303
18304
18305 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18306 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18307 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18308 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18309 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18310 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18311 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18312 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18313
18314 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18315 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18316 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18317 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18318 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18319 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18320 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18321 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18322
18323
18324
18325
18326 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18327 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18328 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18329 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18330 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18331 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18332 .display
18333 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18334 .endd
18335 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18336 no options:
18337 .code
18338 route_list = \
18339 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18340 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18341 .endd
18342 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18343 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18344 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18345 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18346 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18347 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18348 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18349 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18350 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18351 in a &%route_list%&).
18352
18353 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18354 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18355 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18356 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18357
18358
18359
18360 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18361 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18362 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18363 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18364 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18365 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18366 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18367 like this:
18368 .code
18369 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18370 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18371 .endd
18372 This data can be accessed by setting
18373 .code
18374 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18375 .endd
18376 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18377 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18378 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18379 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18380 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18381
18382
18383
18384
18385 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18386 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18387 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18388 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18389 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18390 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18391 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18392
18393 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18394 variables are set during its expansion:
18395
18396 .ilist
18397 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18398 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18399 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18400 .code
18401 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18402 .endd
18403 .next
18404 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18405 .next
18406 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18407
18408 .next
18409 .vindex "&$value$&"
18410 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18411 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18412 .code
18413 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18414 .endd
18415 .endlist
18416
18417 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18418 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18419
18420
18421
18422 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18423 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18424 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18425 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18426 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18427 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18428
18429 .ilist
18430 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18431 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18432 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18433 .code
18434 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18435 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18436 .endd
18437 .next
18438 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18439 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18440 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18441 number follows. For example:
18442 .code
18443 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18444 .endd
18445 .endlist
18446
18447 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18448 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18449 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18450 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18451 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18452 transport.
18453
18454 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18455 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18456 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18457 records in the DNS. For example:
18458 .code
18459 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18460 .endd
18461 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18462 example:
18463 .code
18464 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18465 .endd
18466 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18467 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18468 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18469 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18470 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18471 happens is controlled by the
18472 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18473 &%self%& option of the router.
18474
18475 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18476 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18477 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18478 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18479 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18480 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18481 defined by MX preferences.
18482
18483 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18484 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18485 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18486
18487 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18488 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18489 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18490 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18491
18492 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18493 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18494 router.
18495
18496 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18497 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18498 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18499
18500 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18501 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18502
18503
18504
18505 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18506 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18507 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18508 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18509 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18510 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18511 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18512
18513 .ilist
18514 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18515 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18516 .next
18517 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18518 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18519 .next
18520 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18521 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18522 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18523 .next
18524 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18525 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18526 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18527 .endlist
18528
18529 For example:
18530 .code
18531 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18532 domain2 host4:host5
18533 .endd
18534 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18535 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18536 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18537 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18538 call.
18539
18540 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18541 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18542 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18543 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18544 function called.
18545
18546
18547
18548 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18549 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18550
18551 .vindex "&$host$&"
18552 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18553 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18554
18555
18556
18557 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18558 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18559 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18560
18561 .ilist
18562 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18563 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18564 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18565 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18566 .code
18567 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18568 .endd
18569 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18570 your first router something like this:
18571 .code
18572 smart_route:
18573 driver = manualroute
18574 domains = !+local_domains
18575 transport = remote_smtp
18576 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18577 .endd
18578 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18579 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18580 they are tried in order
18581 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18582 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18583 .code
18584 smart_route:
18585 driver = manualroute
18586 transport = remote_smtp
18587 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18588 .endd
18589 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18590 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18591 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18592 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18593 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18594 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18595 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18596 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18597
18598 .next
18599 .cindex "mail hub example"
18600 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18601 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18602 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18603 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18604 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18605 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18606 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18607 lookup is easier to manage.
18608
18609 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18610 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18611 example:
18612 .code
18613 hub_route:
18614 driver = manualroute
18615 transport = remote_smtp
18616 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18617 .endd
18618 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18619 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18620 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18621 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18622 domain can be used to find the host:
18623 .code
18624 through_firewall:
18625 driver = manualroute
18626 transport = remote_smtp
18627 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18628 .endd
18629 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18630 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18631 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18632 next router.
18633
18634 .next
18635 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18636 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18637 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18638 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18639 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18640 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18641 .code
18642 save_in_file:
18643 driver = manualroute
18644 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18645 route_list = saved.domain.example
18646 .endd
18647 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18648 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18649 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18650 .code
18651 save_in_file:
18652 driver = manualroute
18653 route_list = \
18654 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18655 *.saved.domain2.example \
18656 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18657 batch_pipe
18658 .endd
18659 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18660 .vindex "&$host$&"
18661 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18662 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18663 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18664 the address if the lookup fails.
18665
18666 .next
18667 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18668 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18669 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18670 one way it can be done:
18671 .code
18672 # Transport
18673 uucp:
18674 driver = pipe
18675 user = nobody
18676 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18677 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18678 return_fail_output = true
18679
18680 # Router
18681 uucphost:
18682 transport = uucp
18683 driver = manualroute
18684 route_data = \
18685 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18686 .endd
18687 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18688 .code
18689 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18690 .endd
18691 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18692 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18693 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18694 .endlist
18695 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18696 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18697
18698
18699
18700
18701
18702
18703
18704
18705 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18706 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18707
18708 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18709 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18710 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18711 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18712 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18713 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18714 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18715 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18716 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18717 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18718 options:
18719 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18720
18721 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18722 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18723 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18724 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18725 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18726
18727
18728 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18729 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18730 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18731 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18732 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18733 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18734
18735
18736 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18737 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18738 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18739 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18740 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18741 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18742 not set, a value for the gid also.
18743
18744 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18745 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18746 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18747 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18748 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18749 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18750 gid.
18751
18752
18753 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18754 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18755 before running the command.
18756
18757
18758 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18759 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18760 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18761 timeout.
18762
18763
18764 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18765 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18766 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18767 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18768 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18769
18770 .ilist
18771 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18772 below).
18773 .next
18774 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18775 &%no_more%& is set.
18776 .next
18777 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18778 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18779 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18780 included in the SMTP response.
18781 .next
18782 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18783 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18784 included in any SMTP response.
18785 .next
18786 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18787 .next
18788 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18789 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18790 .next
18791 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18792 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18793 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18794 .endlist
18795
18796 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18797 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18798 the page):
18799 .code
18800 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18801 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18802 .endd
18803 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18804 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18805 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18806 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18807
18808 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18809 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18810 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18811 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18812 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18813
18814 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18815 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18816 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18817 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18818 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18819
18820 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18821 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18822 variable. For example, this return line
18823 .code
18824 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18825 .endd
18826 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18827 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18828 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18829 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18830
18831
18832
18833
18834 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18836
18837 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18838 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18839 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18840 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18841 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18842 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18843 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18844 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18845 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18846 redirected in several different ways:
18847
18848 .ilist
18849 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18850 independently.
18851 .next
18852 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18853 .next
18854 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18855 .next
18856 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18857 .next
18858 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18859 .next
18860 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18861 .next
18862 It can be discarded.
18863 .endlist
18864
18865 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18866 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18867 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18868 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18869
18870
18871
18872 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18873 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18874 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18875 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18876 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18877 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18878 .code
18879 system_aliases:
18880 driver = redirect
18881 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18882 .endd
18883 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18884 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18885 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18886 cause delivery to be deferred.
18887
18888 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18889 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18890 .code
18891 userforward:
18892 driver = redirect
18893 check_local_user
18894 file = $home/.forward
18895 no_verify
18896 .endd
18897 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18898 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18899 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18900 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18901 comments.
18902
18903
18904
18905 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18906 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18907 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18908 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18909
18910 .ilist
18911 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18912 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18913 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18914 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18915 .next
18916 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18917 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18918 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18919 saves some resources.
18920 .endlist
18921
18922
18923
18924
18925
18926
18927 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18928 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18929 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18930 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18931 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18932
18933 .ilist
18934 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18935 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18936 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18937 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18938 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18939 document is intended for use by end users.
18940 .next
18941 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18942 described in the next section.
18943 .endlist
18944
18945 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18946 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18947 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18948 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18949 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18950
18951
18952
18953 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18954 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18955 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18956 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18957 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18958 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18959 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18960 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18961 commas or newlines.
18962 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18963 quotes.
18964
18965 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18966 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18967 next newline character is ignored.
18968
18969 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18970 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18971 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18972 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18973 removed.
18974
18975 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18976 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18977 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18978 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18979 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18980 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18981 setting:
18982 .code
18983 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18984 .endd
18985
18986
18987 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18988 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18989 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18990 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18991 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18992 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18993 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18994 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18995 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18996 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18997 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18998
18999 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19000 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19001 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19002 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19003 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19004 .code
19005 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19006 .endd
19007 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19008 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19009 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19010 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19011 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19012 synonymously.
19013
19014 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19015 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19016 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19017 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19018 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19019
19020 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19021 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19022 contains:
19023 .code
19024 Sam.Reman: spqr
19025 .endd
19026 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19027 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19028 this forward file:
19029 .code
19030 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19031 .endd
19032 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19033 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19034 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19035 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19036 should really contain
19037 .code
19038 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19039 .endd
19040 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19041 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19042 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19043
19044
19045
19046 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19047 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19048 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19049
19050 .ilist
19051 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19052 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19053 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19054 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19055 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19056 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19057 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19058
19059 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19060 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19061 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19062 in double quotes, for example:
19063 .code
19064 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19065 .endd
19066 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19067 quote just the command. An item such as
19068 .code
19069 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19070 .endd
19071 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19072
19073 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19074 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19075 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19076 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19077 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19078 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19079 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19080 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19081 an &%accept%& router.
19082
19083 .next
19084 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19085 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19086 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19087 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19088 .code
19089 /home/world/minbari
19090 .endd
19091 is treated as a file name, but
19092 .code
19093 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19094 .endd
19095 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19096 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19097 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19098 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19099
19100 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19101 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19102
19103 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19104 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19105 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19106 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19107
19108 .next
19109 .cindex "included address list"
19110 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19111 If an item is of the form
19112 .code
19113 :include:<path name>
19114 .endd
19115 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19116 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19117 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19118 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19119 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19120 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19121 .code
19122 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19123 .endd
19124 It must be given as
19125 .code
19126 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19127 .endd
19128 .next
19129 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19130 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19131 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19132 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19133 .cindex "black hole"
19134 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19135 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19136 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
19137 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19138
19139 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19140 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19141 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19142 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19143 &_/dev/null_&.
19144
19145 .next
19146 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19147 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19148 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19149 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19150 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19151 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19152 redirection items of the form
19153 .code
19154 :defer:
19155 :fail:
19156 .endd
19157 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19158 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19159 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19160 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19161 .code
19162 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19163 .endd
19164 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19165 of a
19166 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19167 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19168 default.
19169 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19170 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19171 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19172
19173 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19174 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19175 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19176 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19177 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19178 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19179 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19180 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19181 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19182 ignored.
19183
19184 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19185 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19186 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19187 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19188
19189 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19190 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19191 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19192 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19193 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19194
19195 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19196 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19197 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19198 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19199 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19200 rules still apply.
19201
19202 .next
19203 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19204 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19205 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19206 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19207 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19208 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19209 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19210 .endlist
19211
19212
19213 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19214 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19215 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19216 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19217 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19218 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19219 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19220 aliasing scheme of the type
19221 .code
19222 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19223 localpart1: pipe
19224 localpart2: pipe
19225 .endd
19226 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19227 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19228 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19229 such as
19230 .code
19231 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19232 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19233 .endd
19234 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19235 the pipes are distinct.
19236
19237
19238
19239 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19240 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19241 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19242 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19243 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19244 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19245 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19246 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19247 can be used to avoid this.
19248
19249
19250 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19251 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19252 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19253 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19254 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19255 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19256 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19257
19258
19259
19260 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19261
19262 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19263 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19264
19265
19266 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19267 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19268 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19269
19270
19271 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19272 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19273 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19274 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19275
19276
19277 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19278 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19279 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19280 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19281 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19282 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19283 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19284
19285 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19286 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19287
19288
19289 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19290 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19291 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19292 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19293 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19294
19295
19296
19297 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19298 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19299 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19300 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19301 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19302 let ordinary users do.
19303
19304
19305
19306 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19307 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19308 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19309 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19310 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19311 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19312
19313 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19314 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19315 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19316 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19317 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19318 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19319 .code
19320 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19321 .endd
19322 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19323 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19324 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19325 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19326 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19327 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19328 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19329 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19330
19331
19332 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19333 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19334 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19335 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19336 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19337 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19338 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19339 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19340
19341
19342
19343 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19344 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19345 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19346 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19347 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19348 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19349
19350
19351 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19352 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19353 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19354 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19355 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19356 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19357
19358 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19359 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19360 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19361 .code
19362 data = #Exim filter\n\
19363 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19364 .endd
19365 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19366 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19367 choice into a newline.
19368
19369
19370 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19371 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19372 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19373 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19374 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19375
19376
19377 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19378 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19379 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19380 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19381 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19382 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19383 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19384 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19385
19386 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19387 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19388 runs a check on the containing directory,
19389 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19390 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19391 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19392 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19393 not, the router declines.
19394
19395
19396 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19397 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19398 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19399 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19400 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19401 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19402 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19403
19404
19405 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19406 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19407 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19408 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19409 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19410
19411
19412 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19413 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19414 redirection list.
19415
19416
19417 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19418 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19419 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19420
19421
19422
19423
19424 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19425 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19426 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19427 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19428 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19429 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19430 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19431 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19432 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19433
19434
19435 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19436 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19437 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19438 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19439 functions.
19440
19441 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19442 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19443 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19444 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19445
19446 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19447 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19448 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19449 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19450 &_.forward_& files).
19451
19452
19453 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19454 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19455 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19456
19457
19458 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19459 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19460 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19461 of the embedded Perl support.
19462
19463
19464 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19465 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19466 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19467
19468
19469 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19470 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19471 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19472
19473
19474 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19475 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19476 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19477 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19478 &%one_time%& is set.
19479
19480
19481 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19482 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19483 to make use of &%run%& items.
19484
19485
19486 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19487 If this option is true, items of the form
19488 .code
19489 :include:<path name>
19490 .endd
19491 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19492
19493
19494 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19495 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19496 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19497 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19498 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19499
19500
19501 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19502 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19503 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19504
19505
19506 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19507 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19508 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19509 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19510 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19511
19512
19513
19514
19515 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19516 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19517 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19518 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19519 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19520 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19521 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19522
19523
19524 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19525 .cindex "EACCES"
19526 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19527 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19528 file did not exist.
19529
19530
19531 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19532 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19533 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19534 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19535 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19536
19537 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19538 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19539 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19540 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19541 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19542 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19543 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19544 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19545
19546
19547
19548 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19549 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19550 redirection list must start with this directory.
19551
19552
19553 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19554 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19555 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19556
19557
19558 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19559 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19560 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19561 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19562 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19563 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19564 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19565 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19566 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19567 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19568 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19569 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19570 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19571 before they subscribed.
19572
19573 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19574 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19575 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19576 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19577 attempt.
19578
19579 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19580 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19581 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19582 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19583
19584 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19585 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19586 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19587
19588 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19589 &%one_time%&.
19590
19591 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19592 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19593 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19594 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19595 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19596 expansion.
19597
19598
19599 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19600 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19601 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19602 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19603 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19604 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19605 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19606 See &%check_owner%& above.
19607
19608
19609 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19610 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19611 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19612 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19613
19614
19615 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19616 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19617 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19618 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19619 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19620 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19621 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19622
19623
19624 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19625 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19626 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19627 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19628 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19629 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19630 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19631 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19632
19633 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19634 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19635 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19636 addresses.
19637
19638 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19639 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19640 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19641 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19642 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19643 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19644 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19645 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19646 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19647 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19648
19649
19650 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19651 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19652 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19653 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19654 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19655 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19656
19657
19658 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19659 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19660 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19661 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19662 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19663 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19664
19665
19666 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19667 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19668 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19669 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19670 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19671
19672
19673 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19674 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19675 :subaddress part of an address.
19676
19677 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19678 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19679 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19680 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19681
19682
19683 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19684 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19685 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19686 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19687 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19688 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19689 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19690
19691
19692
19693 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19694 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19695 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19696 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19697 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19698 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19699 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19700 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19701 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19702 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19703 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19704 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19705 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19706 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19707 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19708 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19709
19710 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19711 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19712 the following routers.
19713
19714 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19715 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19716 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19717 so it is passed to the following routers.
19718
19719 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19720 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19721 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19722 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19723
19724 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19725 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19726 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19727 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19728 .code
19729 userforward:
19730 driver = redirect
19731 allow_filter
19732 check_local_user
19733 file = $home/.forward
19734 file_transport = address_file
19735 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19736 reply_transport = address_reply
19737 no_verify
19738 skip_syntax_errors
19739 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19740 syntax_errors_text = \
19741 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19742 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19743 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19744 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19745 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19746 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19747 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19748 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19749 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19750 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19751 .endd
19752 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19753 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19754 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19755 .code
19756 real_localuser:
19757 driver = accept
19758 check_local_user
19759 local_part_prefix = real-
19760 transport = local_delivery
19761 .endd
19762 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19763 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19764 .code
19765 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19766 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19767 .endd
19768
19769
19770 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19771 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19772
19773
19774 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19775 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19776 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19777 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19778
19779
19780
19781
19782
19783
19784 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19785 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19786
19787 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19788 "Environment for local transports"
19789 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19790 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19791 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19792 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19793 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19794 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19795 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19796
19797 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19798 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19799 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19800 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19801
19802 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19803 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19804 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19805 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19806 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19807
19808
19809
19810 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19811 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19812 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19813 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19814 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19815 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19816 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19817 time.
19818
19819 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19820 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19821 .code
19822 my_transport:
19823 driver = pipe
19824 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19825 .endd
19826 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19827 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19828 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19829 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19830
19831
19832
19833
19834 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19835 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19836 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19837 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19838 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19839 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19840 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19841 group (set by the transport). For example:
19842 .code
19843 # Routers ...
19844 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19845 local_users:
19846 driver = accept
19847 check_local_user
19848 transport = group_delivery
19849
19850 # Transports ...
19851 # This transport overrides the group
19852 group_delivery:
19853 driver = appendfile
19854 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19855 group = mail
19856 .endd
19857 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19858 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19859 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19860 set.
19861
19862 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19863 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19864 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19865 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19866 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19867 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19868
19869 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19870 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19871 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19872 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19873 original gid is also used.
19874
19875 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19876 following that is set is used:
19877
19878 .ilist
19879 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19880 .next
19881 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19882 .next
19883 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19884 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19885 .next
19886 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19887 .next
19888 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19889 the uid is the creator's uid;
19890 .next
19891 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19892 .endlist
19893
19894 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19895 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19896 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19897 The first of the following that is set is used:
19898
19899 .ilist
19900 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19901 .next
19902 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19903 .next
19904 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19905 .next
19906 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19907 .next
19908 The Exim uid.
19909 .endlist
19910
19911 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19912 &%never_users%& list.
19913
19914
19915
19916
19917
19918 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19919 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19920 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19921 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19922 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19923 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19924 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19925 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19926 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19927 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19928
19929 .ilist
19930 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19931 .next
19932 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19933 .next
19934 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19935 .next
19936 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19937 .endlist
19938
19939 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19940
19941 .ilist
19942 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19943 .next
19944 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19945 .endlist
19946
19947
19948 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19949 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19950 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19951
19952
19953
19954 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19955 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19956 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19957 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19958 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19959 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19960 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19961 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19962 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19963 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19964 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19965 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19966 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19967 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19968
19969
19970
19971
19972
19973
19974
19975 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19976 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19977
19978 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19979 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19980 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19981 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19982 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19983
19984
19985 .option body_only transports boolean false
19986 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19987 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19988 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19989 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19990 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19991 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19992 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19993 automatically suppress them.
19994
19995
19996 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19997 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19998 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19999 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20000 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20001 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20002
20003
20004 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20005 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20006 deliveries by the transport or for any
20007 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20008 what you are doing.
20009
20010
20011 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20012 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20013 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20014 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20015 transport is run.
20016 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20017 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20018 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20019 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20020 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20021 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20022 one.
20023 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20024 transport and the router that called it.
20025
20026 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20027 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20028 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20029 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20030 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20031 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20032 safely be resent to other recipients.
20033
20034
20035 .option driver transports string unset
20036 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20037 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20038
20039
20040 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20041 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20042 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20043 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20044 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20045 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20046 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20047 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20048 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20049 resent to other recipients.
20050
20051
20052 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20053 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20054 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20055 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20056 &%user%& (see below).
20057
20058
20059 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20060 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20061 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20062 This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
20063 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20064 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20065 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20066 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20067 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20068 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20069
20070 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20071 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20072
20073
20074 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20075 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20076 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20077 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20078 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20079 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20080 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20081 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20082
20083
20084 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20085 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20086 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20087 This option specifies a list of header names, colon-separated;
20088 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20089 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20090 routers.
20091 Each list item is separately expanded.
20092 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20093 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20094 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20095
20096 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20097 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20098
20099
20100
20101 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20102 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20103 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20104 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20105 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20106 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20107 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20108 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20109 example,
20110 .code
20111 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20112 x@y w@z
20113 .endd
20114 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20115 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20116 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20117 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20118 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20119 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20120 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20121 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20122 change envelope recipients at this time.
20123
20124
20125 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20126 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20127 .vindex "&$home$&"
20128 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20129 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20130 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20131 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20132 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20133 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20134 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20135 deferred.
20136
20137
20138 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20139 .cindex "additional groups"
20140 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20141 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20142 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20143 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20144 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20145
20146
20147 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20148 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20149 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20150 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20151 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20152 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20153 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20154 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20155 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20156 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20157 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20158 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20159 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20160 delivered.
20161
20162
20163
20164 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20165 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20166 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20167 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20168 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20169 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20170 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20171 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20172 that contains
20173 .code
20174 local_part_prefix = *-
20175 .endd
20176 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20177 is delivered with
20178 .code
20179 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20180 .endd
20181 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20182 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20183 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20184 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20185 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20186
20187
20188 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20189 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20190 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20191 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20192 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20193 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20194 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20195 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20196 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20197
20198 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20199 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20200 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20201 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20202
20203 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20204 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20205 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20206
20207
20208 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20209 .cindex "envelope sender"
20210 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20211 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20212 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20213 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20214 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20215 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20216 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20217 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20218 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20219
20220 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20221 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20222
20223 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20224 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20225 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20226 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20227 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20228 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20229 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20230
20231 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20232 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20233 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20234 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20235 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20236
20237
20238
20239 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20240 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20241 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20242 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20243 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20244 have easy access to it.
20245
20246 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20247 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20248 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20249 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20250 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20251 recipients.
20252
20253
20254 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20255 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20256
20257
20258 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20259 .cindex "shadow transport"
20260 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20261 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20262 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20263
20264 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20265 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20266 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20267 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20268 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20269 cause a log line to be written.
20270
20271 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20272 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20273 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20274 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20275 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20276 of the form
20277 .code
20278 ST=<shadow transport name>
20279 .endd
20280 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20281 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20282 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20283 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20284 headers that some sites insist on.
20285
20286
20287 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20288 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20289 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20290 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20291 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20292 individual users or via a system filter.
20293
20294 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20295 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20296 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20297 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20298 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20299
20300 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20301 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20302 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20303 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20304 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20305 &(pipe)& transports.
20306
20307 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20308 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20309 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20310 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20311 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20312
20313 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20314 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20315 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20316 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20317
20318 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20319 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20320 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20321 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20322 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20323 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20324
20325 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20326 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20327 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20328 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20329 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20330 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20331 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20332 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20333
20334 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20335 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20336 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20337 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20338 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20339 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20340 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20341 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20342 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20343 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20344
20345 .vindex "&$host$&"
20346 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20347 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20348 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20349 which the message is being sent. For example:
20350 .code
20351 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20352 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20353 .endd
20354
20355 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20356 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20357 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20358 .ilist
20359 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20360 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20361 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20362 example:
20363 .code
20364 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20365 .endd
20366 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20367 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20368 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20369 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20370 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20371 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20372 .next
20373 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20374 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20375 arguments. Consider this example:
20376 .code
20377 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20378 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20379 .endd
20380 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20381 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20382 .code
20383 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20384 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20385 .endd
20386 .endlist
20387
20388 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20389 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20390 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20391 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20392 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20393 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20394 bounced from a transport filter.
20395
20396 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20397 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20398 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20399
20400
20401 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20402 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20403 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20404 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20405 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20406 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20407 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20408 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20409 becomes a temporary error.
20410
20411
20412 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20413 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20414 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20415 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20416 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20417 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20418 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20419 option is not set.
20420
20421 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20422 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20423 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20424
20425 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20426 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20427 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20428 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20429 retry data.
20430 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20431 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20432 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20433
20434
20435
20436
20437
20438
20439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20441
20442 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20443 "Address batching"
20444 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20445 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20446 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20447 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20448 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20449 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20450 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20451
20452 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20453 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20454 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20455 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20456 local transport, for example:
20457
20458 .ilist
20459 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20460 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20461 recipients saves space.
20462 .next
20463 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20464 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20465 .next
20466 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20467 to a scanner program or
20468 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20469 acceptable.
20470 .endlist
20471
20472 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20473 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20474 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20475
20476 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20477 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20478 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20479 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20480 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20481 to certain conditions:
20482
20483 .ilist
20484 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20485 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20486 batching is possible.
20487 .next
20488 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20489 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20490 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20491 .next
20492 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20493 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20494 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20495 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20496 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20497 from taking place.
20498 .next
20499 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20500 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20501 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20502 be the same.
20503 .endlist
20504
20505 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20506 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20507 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20508 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20509 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20510 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20511 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20512 .code
20513 check_string = "."
20514 escape_string = ".."
20515 .endd
20516 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20517 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20518 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20519
20520 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20521 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20522 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20523 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20524 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20525 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20526
20527 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20528 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20529 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20530 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20531 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20532 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20533 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20534 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20535 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20536
20537
20538
20539
20540 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20541 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20542
20543 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20544 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20545 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20546 .cindex "directory creation"
20547 .cindex "creating directories"
20548 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20549 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20550 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20551 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20552 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20553 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20554 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20555 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20556 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20557 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20558
20559 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20560 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20561 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20562 included.
20563
20564 .cindex "quota" "system"
20565 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20566 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20567 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20568
20569 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20570 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20571 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20572 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20573
20574 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20575 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20576 private options.
20577
20578 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20579 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20580 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20581 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20582 option).
20583
20584
20585
20586 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20587 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20588 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20589 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20590 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20591
20592 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20593 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20594 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20595 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20596 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20597 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20598 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20599 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20600 operation. There are two cases:
20601
20602 .ilist
20603 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20604 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20605 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20606 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20607 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20608 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20609 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20610 .next
20611 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20612 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20613 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20614 .endlist
20615
20616
20617 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20618 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20619 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20620 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20621 form:
20622 .code
20623 save folder23
20624 .endd
20625 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20626 .code
20627 require "fileinto";
20628 fileinto "folder23";
20629 .endd
20630 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20631 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20632 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20633 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20634 way of handling this requirement:
20635 .code
20636 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20637 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20638 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20639 {$address_file} \
20640 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20641 }} \
20642 }
20643 .endd
20644 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20645 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20646 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20647
20648 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20649 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20650 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20651 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20652 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20653 path to the transport.
20654
20655 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20656 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20657
20658
20659
20660
20661 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20662 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20663
20664
20665
20666 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20667 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20668 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20669 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20670 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20671 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20672 delivery is deferred.
20673
20674
20675 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20676 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20677 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20678 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20679 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20680 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20681 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20682 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20683
20684
20685 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20686 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20687 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20688 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20689 file.
20690
20691
20692 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20693 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20694
20695
20696 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20697 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20698 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20699 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20700 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20701
20702
20703 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20704 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20705 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20706 process is running.
20707
20708
20709 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20710 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20711 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20712 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20713 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20714 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20715 contains is significant.
20716
20717 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20718 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20719 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20720 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20721 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20722
20723 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20724 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20725 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20726 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20727 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20728 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20729 .code
20730 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20731 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20732 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20733 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20734 .endd
20735 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20736 .cindex "directory creation"
20737 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20738 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20739 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20740
20741 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20742 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20743 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20744 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20745 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20746
20747
20748
20749 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20750 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20751 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20752 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20753 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20754 beneath.
20755
20756 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20757 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20758 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20759 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20760 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20761 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20762 &%file_must_exist%&.
20763
20764
20765 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20766 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20767 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20768 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20769
20770 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20771 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20772 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20773 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20774 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20775
20776
20777 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20778 .cindex "base62"
20779 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20780 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20781 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20782 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20783 .code
20784 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20785 .endd
20786 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20787 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20788 option.
20789
20790
20791 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20792 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20793 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20794
20795
20796 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20797 See &%check_string%& above.
20798
20799
20800 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20801 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20802 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20803 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20804 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20805 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20806 &%file%&.
20807
20808 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20809 .cindex "locking files"
20810 .cindex "lock files"
20811 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20812 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20813
20814 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20815 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20816 examples:
20817 .code
20818 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20819 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20820 file = $home/inbox
20821 .endd
20822 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20823 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20824 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20825 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20826 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20827 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20828
20829
20830
20831 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20832 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20833 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20834 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20835 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20836 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20837 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20838 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20839 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20840 this added to it:
20841 .code
20842 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20843 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20844 .endd
20845 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20846 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20847 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20848 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20849 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20850 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20851 delivery is deferred.
20852
20853
20854 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20855 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20856 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20857 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20858
20859
20860 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20861 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20862 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20863 .cindex "locking files"
20864 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20865 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20866 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20867 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20868 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20869 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20870 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20871 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20872
20873 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20874 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20875 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20876 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20877
20878 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20879 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20880 retries is
20881 .code
20882 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20883 .endd
20884 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20885 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20886 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20887
20888 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20889 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20890 .code
20891 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20892 .endd
20893
20894 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20895 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20896 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20897 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20898
20899
20900 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20901 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20902 for details of locking.
20903
20904
20905 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20906 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20907 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20908
20909
20910 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20911 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20912 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20913
20914
20915 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20916 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20917 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20918 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20919 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20920
20921
20922 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20923 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20924 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20925 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20926 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20927 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20928 external source that maintains the data.
20929
20930
20931 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20932 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20933 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20934 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20935 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20936 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20937 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20938 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20939
20940
20941
20942 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20943 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20944 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20945 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20946 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20947 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20948 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20949 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20950 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20951 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20952
20953
20954 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20955 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20956 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20957 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20958 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20959 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20960 calculation. The default value is:
20961 .code
20962 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20963 .endd
20964 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20965 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20966 &_Trash_&
20967 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20968 .code
20969 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20970 .endd
20971 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20972 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20973 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20974 directly into that directory.
20975
20976
20977 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20978 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20979 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20980
20981
20982 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20983 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20984 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20985
20986
20987 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20988 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20989 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20990 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20991 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20992 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20993 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20994 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20995
20996 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20997 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20998 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20999 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21000 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21001 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21002 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21003 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21004 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21005 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21006
21007
21008 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21009 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21010 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21011 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21012 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21013 below for further details.
21014
21015
21016 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21017 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21018 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21019
21020
21021 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21022 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21023 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21024
21025
21026 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21027 .cindex "locking files"
21028 .cindex "file" "locking"
21029 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21030 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21031 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21032 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21033 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21034 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21035 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21036
21037 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21038 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21039 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21040 combination:
21041 .code
21042 mbx_format = true
21043 message_prefix =
21044 message_suffix =
21045 .endd
21046 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21047 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21048 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21049 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21050 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21051 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21052 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21053 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21054
21055 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21056 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21057 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21058 append messages to it.
21059
21060
21061 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21062 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21063 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21064 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21065 in which case it is:
21066 .code
21067 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21068 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21069 .endd
21070 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21071 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21072
21073 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21074 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21075 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21076 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21077 setting
21078 .code
21079 message_suffix =
21080 .endd
21081 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21082 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21083
21084 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21085 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21086 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21087 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21088 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21089 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21090 value, and this option is ignored.
21091
21092
21093 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21094 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21095 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21096 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21097 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21098
21099
21100 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21101 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21102 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21103 on users about incoming mail.
21104
21105
21106 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21107 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21108 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21109 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21110 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21111 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21112 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21113 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21114 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21115
21116 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21117 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21118 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21119
21120 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21121 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21122 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21123 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21124 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21125 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21126
21127 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21128 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21129 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21130 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21131 be handled.
21132
21133 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21134
21135 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21136 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21137 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21138 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21139 system quota failures.
21140
21141 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21142 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21143 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21144 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21145 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21146 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21147 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21148 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21149 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21150 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21151
21152
21153 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21154 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21155 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21156 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21157 delivery directory.
21158
21159
21160 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21161 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21162 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21163 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21164 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21165 &"no quota"&.
21166
21167
21168 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21169 See &%quota%& above.
21170
21171
21172 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21173 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21174 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21175 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21176 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21177 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21178 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21179
21180 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21181 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21182 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21183 the file length to the file name. For example:
21184 .code
21185 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21186 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21187 .endd
21188 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21189 number of lines in the message.
21190
21191 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21192 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21193 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21194
21195 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21196
21197
21198 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21199 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21200 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21201 .code
21202 quota_warn_message = "\
21203 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21204 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21205 This message is automatically created \
21206 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21207 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21208 a warning threshold that is\n\
21209 set by the system administrator.\n"
21210 .endd
21211
21212
21213 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21214 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21215 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21216 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21217 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21218 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21219 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21220 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21221 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21222 sign. For example:
21223 .code
21224 quota = 10M
21225 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21226 .endd
21227 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21228 percent sign is ignored.
21229
21230 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21231 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21232 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21233 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21234 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21235 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21236 .code
21237 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21238 .endd
21239 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21240 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21241 option.
21242
21243 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21244 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21245 percentage.
21246
21247
21248 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21249 .cindex "envelope sender"
21250 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21251 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21252 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21253 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21254 for details of batch SMTP.
21255
21256
21257 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21258 .cindex "carriage return"
21259 .cindex "linefeed"
21260 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21261 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21262 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21263 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21264
21265 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21266 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21267 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21268 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21269 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21270 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21271
21272
21273 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21274 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21275 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21276 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21277 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21278 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21279
21280
21281 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21282 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21283 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21284 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21285 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21286
21287 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21288 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21289 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21290 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21291
21292 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21293 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21294 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21295 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21296 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21297 error.
21298
21299 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21300 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21301
21302
21303 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21304 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21305 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21306 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21307 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21308 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21309 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21310
21311 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21312 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21313 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21314 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21315 file corruption.
21316
21317 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21318 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21319 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21320
21321
21322 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21323 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21324 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21325 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21326 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21327 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21328 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21329 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21330 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21331
21332 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21333 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21334 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21335 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21336
21337
21338
21339
21340 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21341 .cindex "appending to a file"
21342 .cindex "file" "appending"
21343 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21344
21345 .ilist
21346 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21347 return is given.
21348
21349 .next
21350 .cindex "directory creation"
21351 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21352 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21353 &%directory_mode%& option.
21354
21355 .next
21356 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21357 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21358 transport.
21359
21360 .next
21361 .cindex "file" "locking"
21362 .cindex "locking files"
21363 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21364 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21365 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21366
21367 .olist
21368 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21369 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21370 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21371 .next
21372 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21373 .next
21374 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21375 Unlink the hitching post name.
21376 .next
21377 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21378 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21379 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21380 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21381 .next
21382 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21383 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21384 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21385 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21386 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21387 it before trying again.
21388 .endlist olist
21389
21390 .next
21391 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21392 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21393 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21394
21395 .next
21396 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21397 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21398 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21399 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21400 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21401 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21402 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21403 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21404 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21405 checked.
21406
21407 .next
21408 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21409 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21410 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21411 delivery is deferred.
21412
21413 .next
21414 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21415 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21416 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21417 permissions.
21418
21419 .next
21420 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21421 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21422 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21423
21424 .next
21425 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21426 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21427 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21428
21429 .next
21430 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21431 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21432 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21433 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21434 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21435 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21436 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21437 that prevents link following.
21438
21439 .next
21440 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21441 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21442 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21443 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21444 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21445
21446 .next
21447 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21448
21449 .next
21450 .cindex "file" "locking"
21451 .cindex "locking files"
21452 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21453 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21454 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21455 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21456 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21457 .code
21458 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21459 .endd
21460 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21461 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21462 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21463
21464 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21465 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21466 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21467
21468 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21469 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21470 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21471 delivery is deferred.
21472
21473 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21474 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21475 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21476 immediately. It retries up to
21477 .code
21478 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21479 .endd
21480 times (rounded up).
21481 .endlist
21482
21483 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21484 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21485
21486
21487 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21488 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21489 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21490 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21491 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21492 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21493 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21494 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21495 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21496 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21497
21498 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21499 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21500 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21501 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21502 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21503 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21504 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21505
21506 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21507 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21508 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21509 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21510
21511
21512 .cindex "maildir format"
21513 .cindex "mailstore format"
21514 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21515 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21516 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21517 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21518 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21519
21520 .cindex "directory creation"
21521 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21522 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21523 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21524 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21525 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21526 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21527 deferred.
21528
21529
21530
21531 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21532 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21533 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21534 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21535 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21536 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21537 &_new_& subdirectory.
21538
21539 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21540 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21541 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21542 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21543 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21544 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21545 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21546
21547 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21548 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21549 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21550 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21551 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21552 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21553 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21554 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21555
21556 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21557 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21558 folders. Consider this example:
21559 .code
21560 maildir_format = true
21561 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21562 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21563 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21564 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21565 .endd
21566 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21567 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21568 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21569 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21570 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21571 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21572
21573 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21574 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21575 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21576 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21577 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21578
21579 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21580 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21581 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21582
21583 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21584 .cindex "maildir++"
21585 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21586 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21587 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21588 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21589 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21590 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21591 amount of space used.
21592
21593 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21594 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21595 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21596 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21597 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21598 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21599
21600
21601
21602
21603 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21604 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21605 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21606 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21607 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21608 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21609
21610
21611 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21612 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21613 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21614 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21615 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21616 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21617 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21618 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21619 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21620 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21621 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21622 backwards compatibility).
21623
21624 For one common implementation, you might set:
21625 .code
21626 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21627 .endd
21628 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21629
21630 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21631 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21632 &[stat()]& each message file.
21633
21634
21635 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21636 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21637 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21638 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21639 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21640 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21641 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21642 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21643 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21644
21645 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21646 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21647 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21648 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21649 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21650 need to know the quota.
21651
21652 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21653 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21654
21655 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21656 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21657 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21658 details.
21659
21660
21661 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21662 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21663 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21664 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21665 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21666 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21667 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21668 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21669
21670 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21671 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21672 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21673 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21674 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21675 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21676
21677 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21678 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21679 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21680 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21681 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21682 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21683
21684 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21685 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21686 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21687 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21688
21689
21690 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21691 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21692 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21693 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21694 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21695 .code
21696 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21697 .endd
21698 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21699 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21700 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21701 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21702 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21703
21704
21705
21706
21707
21708
21709 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21710 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21711
21712 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21713 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21714 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21715 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21716 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21717 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21718 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21719 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21720
21721 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21722 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21723 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21724 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21725 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21726
21727
21728 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21729 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21730 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21731 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21732 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21733
21734 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21735 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21736 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21737 transport is run as a consequence of a
21738 &%mail%&
21739 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21740 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21741 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21742 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21743 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21744 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21745
21746 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21747 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21748 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21749 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21750
21751 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21752 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21753 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21754 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21755 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21756 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21757 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21758
21759 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21760 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21761 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21762 the transport defers.
21763 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21764 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21765
21766 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21767 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21768 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21769 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21770
21771 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21772 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21773 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21774 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21775 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21776 problems. They are just discarded.
21777
21778
21779
21780 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21781 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21782
21783 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21784 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21785 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21786
21787
21788 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21789 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21790 when the message is specified by the transport.
21791
21792
21793 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21794 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21795 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21796 string comes first.
21797
21798
21799 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21800 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21801 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21802
21803
21804 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21805 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21806 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21807
21808
21809 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21810 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21811 specified by the transport.
21812
21813
21814 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21815 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21816 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21817 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21818
21819
21820 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21821 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21822 the message is specified by the transport.
21823
21824
21825 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21826 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21827 used.
21828
21829
21830 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21831 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21832 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21833 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21834 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21835
21836
21837
21838 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21839 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21840 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21841 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21842
21843 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21844 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21845 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21846 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21847 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21848 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21849 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21850 infinity.
21851
21852 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21853 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21854 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21855 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21856 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21857
21858 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21859 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21860 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21861 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21862 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21863 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21864
21865
21866 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21867 See &%once%& above.
21868
21869
21870 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21871 See &%once%& above.
21872 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21873
21874
21875 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21876 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21877 specified by the transport.
21878
21879
21880 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21881 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21882 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21883 configuration option.
21884
21885
21886 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21887 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21888 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21889 automatic responses. For example:
21890 .code
21891 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21892 .endd
21893 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21894 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21895 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21896 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21897 small.
21898
21899
21900
21901 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21902 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21903 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21904 the text comes first.
21905
21906
21907 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
21908 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21909 when the message is specified by the transport.
21910 .ecindex IIDauttra1
21911 .ecindex IIDauttra2
21912
21913
21914
21915
21916 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21917 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21918
21919 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21920 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21921 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21922 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21923 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21924 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21925 specified command
21926 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21927 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21928 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21929 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21930 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21931 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21932 .code
21933 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
21934 .endd
21935 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21936 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21937 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21938 as follows:
21939
21940 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21941 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21942
21943
21944 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21945 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21946 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21947 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21948 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21949
21950
21951 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21952 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21953 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21954 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21955 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21956 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21957 LMTP protocol.
21958
21959 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21960 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21961 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21962 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21963 in its response to the LHLO command.
21964
21965 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21966 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21967 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21968 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21969
21970
21971 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21972 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21973 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21974 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21975 LMTP transport:
21976 .code
21977 lmtp:
21978 driver = lmtp
21979 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21980 batch_max = 20
21981 user = exim
21982 .endd
21983 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21984 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21985
21986
21987
21988 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21990
21991 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21992 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21993 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21994 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21995 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21996 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21997 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21998 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21999 following ways:
22000
22001 .ilist
22002 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22003 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22004 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22005 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22006 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22007 .next
22008 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22009 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22010 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22011 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22012 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22013 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22014 that are routed to the transport.
22015 .next
22016 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22017 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22018 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22019 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22020 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22021 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22022 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22023 .endlist
22024
22025
22026 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22027 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22028 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22029
22030 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22031 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22032 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22033 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22034 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22035 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22036 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22037
22038
22039 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22040 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22041 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22042 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22043 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22044
22045
22046
22047
22048 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22049 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22050 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22051 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22052 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22053 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22054 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22055 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22056 &"local delivery failed"&.
22057
22058 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22059 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22060 will be sent as normal.
22061
22062 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22063 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22064 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22065 apply in this case.
22066
22067 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22068 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22069 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22070 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22071
22072 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22073 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22074 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22075 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22076 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22077 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22078 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22079 &%temp_errors%&.
22080
22081
22082
22083 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22084 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22085 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22086 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22087 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22088 run.
22089
22090 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22091 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22092 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22093 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22094
22095 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22096 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22097 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22098 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22099 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22100 .code
22101 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22102 .endd
22103 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22104 arguments. You have to write
22105 .code
22106 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22107 .endd
22108 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22109 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22110 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22111 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22112 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22113 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22114 example:
22115 .code
22116 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22117 .endd
22118
22119 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22120 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22121 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22122 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22123 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22124 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22125 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22126 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22127 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22128 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22129
22130 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22131 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22132 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22133 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22134 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22135 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22136 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22137 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22138
22139 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22140 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22141 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22142 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22143 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22144 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22145 control what is done with it.
22146
22147 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22148 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22149 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22150 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22151 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22152 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22153 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22154 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22155 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22156 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22157 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22158
22159
22160
22161 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22162 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22163 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22164 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22165 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22166 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22167 environment.
22168 .display
22169 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22170 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22171 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22172 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22173 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22174 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22175 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22176 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22177 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22178 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22179 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22180 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22181 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22182 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22183 &`USER `& see below
22184 .endd
22185 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22186 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22187 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22188 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22189 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22190 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22191 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22192
22193 .cindex "HOST"
22194 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22195 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22196 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22197 the router.
22198
22199 .cindex "HOME"
22200 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22201 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22202 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22203 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22204
22205
22206 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22207 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22208
22209
22210
22211 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22212 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22213 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22214 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22215 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22216 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22217 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22218 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22219 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22220 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22221 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22222 example, if
22223 .code
22224 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22225 .endd
22226 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22227 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22228 &%use_shell%& is set.
22229
22230
22231 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22232 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22233
22234
22235 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22236 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22237 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22238
22239
22240 .option check_string pipe string unset
22241 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22242 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22243 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22244 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22245 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22246 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22247 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22248 ignored.
22249
22250
22251 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22252 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22253 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22254 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22255 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22256 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22257 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22258
22259
22260 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22261 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22262 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22263 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22264 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22265 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22266 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22267
22268
22269 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22270 See &%check_string%& above.
22271
22272
22273 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22274 .cindex "exec failure"
22275 .cindex "failure of exec"
22276 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22277 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22278 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22279 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22280 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22281
22282
22283 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22284 .cindex "signal exit"
22285 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22286 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22287 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22288 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22289
22290
22291 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22292 .cindex "force command"
22293 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22294 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22295 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22296 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22297 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22298 command. For example:
22299 .code
22300 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22301 force_command
22302 .endd
22303
22304 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22305 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22306 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22307
22308 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22309 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22310 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22311 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22312 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22313 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22314
22315 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22316 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22317
22318 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22319 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22320 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22321 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22322 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22323
22324
22325 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22326 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22327 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22328 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22329 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22330 Only one of them may be set.
22331
22332
22333
22334 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22335 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22336 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22337 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22338
22339
22340
22341 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22342 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22343 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22344 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22345 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22346 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22347 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22348 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22349
22350
22351 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22352 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22353 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22354 .code
22355 message_prefix = \
22356 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22357 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22358 .endd
22359 .cindex "Cyrus"
22360 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22361 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22362 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22363 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22364 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22365 setting
22366 .code
22367 message_prefix =
22368 .endd
22369 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22370 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22371
22372
22373 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22374 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22375 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22376 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22377 .code
22378 message_suffix =
22379 .endd
22380 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22381 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22382
22383
22384 .option path pipe string "see below"
22385 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22386 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22387 .code
22388 /bin:/usr/bin
22389 .endd
22390 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22391 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22392 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22393
22394
22395 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22396 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22397 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22398 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22399 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22400 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22401 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22402 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22403 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22404
22405
22406 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22407 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22408 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22409 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22410 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22411 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22412 accept the message is used.
22413
22414
22415 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22416 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22417 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22418 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22419 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22420 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22421
22422
22423 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22424 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22425 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22426 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22427 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22428 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22429 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22430
22431
22432
22433 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22434 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22435 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22436 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22437 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22438 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22439 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22440 of them may be set.
22441
22442
22443
22444 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22445 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22446 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22447 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22448 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22449 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22450 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22451 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22452 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22453 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22454 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22455 and 73, respectively.
22456
22457
22458 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22459 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22460 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22461 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22462 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22463 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22464 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22465
22466 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22467 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22468 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22469 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22470 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22471 delivery to be deferred.
22472
22473 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22474 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22475
22476
22477 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22478 .cindex "envelope sender"
22479 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22480 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22481 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22482 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22483 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22484
22485 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22486 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22487 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22488 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22489 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22490 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22491 class database.
22492
22493
22494 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22495 .cindex "carriage return"
22496 .cindex "linefeed"
22497 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22498 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22499 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22500 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22501
22502 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22503 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22504 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22505 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22506 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22507
22508
22509 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22510 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22511 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22512 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22513 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22514 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22515 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22516 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22517 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22518 its &%-c%& option.
22519
22520
22521
22522 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22523 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22524 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22525 .cindex "external local delivery"
22526 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22527 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22528 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22529 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22530 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22531 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22532 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22533 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22534 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22535 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22536 .code
22537 # transport
22538 procmail_pipe:
22539 driver = pipe
22540 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22541 return_path_add
22542 delivery_date_add
22543 envelope_to_add
22544 check_string = "From "
22545 escape_string = ">From "
22546 umask = 077
22547 user = $local_part
22548 group = mail
22549
22550 # router
22551 procmail:
22552 driver = accept
22553 check_local_user
22554 transport = procmail_pipe
22555 .endd
22556 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22557 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22558 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22559 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22560 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22561 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22562
22563 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22564 .code
22565 IFS=" "
22566 .endd
22567 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22568 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22569
22570 .cindex "Cyrus"
22571 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22572 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22573 .code
22574 # transport
22575 local_delivery_cyrus:
22576 driver = pipe
22577 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22578 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22579 user = cyrus
22580 group = mail
22581 return_output
22582 log_output
22583 message_prefix =
22584 message_suffix =
22585
22586 # router
22587 local_user_cyrus:
22588 driver = accept
22589 check_local_user
22590 local_part_suffix = .*
22591 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22592 .endd
22593 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22594 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22595 sender.
22596 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22597 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22598
22599
22600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22602
22603 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22604 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22605 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22606 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22607 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22608 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22609 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22610 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22611
22612
22613 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22614 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22615 two ways:
22616
22617 .ilist
22618 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22619 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22620 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22621 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22622 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22623 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22624 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22625 .next
22626 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22627 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22628 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22629 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22630 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22631 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22632 process.
22633 .endlist
22634
22635
22636 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22637 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22638 no further messages are sent over that connection.
22639
22640
22641
22642 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22643 .vindex "&$host$&"
22644 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22645 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22646 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22647 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22648 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22649 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22650 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22651 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22652
22653
22654 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22655 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22656 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22657 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22658 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
22659 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22660 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22661 are the values that were set when the message was received.
22662 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22663 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22664 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22665 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22666 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22667 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22668
22669 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22670 and will be removed in a future release.
22671
22672
22673 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22674 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22675 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22676
22677
22678 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22679 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22680 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22681 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22682 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22683 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22684 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22685 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22686
22687 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22688 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22689 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22690 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22691 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22692 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22693 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22694 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22695 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22696
22697
22698 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22699 .cindex "Cyrus"
22700 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22701 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22702 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22703 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22704 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22705 ignored.
22706
22707 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22708 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22709 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22710 particular connection.
22711
22712 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22713 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22714 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22715 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22716
22717 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22718 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22719 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22720 .code
22721 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22722 .endd
22723 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22724 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22725
22726 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22727 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22728 value.
22729
22730
22731 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22732 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22733 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22734 authenticated as a client.
22735
22736
22737 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22738 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22739 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22740 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22741
22742
22743 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22744 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22745 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22746 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22747 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22748 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22749 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22750
22751
22752 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22753 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22754 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22755 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22756 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22757 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22758 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22759 option.
22760
22761
22762 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22763 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22764 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22765 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22766
22767
22768 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22769 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22770 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22771 cutoff times.
22772
22773 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22774 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22775 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22776 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22777 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22778 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22779
22780 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22781 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22782 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22783 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22784 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22785 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22786 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22787 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22788 to them.
22789
22790
22791 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22792 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22793 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22794 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22795 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22796
22797
22798 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22799 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22800 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22801 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22802 details.
22803
22804
22805 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
22806 .cindex "MX record" "security"
22807 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
22808 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
22809 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
22810 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
22811 the dnssec request bit set.
22812 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
22813
22814
22815
22816 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
22817 .cindex "MX record" "security"
22818 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
22819 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
22820 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
22821 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
22822 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
22823 (AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
22824 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
22825
22826
22827
22828 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22829 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22830 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22831 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22832 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22833 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22834 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22835
22836 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22837 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22838 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22839 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22840 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22841
22842
22843 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22844 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22845 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22846 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22847 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22848 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22849 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22850 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22851
22852 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22853 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22854 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22855 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22856 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22857 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22858
22859 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22860 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22861 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22862 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22863 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22864
22865 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22866 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22867 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22868 copy of the message is sent.
22869
22870 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22871 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22872 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22873 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22874 fails"& facility.
22875
22876
22877 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22878 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22879 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22880 zero.
22881
22882 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22883 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22884 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22885 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22886 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22887 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22888
22889 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22890 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22891 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22892 implementations of TLS.
22893
22894 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22895 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22896 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22897 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22898 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22899 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22900 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22901 option is:
22902 .code
22903 $primary_hostname
22904 .endd
22905 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22906 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22907 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22908 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22909 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22910 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22911 interface address, you could use this:
22912 .code
22913 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22914 {$primary_hostname}}
22915 .endd
22916 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22917 callouts.
22918
22919 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22920 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22921 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22922 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22923 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22924 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22925
22926 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22927 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22928 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22929 &%hosts_override%& is set.
22930
22931 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22932 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22933 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22934 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22935 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22936 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22937 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22938
22939 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22940 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22941 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22942 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22943 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22944 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22945 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22946 address are used.
22947
22948 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22949 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22950
22951
22952 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22953 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22954 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22955 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22956 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22957 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22958 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22959 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22960 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22961 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22962
22963
22964 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22965 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22966 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22967 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22968
22969
22970 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22971 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22972 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22973 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22974
22975 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
22976 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22977 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
22978 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
22979 to any host that matches this list.
22980 Note that the default is to not use TLS.
22981
22982
22983 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22984 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22985 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22986 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22987 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22988 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22989 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22990 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22991
22992
22993 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22994 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22995 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22996 why it exists.
22997
22998
22999
23000 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23001 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23002 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23003 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23004 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23005 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23006 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23007 explanation of when this might be needed.
23008
23009
23010 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23011 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23012 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23013 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23014 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23015
23016
23017 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23018 .cindex "randomized host list"
23019 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23020 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23021 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23022 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23023 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23024 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23025 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23026 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23027
23028 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23029 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23030 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23031 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23032 .code
23033 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23034 .endd
23035 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23036 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23037 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23038
23039 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23040 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23041 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23042 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23043 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23044 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23045 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23046 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23047 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23048
23049
23050 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23051 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23052 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23053 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23054 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23055
23056 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23057 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23058 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23059 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23060 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23061
23062 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23063 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23064 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23065 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23066 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23067 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23068
23069 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23070 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23071 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23072 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23073 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23074 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23075 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23076
23077 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" unset
23078 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23079 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23080 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23081 for multi-recipient messages.
23082
23083 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23084 .cindex "bind IP address"
23085 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23086 .vindex "&$host$&"
23087 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23088 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23089 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23090 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23091 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23092 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23093 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23094 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23095 unknown.
23096
23097 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23098 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23099 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23100 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23101 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23102 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23103 .code
23104 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23105 .endd
23106 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23107 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23108 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23109 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23110
23111
23112 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23113 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23114 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23115 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23116 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23117 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23118 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23119 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23120 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23121 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23122 unreachable hosts.
23123
23124
23125 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23126 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23127 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23128 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23129 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23130
23131 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23132 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23133 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23134 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23135 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23136 permits this.
23137
23138
23139 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
23140 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23141 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23142 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23143 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23144 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23145 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23146 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23147
23148
23149 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23150 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23151 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23152 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23153 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23154 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23155 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23156 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23157
23158 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23159 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23160 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23161 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23162 is deferred.
23163
23164
23165
23166 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23167 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23168 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23169 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23170 .vindex "&$port$&"
23171 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23172 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23173 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23174 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23175 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23176
23177 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
23178 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23179 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23180 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23181
23182
23183 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
23184 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23185 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23186 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23187 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23188 addresses is not affected.
23189
23190 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23191 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23192 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23193 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
23194 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
23195 hosts.
23196
23197
23198 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23199 .cindex "serializing connections"
23200 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23201 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23202 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23203 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23204 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23205 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23206 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23207
23208 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23209 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23210 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23211 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23212 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23213 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23214
23215 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23216 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23217 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23218 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23219 are used for ETRN serialization.
23220
23221
23222 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23223 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23224 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23225 .cindex "size" "of message"
23226 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23227 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23228 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23229 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23230 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23231 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23232 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23233 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23234
23235 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23236 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23237
23238
23239 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23240 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23241 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23242 .vindex "&$host$&"
23243 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23244 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23245 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23246 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23247 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23248 details of TLS.
23249
23250 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23251 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23252 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23253 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23254 client.
23255
23256
23257 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23258 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23259 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23260 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23261 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23262
23263
23264 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23265 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23266 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23267 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23268 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23269 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23270 will fail.
23271
23272 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23273
23274
23275 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23276 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23277 .vindex "&$host$&"
23278 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23279 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23280 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23281 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23282 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23283 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23284 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23285 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23286
23287
23288 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23289 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23290 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23291 .vindex "&$host$&"
23292 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23293 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23294 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23295 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23296 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23297 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23298 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23299 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23300 ciphers is a preference order.
23301
23302
23303
23304 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23305 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23306 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23307 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23308 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23309 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23310 certificate and private key for the session.
23311
23312 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23313
23314 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23315 TLS extensions.
23316
23317
23318
23319
23320 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23321 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23322 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23323 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23324 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23325 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23326 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23327 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23328 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23329 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23330 in clear.
23331
23332
23333 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!! unset
23334 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23335 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23336 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23337 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23338 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23339 Note that unless the host is in this list
23340 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23341 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is set.
23342 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23343 certificate verification succeeds.
23344
23345
23346 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
23347 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23348 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23349 .vindex "&$host$&"
23350 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23351 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
23352 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23353 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
23354 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
23355 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
23356 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
23357 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23358 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23359
23360 For back-compatability,
23361 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23362 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23363
23364
23365 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!! unset
23366 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23367 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23368 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23369 certificate verification must succeed.
23370 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23371 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23372 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23373
23374
23375
23376
23377 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23378 "SECTvalhosmax"
23379 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23380 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23381 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23382 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23383 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23384
23385
23386 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23387 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23388 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23389 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23390 retrying.
23391
23392 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23393 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23394 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23395
23396 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23397 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23398 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23399 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23400 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23401
23402 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23403 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23404 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23405 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23406 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23407 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23408 see below for an exception).
23409
23410 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23411 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23412 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23413 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23414 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23415
23416 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23417 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23418 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23419 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23420 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23421 reached their retry times.
23422
23423 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23424 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23425 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23426 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23427 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23428 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23429 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23430 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23431 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23432 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23433 reached.
23434
23435 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23436 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23437 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23438 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23439 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23440 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23441
23442 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23443 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23444 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23445 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23446 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23447 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23448
23449
23450
23451
23452
23453 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23454 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23455
23456 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23457 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23458 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23459 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23460 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23461 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23462
23463 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23464 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23465 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23466 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23467 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23468 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23469 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23470
23471 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23472 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23473 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23474 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23475
23476
23477 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23478 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23479 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23480 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23481
23482 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23483 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23484 facility; you do not have to use it.
23485
23486 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23487 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23488 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23489 address to which it applies.
23490
23491 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23492 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23493 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23494 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23495 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23496 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23497 rules.
23498
23499 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23500 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23501 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23502 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23503
23504
23505 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23506 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23507 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23508 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23509 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23510 discouraged.
23511
23512 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23513 illustrated by these examples:
23514
23515 .ilist
23516 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23517 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23518 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23519 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23520 .next
23521 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23522 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23523 .endlist
23524
23525
23526
23527 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23528 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23529 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23530 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23531 message's processing.
23532
23533 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23534 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23535 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23536 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23537 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23538 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23539 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23540 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23541 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23542
23543 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23544 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23545 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23546 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23547 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23548 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23549 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23550 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23551 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23552 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23553
23554 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23555 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23556 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23557 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23558 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23559 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23560
23561 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23562 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23563 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23564
23565 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23566 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23567 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23568 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23569 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23570 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23571 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23572 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23573 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23574
23575 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23576 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23577 transport time.
23578
23579
23580
23581
23582 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23583 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23584 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23585 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23586 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23587 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23588 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23589 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23590 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23591 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23592 .code
23593 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23594 .endd
23595 might produce the output
23596 .code
23597 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23598 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23599 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23600 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23601 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23602 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23603 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23604 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23605 .endd
23606 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23607 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23608 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23609 set for a particular transport.
23610
23611
23612 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23613 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23614 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
23615 rules in the form
23616 .display
23617 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
23618 .endd
23619 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
23620 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
23621 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
23622 any colons must be doubled, of course).
23623
23624 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
23625 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
23626 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
23627 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
23628 ignored.
23629
23630 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
23631 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
23632 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
23633
23634 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
23635 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
23636 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
23637 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
23638 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
23639 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
23640 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
23641
23642 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23643 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23644 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23645 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23646 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23647 .code
23648 *@* ${lookup ...
23649 .endd
23650 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23651 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23652
23653
23654 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23655 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23656 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23657 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23658 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23659 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23660 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23661 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23662 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23663
23664 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23665 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23666 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23667
23668 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23669 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23670 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23671 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23672 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23673 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23674 of pattern they are set as follows:
23675
23676 .ilist
23677 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23678 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23679 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23680 pattern
23681 .code
23682 *queen@*.fict.example
23683 .endd
23684 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23685 .code
23686 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23687 $1 = hearts-
23688 $2 = wonderland
23689 .endd
23690 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23691 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23692
23693 .next
23694 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23695 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23696 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23697 rewriting rule of the form
23698 .display
23699 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23700 .endd
23701 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23702 .code
23703 $1 = foo
23704 $2 = bar
23705 $3 = baz.example
23706 .endd
23707 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23708 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23709 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23710 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23711 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23712 .endlist
23713
23714
23715 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23716 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23717 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23718 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23719 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23720 .code
23721 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23722 .endd
23723 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23724 &'From:'& headers.
23725
23726 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23727 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23728 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23729 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23730 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23731 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23732 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23733 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23734 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23735 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23736 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23737 entry written to the panic log.
23738
23739
23740
23741 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23742 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23743
23744 .ilist
23745 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23746 c, f, h, r, s, t.
23747 .next
23748 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23749 .next
23750 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23751 .endlist
23752
23753 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23754 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23755
23756
23757
23758 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23759 "SECID154"
23760 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23761 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23762 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23763 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23764 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23765 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23766 .display
23767 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23768 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23769 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23770 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23771 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23772 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23773 &`h`& rewrite all headers
23774 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23775 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23776 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23777 .endd
23778 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23779 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23780 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23781
23782 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23783 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23784
23785
23786 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23787 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23788 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23789 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23790 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23791 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23792 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23793 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23794 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23795
23796 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23797 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23798 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23799 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23800 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23801 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23802 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23803 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23804
23805
23806 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23807 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23808 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23809 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23810
23811 .ilist
23812 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23813 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23814 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23815 .next
23816 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23817 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23818 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23819 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23820 .next
23821 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23822 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23823 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23824 .next
23825 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23826 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23827 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23828 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23829 .code
23830 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23831 .endd
23832 into
23833 .code
23834 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23835 .endd
23836 .cindex "RFC 2047"
23837 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23838 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23839 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23840 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
23841 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23842 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23843 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23844 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23845
23846 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23847 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23848 .endlist
23849
23850
23851 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23852 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23853 .code
23854 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23855 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23856 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23857 .endd
23858 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23859 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23860 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23861 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23862 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23863 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23864 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23865 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23866
23867 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23868 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23869 .code
23870 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23871 .endd
23872 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23873 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23874
23875 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23876 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23877 messages that originate outside the local host:
23878 .code
23879 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23880 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23881 .endd
23882 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23883 space.
23884
23885 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23886 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23887 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23888 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23889 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23890 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23891 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23892 components. For example, the rule
23893 .code
23894 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23895 .endd
23896 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23897 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23898 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23899 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23900 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23901 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23902 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23903 .ecindex IIDaddrew
23904
23905
23906
23907
23908
23909 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23910 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23911
23912 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23913 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23914 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23915 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23916 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23917 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23918 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23919 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23920 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23921 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23922 address, domain and error.
23923
23924 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23925 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23926 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23927 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23928 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23929 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23930 log selector is set, the message
23931 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23932 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23933 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23934 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23935
23936 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23937 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23938 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23939 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23940 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23941 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23942 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23943 domain are maintained independently.
23944
23945 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23946 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23947 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23948 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23949 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23950 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23951 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23952 the local address is reached.
23953
23954 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23955 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23956 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23957 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23958 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23959
23960 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23961 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23962 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23963 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23964 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23965 messages that it should now be retaining.
23966
23967
23968
23969 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23970 .cindex "retry" "rules"
23971 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23972 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23973 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23974 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23975 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23976 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23977 message's sender, respectively.
23978
23979
23980 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23981 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23982 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23983 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23984 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23985 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23986 example,
23987 .code
23988 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23989 .endd
23990 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23991 whereas
23992 .code
23993 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23994 .endd
23995 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23996 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23997 part.
23998
23999 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24000 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24001 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24002 expressions work in address lists.
24003 .display
24004 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24005 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24006 .endd
24007
24008
24009 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24010 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24011 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24012 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24013 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24014 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24015 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24016 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24017 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24018
24019 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24020 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24021 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24022 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24023 local transports).
24024
24025 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24026 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24027 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24028 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24029 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24030 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24031 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24032 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24033 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24034 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24035 commands.
24036
24037
24038
24039 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24040 "SECID160"
24041 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24042 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24043 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24044 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24045 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24046 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24047 .code
24048 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24049 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24050 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24051 .endd
24052 and the retry rules are
24053 .code
24054 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24055 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24056 .endd
24057 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24058 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24059 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24060 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24061 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24062 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24063
24064 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24065 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24066 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24067 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24068
24069 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24070 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24071 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24072 .code
24073 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24074 .endd
24075 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24076 textual form of the IP address.
24077
24078 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24079 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24080 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24081 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24082
24083 .vlist
24084 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24085 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24086 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24087
24088 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24089 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24090 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24091
24092 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24093 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24094
24095 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24096 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24097 .endlist
24098
24099 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24100 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24101 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24102 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24103 retry rule of this form:
24104 .code
24105 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24106 .endd
24107 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24108 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24109
24110 .vlist
24111 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24112 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24113 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24114 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24115
24116 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24117 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24118
24119 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24120 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24121
24122 .vitem &%refused%&
24123 A connection was refused.
24124
24125 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24126 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24127
24128 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24129 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24130
24131 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24132 A connection attempt timed out.
24133
24134 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24135 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24136 obtained from an MX record.
24137
24138 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24139 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24140 obtained from an MX record.
24141
24142 .vitem &%timeout%&
24143 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24144
24145 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24146 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24147 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24148 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24149
24150 .vitem &%quota%&
24151 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24152 transport.
24153
24154 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24155 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24156 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24157 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24158 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24159 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24160 for four days.
24161 .endlist
24162
24163 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24164 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24165 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24166 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24167 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24168 heuristic rules:
24169
24170 .ilist
24171 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24172 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24173 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24174 .next
24175 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24176 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24177 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24178 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24179 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24180 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24181 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24182 .next
24183 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24184 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24185 .endlist
24186
24187 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24188 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24189 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24190 error).
24191
24192
24193
24194 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24195 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24196 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24197 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24198 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24199 form:
24200 .display
24201 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24202 .endd
24203 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24204 .code
24205 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24206 .endd
24207 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24208 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24209 For example:
24210 .code
24211 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24212 .endd
24213 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24214 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24215 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24216 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24217 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24218
24219 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24220 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24221 .code
24222 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24223 .endd
24224 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24225 list is never matched.
24226
24227
24228
24229
24230
24231 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24232 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24233 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24234 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24235 .display
24236 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24237 .endd
24238 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24239 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24240 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24241 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24242 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24243
24244 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24245 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24246 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24247 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24248 The available algorithms are:
24249
24250 .ilist
24251 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24252 the interval.
24253 .next
24254 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24255 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24256 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24257 .next
24258 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24259 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24260 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24261 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24262 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24263 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24264 queue processing times.
24265 .endlist
24266
24267 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24268 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24269 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24270 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24271 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24272 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24273 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24274 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24275 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24276 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24277 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24278 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24279
24280 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24281 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24282 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24283 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24284 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24285 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24286 time.
24287
24288 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24289 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24290 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24291 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24292 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24293 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24294 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24295 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24296 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24297 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24298 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24299 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24300
24301 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24302 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24303 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24304 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24305 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24306 deliveries that have been deferred.
24307
24308
24309 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24310 Here are some example retry rules:
24311 .code
24312 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24313 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24314 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24315 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24316 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24317 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24318 .endd
24319 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24320 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24321 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24322 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24323 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24324 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24325 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24326 days.
24327
24328 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24329 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24330 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24331 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24332 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24333
24334 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24335 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24336 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24337 were not obtained from an MX record.
24338
24339 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24340 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24341 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24342 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24343 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24344
24345
24346
24347 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24348 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24349 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24350 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24351 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24352 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24353 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24354 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24355 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24356 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24357 failing for the first time.
24358
24359 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24360 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24361 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24362 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24363
24364 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24365 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24366 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24367
24368
24369
24370
24371 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24372 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24373 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24374 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24375 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24376 default retry rule:
24377 .code
24378 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24379 .endd
24380 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24381 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24382 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24383
24384 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24385 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24386 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24387 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24388 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24389
24390 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24391 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24392 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24393
24394 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24395 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24396 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24397 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24398 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24399 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24400 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24401 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24402
24403 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24404 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24405 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24406 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24407 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24408 notice.
24409
24410 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24411 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24412 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24413 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24414 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24415 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24416 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24417 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24418 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24419 true.
24420
24421 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24422 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24423 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24424 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24425 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24426 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24427 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24428 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24429 reached.
24430
24431 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24432 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24433 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24434 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24435 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24436 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24437 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24438 time out the address.
24439
24440 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24441 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24442 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24443 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24444 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24445 considered immediately.
24446 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24447 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24448
24449
24450
24451
24452
24453
24454 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24455 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24456
24457 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24458 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24459 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24460 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24461 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24462 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24463 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24464 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24465 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24466 other.
24467
24468 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24469 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24470
24471 .ilist
24472 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24473 the client's EHLO command.
24474 .next
24475 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24476 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24477 .next
24478 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24479 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24480 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24481 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24482 with the AUTH command.
24483 .next
24484 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24485 .next
24486 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24487 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24488 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24489 connection.
24490 .next
24491 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24492 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24493 unauthenticated connection.
24494 .endlist
24495
24496 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24497 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24498 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24499 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24500 .display
24501 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24502 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24503 &`Connected to server.example.`&
24504 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
24505 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24506 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24507 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24508 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24509 &`250-PIPELINING`&
24510 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
24511 &`250 HELP`&
24512 .endd
24513 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24514 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24515 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24516 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24517 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24518 included by setting
24519 .code
24520 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
24521 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24522 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
24523 AUTH_GSASL=yes
24524 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24525 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
24526 AUTH_SPA=yes
24527 .endd
24528 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24529 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24530 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24531 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24532 work via a socket interface.
24533 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24534 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24535 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24536 supporting setting a server keytab.
24537 The sixth can be configured to support
24538 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24539 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24540 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24541
24542 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24543 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24544 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24545 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24546 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24547 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24548 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24549
24550 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24551 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24552 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24553 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24554 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24555 both sets of options, is required. For example:
24556 .code
24557 cram:
24558 driver = cram_md5
24559 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24560 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24561 client_name = ph10
24562 client_secret = secret2
24563 .endd
24564 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24565 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24566
24567 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24568 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24569 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24570 in Exim.
24571
24572 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24573 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24574 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24575 authenticating data.
24576
24577 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24578 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24579 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24580 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24581 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24582 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24583 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24584 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24585 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24586 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24587 choose to honour.
24588
24589 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24590 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24591 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24592 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24593
24594
24595
24596 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24597 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24598 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24599
24600 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24601 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24602 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24603 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24604 encrypted by a setting such as:
24605 .code
24606 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
24607 .endd
24608
24609
24610 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24611 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
24612 result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
24613 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
24614
24615
24616 .option driver authenticators string unset
24617 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
24618 authenticators is to be used.
24619
24620
24621 .option public_name authenticators string unset
24622 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
24623 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
24624 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
24625 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
24626 defaults to the driver's instance name.
24627
24628
24629 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24630 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
24631 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
24632 mechanism is not advertised.
24633 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
24634 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
24635 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
24636
24637
24638 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24639 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
24640 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
24641 for details.
24642
24643 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
24644 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
24645
24646 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
24647 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
24648 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
24649 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24650 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24651 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24652 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24653 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24654 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24655 the error text.
24656
24657
24658 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24659 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24660 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24661 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24662 out the values of variables.
24663 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24664 output, and Exim carries on processing.
24665
24666
24667 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24668 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24669 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24670 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24671 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24672 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24673 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24674 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24675 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24676
24677
24678 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24679 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24680 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24681 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24682 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24683 remembered for later use.
24684 How it is used is described in the following section.
24685
24686
24687
24688
24689
24690 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24691 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24692 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24693 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24694 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24695 message:
24696
24697 .ilist
24698 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24699 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24700 .next
24701 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24702 .next
24703 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24704 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24705 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24706 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24707 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24708 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24709 given for the MAIL command.
24710 .next
24711 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24712 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24713 authenticated.
24714 .next
24715 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24716 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24717 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24718 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24719 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24720 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24721 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24722 message.
24723 .endlist
24724
24725
24726 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24727 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24728 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24729 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24730
24731 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24732 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24733 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24734 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24735 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24736 ACL is run.
24737
24738
24739
24740 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24741 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24742 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24743 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24744 conditions:
24745
24746 .ilist
24747 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24748 .next
24749 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24750 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24751 .endlist
24752
24753 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24754 the mechanisms are advertised.
24755
24756 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24757 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24758 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24759 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24760 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24761 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24762 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24763 .code
24764 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24765 .endd
24766 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24767
24768 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24769 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24770 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24771 such as:
24772 .code
24773 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24774 .endd
24775 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24776 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24777 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24778
24779 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24780 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24781 command. This is the case if
24782
24783 .ilist
24784 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24785 .next
24786 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24787 .next
24788 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24789 server authenticators.
24790 .endlist
24791
24792
24793 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24794 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24795 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24796
24797 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24798 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24799 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24800 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24801 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24802 rejected with a 504 error.
24803
24804 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24805 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24806 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24807 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24808 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24809 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24810 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24811 no successful authentication.
24812
24813
24814
24815
24816 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24817 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24818 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24819 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24820 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24821 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24822 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24823 script:
24824 .code
24825 use MIME::Base64;
24826 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24827 .endd
24828 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24829 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24830 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24831 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24832 command line to run this script on such data might be
24833 .code
24834 encode '\0user\0password'
24835 .endd
24836 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24837 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24838 whose code value is zero.
24839
24840 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24841 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24842 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24843 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24844
24845 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24846 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24847 example, a command such as
24848 .code
24849 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24850 .endd
24851 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24852
24853 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24854 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24855 .code
24856 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24857 .endd
24858 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24859 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24860 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24861 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24862
24863
24864
24865 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24866 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24867 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24868 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24869 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24870 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24871
24872 .ilist
24873 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24874 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24875 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24876 of the authenticator.
24877 .next
24878 .vindex "&$host$&"
24879 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24880 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24881 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24882 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24883 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24884 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24885 delivery to be deferred.
24886 .next
24887 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24888 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24889 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24890 usual way.
24891 .next
24892 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24893 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24894 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24895 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24896 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24897 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24898 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24899 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24900 deliver the message unauthenticated.
24901 .endlist
24902
24903 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24904 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24905 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24906 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24907 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24908 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24909 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24910 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24911 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24912 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24913 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24914 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
24915 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
24916
24917
24918
24919
24920
24921
24922 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24923 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24924
24925 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24926 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24927 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24928 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24929 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24930 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24931 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24932 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24933 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24934 connections as you do for login accounts.
24935
24936 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24937 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24938 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24939
24940 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24941 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24942 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24943
24944 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24945 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24946 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24947 given.
24948
24949 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24950 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24951 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24952 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24953 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24954 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24955 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24956
24957 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24958 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24959 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24960 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24961 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24962 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24963 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24964
24965 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24966 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24967 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24968 string expansions that also use them for other things.
24969
24970 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24971 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24972 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24973
24974 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24975 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24976 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24977 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24978 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24979 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24980 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24981 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24982 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24983 string as the error text
24984
24985 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24986 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24987 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24988
24989
24990
24991 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24992 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24993 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24994 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24995 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24996 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24997 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24998 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24999
25000 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25001 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25002 configured as follows:
25003 .code
25004 fixed_plain:
25005 driver = plaintext
25006 public_name = PLAIN
25007 server_prompts = :
25008 server_condition = \
25009 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25010 server_set_id = $auth2
25011 .endd
25012 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25013 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25014 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25015 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25016
25017 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25018 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25019 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25020 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25021 .code
25022 250-AUTH PLAIN
25023 .endd
25024 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25025 .code
25026 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25027 .endd
25028 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25029 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25030 .code
25031 AUTH PLAIN
25032 .endd
25033 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25034 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25035
25036 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25037 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25038 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25039 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25040 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25041
25042 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25043 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25044 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25045
25046 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25047 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25048 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25049 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25050 This is an incorrect example:
25051 .code
25052 server_condition = \
25053 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25054 .endd
25055 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25056 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25057 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25058 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25059 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25060 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25061 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25062 .code
25063 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25064 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25065 .endd
25066 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25067 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25068 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25069 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25070 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25071
25072
25073 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25074 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25075 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25076 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25077 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25078 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25079 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25080 .code
25081 fixed_login:
25082 driver = plaintext
25083 public_name = LOGIN
25084 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25085 server_condition = \
25086 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25087 server_set_id = $auth1
25088 .endd
25089 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25090 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25091 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25092 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25093
25094 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25095 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25096 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25097 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25098 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25099 .code
25100 login:
25101 driver = plaintext
25102 public_name = LOGIN
25103 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25104 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25105 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25106 ldapauth{\
25107 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25108 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25109 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25110 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25111 .endd
25112 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25113 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25114 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25115 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25116 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25117 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25118 uninterpreted string.
25119
25120
25121 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25122 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25123 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25124 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25125 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25126 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25127
25128
25129
25130
25131 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25132 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25133 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25134
25135 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25136 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25137 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25138 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25139 usual.
25140
25141 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25142 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25143 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25144 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25145 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25146 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25147 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25148 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25149 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25150 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25151 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25152 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25153
25154 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25155 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25156
25157 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25158 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25159 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25160 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25161 the string.
25162
25163 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25164 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25165 .code
25166 fixed_plain:
25167 driver = plaintext
25168 public_name = PLAIN
25169 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25170 .endd
25171 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25172 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25173 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25174 .code
25175 fixed_login:
25176 driver = plaintext
25177 public_name = LOGIN
25178 client_send = : username : mysecret
25179 .endd
25180 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25181 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25182 prompts.
25183 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25184 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25185
25186
25187
25188
25189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25190 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25191
25192 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25193 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25194 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25195 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25196 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25197 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25198 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25199 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25200 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25201 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25202 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25203 available in plain text at either end.
25204
25205
25206 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25207 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25208 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25209 authenticator as a server:
25210
25211 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25212 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25213 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25214 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25215 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25216 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25217 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25218 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25219 returned to the client.
25220
25221 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25222 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25223 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25224 numeric variables for other things.
25225
25226 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25227 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25228 user name, authentication fails.
25229 .code
25230 fixed_cram:
25231 driver = cram_md5
25232 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25233 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25234 server_set_id = $auth1
25235 .endd
25236 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25237 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25238 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25239 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25240 .code
25241 lookup_cram:
25242 driver = cram_md5
25243 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25244 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25245 {$value}fail}
25246 server_set_id = $auth1
25247 .endd
25248 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25249 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25250
25251 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25252 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25253 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25254 realm, with:
25255 .code
25256 cyrusless_crammd5:
25257 driver = cram_md5
25258 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25259 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25260 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
25261 server_set_id = $auth1
25262 .endd
25263
25264 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25265 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25266 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25267
25268
25269
25270 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25271 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25272 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25273
25274
25275 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25276 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25277 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25278
25279
25280 .vindex "&$host$&"
25281 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25282 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25283 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25284 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25285 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25286 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25287 send the message to the current server.
25288
25289 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25290 strings, is:
25291 .code
25292 fixed_cram:
25293 driver = cram_md5
25294 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25295 client_name = ph10
25296 client_secret = secret
25297 .endd
25298 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25299 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25300
25301
25302
25303 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25305
25306 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25307 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25308 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25309 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25310 .cindex "Kerberos"
25311 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25312 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25313
25314 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25315 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25316 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25317 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25318 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25319
25320 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25321 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25322 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25323 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25324
25325 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25326 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25327 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25328 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25329 depending on the driver you are using.
25330
25331 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25332 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25333 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25334 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25335 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25336 implementation.
25337
25338 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25339 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25340 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25341 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25342 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25343 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25344 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25345 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25346
25347
25348 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25349 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25350 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25351 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25352 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25353 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25354 things.
25355
25356
25357 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25358 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25359 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25360 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25361
25362
25363 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25364 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25365 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25366 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25367 example:
25368 .code
25369 sasl:
25370 driver = cyrus_sasl
25371 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25372 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25373 server_set_id = $auth1
25374 .endd
25375
25376 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25377 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25378
25379
25380 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25381 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25382
25383
25384 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25385 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25386 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25387 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25388 .code
25389 sasl_cram_md5:
25390 driver = cyrus_sasl
25391 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25392 server_set_id = $auth1
25393
25394 sasl_plain:
25395 driver = cyrus_sasl
25396 public_name = PLAIN
25397 server_set_id = $auth2
25398 .endd
25399 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25400 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25401 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25402 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25403 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25404
25405
25406
25407
25408 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25409 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25410 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25411 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25412 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25413 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25414 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25415 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25416 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25417 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25418 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25419
25420 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25421
25422 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25423 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25424 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25425 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25426 .code
25427 dovecot_plain:
25428 driver = dovecot
25429 public_name = PLAIN
25430 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25431 server_set_id = $auth1
25432
25433 dovecot_ntlm:
25434 driver = dovecot
25435 public_name = NTLM
25436 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25437 server_set_id = $auth1
25438 .endd
25439 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25440 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25441 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25442 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25443 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25444 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25445 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25446 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25447
25448
25449 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25450 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25451 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25452 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25453 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25454 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25455 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25456 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25457 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25458 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25459 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25460 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25461 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25462 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25463 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25464 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25465 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25466 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25467 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25468 without code changes in Exim.
25469
25470
25471 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25472 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25473 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25474 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25475 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25476 context.
25477
25478 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25479 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25480 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25481
25482 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25483 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25484 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25485
25486 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25487 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25488 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25489
25490
25491 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25492 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25493 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25494 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25495
25496
25497 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25498 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25499 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25500 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25501 example:
25502 .code
25503 sasl:
25504 driver = gsasl
25505 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25506 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25507 server_set_id = $auth1
25508 .endd
25509
25510
25511 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25512 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25513 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25514 the password itself.
25515
25516 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25517 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25518 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25519 if available, else the empty string.
25520 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25521 else the empty string.
25522
25523 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25524
25525 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25526 option to be simply "true".
25527
25528
25529 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25530 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25531 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25532
25533
25534 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25535 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25536 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25537 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25538
25539
25540 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25541 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25542 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25543 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25544
25545
25546 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25547 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25548 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25549
25550
25551 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25552 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25553 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25554 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25555
25556 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25557 meanings for these variables:
25558
25559 .ilist
25560 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25561 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25562 .next
25563 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25564 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25565 .next
25566 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
25567 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25568 .endlist
25569
25570 On a per-mechanism basis:
25571
25572 .ilist
25573 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25574 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25575 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25576 .next
25577 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25578 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25579 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25580 .next
25581 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25582 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25583 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25584 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25585 .endlist
25586
25587 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25588 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
25589 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25590
25591
25592 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25593 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25594 .code
25595 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25596 driver = gsasl
25597 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25598 server_realm = imap.example.org
25599 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25600 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25601 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25602 server_condition = yes
25603 .endd
25604
25605
25606 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25608
25609 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
25610 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
25611 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
25612 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25613 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
25614 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
25615 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
25616 reliably.
25617
25618 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
25619 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
25620 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
25621 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25622
25623 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
25624 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
25625 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
25626 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
25627
25628 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
25629 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
25630 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
25631 from the keytab.
25632
25633
25634 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
25635 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
25636 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
25637 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
25638
25639 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
25640 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
25641 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
25642 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
25643
25644 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25645 .ilist
25646 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25647 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
25648 .next
25649 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25650 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25651 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25652 GSS Display Name.
25653 .endlist
25654
25655
25656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25657 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25658
25659 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25660 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25661 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25662 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25663 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25664 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25665 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
25666 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25667 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25668 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25669 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25670 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25671 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25672 follows:
25673
25674 .ilist
25675 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25676 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25677 .next
25678 The server sends back a challenge.
25679 .next
25680 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25681 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25682 .endlist
25683
25684 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25685
25686
25687
25688 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25689 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25690 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25691
25692 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
25693 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25694 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25695 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25696 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25697 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25698 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25699 for other things. For example:
25700 .code
25701 spa:
25702 driver = spa
25703 public_name = NTLM
25704 server_password = \
25705 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25706 .endd
25707 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25708 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25709
25710
25711
25712
25713
25714 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25715 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25716 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25717
25718
25719
25720 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25721 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25722
25723
25724 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
25725 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25726
25727
25728 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
25729 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25730 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25731 &'msn.com'&:
25732 .code
25733 msn:
25734 driver = spa
25735 public_name = MSN
25736 client_username = msn/msn_username
25737 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25738 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25739 .endd
25740 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
25741 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
25742
25743
25744
25745
25746
25747 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25748 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25749
25750 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25751 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25752 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25753 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25754 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25755 .cindex "OpenSSL"
25756 .cindex "GnuTLS"
25757 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25758 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25759 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25760 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25761 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25762 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25763 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25764 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25765 certificates are used.
25766
25767 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25768 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25769 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25770 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25771 between them is encrypted.
25772
25773 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25774 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25775 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25776 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25777 encryption state.
25778
25779 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25780 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25781 in order to get TLS to work.
25782
25783
25784
25785 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25786 "SECID284"
25787 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25788 .cindex "smtps protocol"
25789 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25790 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25791 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25792 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25793 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25794 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25795 allocated for this purpose.
25796
25797 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25798 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25799 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25800 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25801 .code
25802 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25803 .endd
25804 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25805 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25806 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25807 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25808 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25809 defined elsewhere.
25810
25811 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25812 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25813
25814
25815
25816
25817
25818
25819 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25820 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25821 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25822 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25823 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25824 .code
25825 USE_GNUTLS=yes
25826 .endd
25827 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25828 .code
25829 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
25830 .endd
25831 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25832 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25833
25834 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25835
25836 .ilist
25837 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25838 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
25839 .next
25840 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25841 .next
25842 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25843 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
25844 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25845 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25846 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
25847 .next
25848 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25849 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25850 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25851 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25852 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25853 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25854 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25855 option).
25856 .next
25857 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25858 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25859 .next
25860 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25861 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25862 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25863 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25864 .next
25865 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25866 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25867 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25868 implementation, then patches are welcome.
25869 .endlist
25870
25871
25872 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25873 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25874 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25875 but not the chosen filename.
25876 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25877 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25878
25879 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25880 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25881 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25882 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25883 of bits requested.
25884 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25885 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25886 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25887 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25888 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25889 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25890 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25891
25892 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25893 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25894 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25895 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25896 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25897
25898 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25899 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25900 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25901 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25902 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25903 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25904
25905 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25906 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25907 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25908
25909 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25910 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25911 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25912 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25913 .code
25914 # ls
25915 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25916 # rm -f new-params
25917 # touch new-params
25918 # chown exim:exim new-params
25919 # chmod 0600 new-params
25920 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25921 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
25922 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
25923 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
25924 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
25925 # chmod 0400 new-params
25926 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25927 .endd
25928 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25929 stalling is removed.
25930
25931 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25932 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25933 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25934 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25935 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25936 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25937 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25938 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25939 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25940 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25941 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25942
25943 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25944 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25945 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
25946 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25947
25948 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
25949 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
25950 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
25951 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
25952 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
25953
25954
25955 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25956 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25957 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25958 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25959 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25960 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25961 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25962 directly to this function call.
25963 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25964 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25965 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25966 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25967
25968 .ilist
25969 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25970 .next
25971 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25972 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25973 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25974 SSL v3 algorithms.
25975 .next
25976 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25977 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25978 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25979 algorithms.
25980 .endlist
25981
25982 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25983 &`-`& or &`+`&.
25984 .ilist
25985 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25986 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25987 stated.
25988 .next
25989 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25990 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25991 .next
25992 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25993 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25994 .endlist
25995
25996 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25997 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25998 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25999 not be moved to the end of the list.
26000 .endlist
26001
26002 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26003 string:
26004 .code
26005 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26006 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26007 .endd
26008
26009 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26010 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26011 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26012 choice of clients used:
26013 .code
26014 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26015 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26016 {DEFAULT}\
26017 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26018 .endd
26019
26020
26021
26022 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26023 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26024 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26025 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26026 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26027 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26028 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26029 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26030 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26031 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26032 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26033 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26034
26035 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
26036
26037 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26038 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26039 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26040 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26041 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26042 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26043
26044 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26045 "Priority strings". This is online as
26046 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26047 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26048 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26049 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26050 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26051
26052 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26053 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26054 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26055
26056 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26057 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26058 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26059 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26060 used:
26061 .code
26062 # GnuTLS variant
26063 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26064 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26065 {SECURE128}}
26066 .endd
26067
26068
26069 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26070 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26071 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26072 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26073 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26074 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26075 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26076 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26077
26078 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26079 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26080 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26081 with the error
26082 .code
26083 554 Security failure
26084 .endd
26085 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26086 rejected with a 554 error code.
26087
26088 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26089 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26090 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26091 without some further configuration at the server end.
26092
26093 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26094 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26095 .code
26096 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26097 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26098 .endd
26099 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26100 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26101 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26102 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
26103 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
26104 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26105 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26106 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26107 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26108 the server's certificate.
26109
26110 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26111 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26112 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26113
26114 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26115 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26116 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26117 transport.
26118
26119 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26120 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26121 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26122 .code
26123 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26124 .endd
26125 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26126 with the parameters contained in the file.
26127 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26128 available:
26129 .code
26130 tls_dhparam = none
26131 .endd
26132 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26133 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26134 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26135 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26136
26137 See the command
26138 .code
26139 openssl dhparam
26140 .endd
26141 for a way of generating file data.
26142
26143 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26144 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26145 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26146 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26147 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26148
26149 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26150 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26151 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26152 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26153 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26154 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26155 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26156 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26157 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26158
26159 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26160 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26161 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26162 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26163 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26164 documentation for more details.
26165
26166 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26167 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26168
26169
26170 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26171 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26172 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26173 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26174 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26175 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26176 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26177 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26178 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26179 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
26180 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
26181 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26182
26183 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26184 directory is used
26185 (OpenSSL only),
26186 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26187 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26188 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26189 .code
26190 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26191 .endd
26192 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26193
26194 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26195 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26196 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26197 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26198 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26199 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26200 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26201 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26202 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26203 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26204
26205 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26206 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26207 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26208 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26209
26210 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26211 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26212 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26213 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26214 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26215 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26216
26217
26218 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26219 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26220 .cindex "revocation list"
26221 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26222 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26223 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26224 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26225 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26226 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26227 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26228 CRL in PEM format.
26229 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26230 file from every certificate authority the know of.
26231
26232 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26233 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26234 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26235 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26236 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26237 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26238
26239 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26240 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26241 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26242 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26243
26244 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26245 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26246 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26247 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26248 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26249 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26250 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26251 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26252
26253 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26254 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.1.3,
26255 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26256
26257 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26258 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26259 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26260 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26261 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26262
26263 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26264 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26265 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26266 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26267 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26268 next connection.
26269
26270 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26271 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26272 ignored.
26273
26274 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26275 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26276 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26277 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26278 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26279 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26280
26281 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26282 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26283
26284 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26285
26286 .code
26287 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26288 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26289 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26290
26291 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26292 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26293 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26294 .endd
26295
26296
26297
26298
26299 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26300 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26301 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26302 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26303 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26304 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26305 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26306 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26307 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26308
26309 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26310 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26311 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26312 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26313 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26314
26315 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26316 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26317 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26318 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26319 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26320 usual way.
26321
26322 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26323 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26324 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26325 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26326 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26327 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26328 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26329 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26330 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26331 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26332 unencrypted.
26333
26334 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26335 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26336 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26337 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26338
26339 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26340 must name a file or,
26341 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
26342 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
26343 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26344 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26345 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26346 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26347
26348 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26349 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26350 or need not succeed respectively.
26351
26352 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26353 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26354 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26355 value is empty.
26356 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26357 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26358 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26359 otherwise.
26360
26361 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26362 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26363 for OCSP to be relevant.
26364
26365 If
26366 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26367 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26368 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26369 alternative hosts, if any.
26370
26371 &*Note*&:
26372 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26373 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26374 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26375 client.
26376
26377 .vindex "&$host$&"
26378 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26379 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26380 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26381 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26382 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26383
26384 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26385 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26386 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26387 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26388 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26389 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26390 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26391 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26392 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26393 outgoing connection.
26394
26395
26396
26397 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
26398 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26399 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
26400 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
26401 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
26402 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
26403 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
26404 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
26405 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
26406 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
26407 for this session.
26408
26409 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
26410 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
26411 address.
26412
26413 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
26414 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
26415 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
26416 be of limited use in that environment.
26417
26418 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
26419 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
26420 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
26421 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
26422 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
26423
26424 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
26425 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
26426 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
26427 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
26428 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
26429
26430 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
26431 received from a client.
26432 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
26433
26434 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
26435 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
26436 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
26437
26438 .ilist
26439 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
26440 &%tls_certificate%&
26441 .next
26442 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
26443 &%tls_crl%&
26444 .next
26445 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
26446 &%tls_privatekey%&
26447 .next
26448 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
26449 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
26450 .next
26451 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
26452 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
26453 .endlist
26454
26455 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
26456 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
26457 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
26458 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
26459
26460 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
26461 are re-expanded.
26462
26463 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
26464 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
26465 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
26466 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
26467
26468 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
26469 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
26470 built, then you have SNI support).
26471
26472
26473
26474 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
26475 "SECTmulmessam"
26476 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
26477 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26478 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
26479 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
26480 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
26481 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
26482 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
26483 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26484 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26485 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26486 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26487
26488 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26489 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
26490 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
26491 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
26492 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
26493 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
26494 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
26495 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
26496 and delay other deliveries to that host.
26497
26498 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
26499 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
26500 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
26501 information is recorded.
26502
26503 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
26504 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
26505 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
26506
26507
26508
26509
26510 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
26511 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
26512 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
26513 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
26514 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
26515 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
26516 to Apache, currently at
26517 .display
26518 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
26519 .endd
26520 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
26521 links to further files.
26522 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
26523 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
26524 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
26525 .display
26526 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
26527 .endd
26528
26529
26530 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
26531 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
26532 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
26533 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
26534 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
26535 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
26536 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
26537 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
26538 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
26539 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
26540 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
26541 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
26542 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
26543
26544 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
26545 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
26546 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
26547 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
26548
26549
26550
26551 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
26552 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
26553 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
26554 with OpenSSL, like this:
26555 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
26556 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
26557 .code
26558 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
26559 -days 9999 -nodes
26560 .endd
26561 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
26562 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
26563 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
26564 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
26565 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
26566 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
26567 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
26568
26569 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
26570 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
26571 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
26572 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
26573 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
26574 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
26575 . ==== -pdp, 2012
26576 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
26577 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
26578 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
26579 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
26580 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
26581 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
26582 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
26583 be a sensible resolution).
26584
26585 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
26586 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
26587 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
26588
26589 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
26590 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
26591 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
26592 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
26593 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
26594 signed with that self-signed certificate.
26595
26596 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
26597 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
26598 Open-source PKI book, available online at
26599 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
26600 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
26601 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
26602
26603
26604
26605 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26606 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26607
26608 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
26609 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
26610 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
26611 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
26612 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
26613 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
26614 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
26615 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
26616 one very small ACL:
26617 .code
26618 begin acl
26619 small_acl:
26620 accept hosts = one.host.only
26621 .endd
26622 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
26623 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
26624
26625 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
26626 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
26627 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
26628 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
26629 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
26630 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
26631 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
26632 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
26633
26634
26635 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
26636 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
26637 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
26638 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
26639 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
26640
26641
26642
26643 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
26644 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
26645 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
26646 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
26647 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
26648 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26649 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
26650 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
26651 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26652 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26653 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
26654 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26655 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
26656 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
26657 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
26658 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26659 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26660 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
26661 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
26662
26663 .table2 140pt
26664 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
26665 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
26666 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
26667 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
26668 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
26669 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
26670 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
26671 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
26672 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
26673 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
26674 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
26675 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
26676 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
26677 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
26678 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
26679 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
26680 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
26681 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
26682 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
26683 .endtable
26684
26685 For example, if you set
26686 .code
26687 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
26688 .endd
26689 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
26690 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
26691 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
26692 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
26693 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
26694 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
26695 testing as possible at RCPT time.
26696
26697
26698 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
26699 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26700 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
26701 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
26702 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
26703 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
26704 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
26705 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
26706 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
26707 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
26708 in any of these ACLs.
26709
26710 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
26711 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
26712 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
26713 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
26714 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
26715 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
26716 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
26717 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
26718 .code
26719 control = suppress_local_fixups
26720 .endd
26721 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
26722 run, it is too late.
26723
26724 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26725 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26726
26727 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
26728 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
26729 temporary error for these kinds of message.
26730
26731
26732 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
26733 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26734 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
26735 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
26736 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
26737 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
26738 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
26739 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
26740 &%smtp_banner%& option.
26741
26742
26743 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
26744 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26745 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26746 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
26747 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
26748 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
26749 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
26750 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
26751 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
26752
26753 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
26754 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
26755 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
26756 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
26757 an EHLO response.
26758
26759
26760 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
26761 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26762 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
26763 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
26764 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
26765 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
26766 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
26767 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
26768 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
26769 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
26770
26771 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
26772 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
26773 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
26774 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
26775 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
26776 associated with the DATA command.
26777
26778 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
26779 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
26780 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
26781 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
26782 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
26783 your resources.
26784
26785 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
26786 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
26787 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
26788 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
26789
26790 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
26791 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
26792 enabled (which is the default).
26793
26794 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
26795 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
26796 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
26797
26798 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26799
26800 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
26801
26802
26803 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
26804 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26805 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26806
26807 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26808
26809
26810 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
26811 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
26812 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
26813 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
26814 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
26815 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
26816 has been accepted.
26817
26818 The ACL test specfied by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
26819 has been recieved, and is executed for each recipient of the message.
26820 The test may accept or deny for inividual recipients.
26821 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
26822 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
26823 for some or all recipients.
26824
26825 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
26826 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
26827 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
26828 for this can be disabled when the MAIL-time $smtp_command included
26829 "PRDR". Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
26830 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
26831 will avoid doing so in some situations (eg. single-recipient mails).
26832
26833 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
26834 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
26835
26836 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26837 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
26838 the feature was not requested by the client.
26839
26840 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
26841 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26842 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
26843 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
26844 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
26845 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
26846
26847 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
26848 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
26849 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
26850 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
26851
26852 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
26853 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
26854
26855 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
26856 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
26857 response to QUIT.
26858
26859 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
26860 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
26861 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
26862 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
26863 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
26864
26865
26866 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
26867 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
26868 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
26869 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
26870 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
26871 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
26872 situation even worse.
26873
26874 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
26875 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
26876 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
26877 and &%warn%&.
26878
26879 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
26880 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
26881 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
26882 connection. The possible values are:
26883 .table2
26884 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
26885 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
26886 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
26887 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
26888 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
26889 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
26890 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
26891 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
26892 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
26893 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
26894 .endtable
26895 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
26896 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
26897 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
26898 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
26899 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
26900 used.
26901
26902
26903 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
26904 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
26905 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
26906 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
26907 .code
26908 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
26909 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
26910 .endd
26911 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
26912 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
26913 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
26914 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
26915 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
26916
26917 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
26918 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
26919 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
26920
26921 .ilist
26922 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
26923 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
26924 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
26925 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
26926 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
26927 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
26928 .code
26929 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
26930 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
26931 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
26932 .endd
26933 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
26934 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
26935 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
26936 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
26937 .next
26938 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
26939 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
26940 matches the string.
26941 .next
26942 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
26943 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
26944 want to have something like
26945 .code
26946 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
26947 .endd
26948 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
26949 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
26950 .endlist
26951
26952
26953
26954
26955 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
26956 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
26957 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
26958 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
26959 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
26960 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
26961 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
26962 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
26963 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
26964
26965 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
26966 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
26967 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
26968
26969
26970 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
26971 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
26972 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
26973 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
26974
26975 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
26976 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
26977 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
26978 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
26979 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
26980 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
26981 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
26982
26983
26984 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
26985 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
26986 recipients; it may create new recipients.
26987
26988
26989
26990 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
26991 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
26992 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
26993 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
26994 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
26995 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
26996
26997 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
26998 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
26999 used to accept or reject anything.
27000
27001 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27002 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27003 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27004 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27005
27006 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27007 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27008 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27009 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27010 configuration file.
27011
27012
27013
27014
27015 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27016 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27017 .vindex &$domain$&
27018 .vindex &$local_part$&
27019 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27020 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27021 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27022 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27023 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27024 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27025 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27026 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27027 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27028
27029 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27030 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27031 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27032 how it is used.
27033
27034 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27035 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27036 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27037 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27038 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27039 received).
27040
27041 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27042 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27043 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27044 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27045 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27046 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27047 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27048 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27049
27050
27051
27052
27053
27054 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27055 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27056 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27057 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27058 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27059 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27060 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27061 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27062 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27063 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27064 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27065 unencrypted connections.
27066 .code
27067 acl_check_auth:
27068 accept encrypted = *
27069 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27070 {CRAM-MD5}}
27071 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27072 .endd
27073 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27074 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27075 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27076 option to do this.)
27077
27078
27079
27080 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27081 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27082 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27083 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27084 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27085 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27086 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27087
27088 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27089 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27090 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27091 example:
27092 .code
27093 deny dnslists = list1.example
27094 dnslists = list2.example
27095 .endd
27096 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27097 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27098 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27099 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27100 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27101
27102
27103 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27104 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27105
27106 .ilist
27107 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27108 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27109 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27110 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27111 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27112 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27113 check a RCPT command:
27114 .code
27115 accept domains = +local_domains
27116 endpass
27117 verify = recipient
27118 .endd
27119 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27120 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27121 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27122 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27123 &%endpass%&.
27124
27125 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27126 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27127 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27128 configuration.
27129
27130 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27131 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27132 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27133 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27134 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27135 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27136 .display
27137 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27138 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27139 .endd
27140 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27141 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27142 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27143
27144 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27145 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27146 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27147 of &%endpass%&.
27148
27149
27150 .next
27151 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27152 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27153 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27154 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27155 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27156 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27157 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27158
27159
27160 .next
27161 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27162 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27163 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27164 example,
27165 .code
27166 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27167 .endd
27168 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27169
27170
27171 .next
27172 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27173 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27174 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27175 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27176 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27177 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27178 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27179 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27180 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27181
27182 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27183 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27184 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27185
27186
27187 .next
27188 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27189 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27190 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27191 .code
27192 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27193 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27194 .endd
27195 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27196 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27197
27198 .next
27199 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27200 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27201 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27202 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27203 .code
27204 require message = Sender did not verify
27205 verify = sender
27206 .endd
27207 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27208 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27209 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27210 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27211
27212 .next
27213 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27214 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27215 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27216 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27217 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27218 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27219 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27220
27221 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27222 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27223 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27224 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27225 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27226
27227 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27228 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27229 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27230 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27231 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27232 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27233 onwards.
27234
27235
27236 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27237 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27238 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27239 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27240 .code
27241 warn !verify = sender
27242 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27243 .endd
27244 .endlist
27245
27246 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27247
27248 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27249 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27250 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27251 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27252 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27253
27254
27255
27256 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27257 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27258 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27259 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27260 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27261 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27262 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27263 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27264 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27265 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27266 .ilist
27267 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27268 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27269 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27270 on the same SMTP connection.
27271 .next
27272 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27273 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27274 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27275 .endlist
27276
27277 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27278 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27279 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27280 .code
27281 accept hosts = whatever
27282 set acl_m4 = some value
27283 accept authenticated = *
27284 set acl_c_auth = yes
27285 .endd
27286 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27287 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27288 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27289
27290 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27291 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27292 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27293 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27294 error is generated.
27295
27296 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27297 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27298
27299
27300 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27301 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27302 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27303 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27304 .code
27305 deny domains = *.dom.example
27306 !verify = recipient
27307 .endd
27308 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27309 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27310 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27311 two statements are equivalent:
27312 .code
27313 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27314 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27315 .endd
27316 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27317 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27318
27319 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27320 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27321 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27322 .code
27323 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27324 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27325 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27326 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27327 .endd
27328 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27329 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27330 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27331 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27332 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27333 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27334 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27335
27336 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27337 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27338 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27339 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27340 message is handled.
27341
27342 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27343 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27344 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27345 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27346 .code
27347 require message = Can't verify sender
27348 verify = sender
27349 message = Can't verify recipient
27350 verify = recipient
27351 message = This message cannot be used
27352 .endd
27353 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27354 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27355 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27356 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27357 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27358 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27359
27360 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27361 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27362 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27363 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27364 .code
27365 deny hosts = ...
27366 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27367 message = Invalid sender from client host
27368 .endd
27369 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27370 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27371
27372
27373
27374 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27375 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27376 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27377
27378 .vlist
27379 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27380 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27381 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27382 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27383
27384 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27385 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
27386 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
27387 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
27388 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
27389 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
27390 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
27391 write rather ugly lines like this:
27392 .display
27393 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
27394 .endd
27395 Instead, all you need is
27396 .display
27397 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
27398 .endd
27399
27400 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27401 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27402 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
27403 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
27404 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
27405 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
27406 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
27407 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
27408
27409 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
27410 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
27411 in several different ways. For example:
27412
27413 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
27414 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
27415 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
27416 . ==== way.
27417
27418 .ilist
27419 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
27420 .code
27421 accept ...some conditions
27422 control = queue_only
27423 .endd
27424 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
27425 other words, when the conditions are all true.
27426
27427 .next
27428 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
27429 .code
27430 accept ...some conditions...
27431 control = queue_only
27432 ...some more conditions...
27433 .endd
27434 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
27435 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
27436 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
27437 to be relevant.
27438
27439 .next
27440 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
27441 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
27442 example:
27443 .code
27444 warn ...some conditions...
27445 control = freeze
27446 accept ...
27447 .endd
27448 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
27449 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
27450 log entry.
27451
27452 .next
27453 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
27454 &%require%& verb. For example:
27455 .code
27456 require control = no_multiline_responses
27457 .endd
27458 .endlist
27459
27460 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
27461 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
27462 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
27463 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
27464 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
27465 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
27466 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
27467 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
27468 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
27469
27470 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
27471 example:
27472 .code
27473 deny ...some conditions...
27474 delay = 30s
27475 .endd
27476 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
27477 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
27478 .code
27479 deny delay = 30s
27480 ...some conditions...
27481 .endd
27482 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
27483 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
27484 .code
27485 warn ...some conditions...
27486 delay = 2m
27487 control = freeze
27488 accept ...
27489 .endd
27490
27491 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
27492 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
27493 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
27494 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
27495 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
27496 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
27497 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
27498
27499
27500 .vitem &*endpass*&
27501 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
27502 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
27503 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
27504 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
27505 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
27506 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
27507 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
27508
27509
27510 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27511 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
27512 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
27513 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
27514 .code
27515 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
27516 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
27517 .endd
27518 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
27519 example:
27520 .display
27521 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
27522 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
27523 .endd
27524 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
27525 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
27526 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
27527 message.
27528
27529 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
27530 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
27531 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
27532 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
27533 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
27534 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
27535 ignored.
27536
27537 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27538 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
27539 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
27540 error message.
27541
27542 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
27543 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
27544 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
27545 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
27546 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
27547 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
27548
27549 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
27550 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
27551 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
27552 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
27553 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
27554 logging rejections.
27555
27556
27557 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
27558 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
27559 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
27560 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
27561 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
27562 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
27563 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
27564 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
27565 .display
27566 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
27567 &` log_reject_target =`&
27568 .endd
27569 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
27570 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
27571 current ACL.
27572
27573
27574 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27575 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
27576 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
27577 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
27578 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
27579 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
27580 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
27581 ACLs. For example:
27582 .display
27583 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
27584 &` control = freeze`&
27585 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
27586 .endd
27587 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
27588 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
27589 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
27590 example:
27591 .code
27592 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
27593 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
27594 .endd
27595
27596
27597 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27598 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27599 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
27600 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
27601 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
27602 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
27603 &%accept%& for details.)
27604
27605 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
27606 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
27607 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
27608 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
27609 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
27610 .code
27611 require message = Host not recognized
27612 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
27613 .endd
27614 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
27615 processed.)
27616
27617 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
27618 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
27619 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
27620 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
27621 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
27622 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
27623 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
27624 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
27625 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
27626 EHLO options.
27627
27628 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
27629 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
27630 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
27631 .code
27632 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
27633 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
27634 .endd
27635 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
27636 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
27637 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
27638 2&'xx'&.
27639
27640 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
27641 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
27642
27643 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
27644 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
27645 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
27646 response.
27647
27648 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27649 .new
27650 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
27651 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
27652 .wen
27653
27654 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
27655 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
27656 However, the original message is available in the variable
27657 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
27658 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
27659 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
27660 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
27661
27662 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
27663 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
27664 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
27665 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
27666 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
27667 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
27668 effect.
27669
27670
27671 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27672 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
27673 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
27674 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
27675
27676
27677 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
27678 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
27679 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
27680 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
27681
27682
27683 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
27684 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
27685 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
27686 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
27687 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
27688 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
27689 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
27690 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
27691 when:
27692 .code
27693 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
27694 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
27695 .endd
27696 .endlist
27697
27698
27699
27700
27701 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
27702 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27703 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
27704
27705 .vlist
27706 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
27707 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
27708 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
27709 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
27710 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
27711 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
27712 not work without it. For example:
27713 .code
27714 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
27715 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
27716 .endd
27717 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
27718 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
27719 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
27720 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
27721 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
27722
27723
27724 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
27725 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
27726 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
27727 .cindex "case of local parts"
27728 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27729 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
27730 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
27731 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
27732 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
27733 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
27734 is encountered.
27735
27736 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
27737 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
27738 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
27739 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
27740 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
27741
27742 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
27743 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
27744 spam score:
27745 .code
27746 warn control = caseful_local_part
27747 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
27748 $acl_m4 + \
27749 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
27750 }
27751 control = caselower_local_part
27752 .endd
27753 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
27754 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
27755
27756
27757 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
27758 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
27759 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
27760 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
27761 It is usable in the RCPT ACL and valid only for single-recipient mails forwarded
27762 from one SMTP connection to another. If a recipient-verify callout connection is
27763 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data, otherwise one is made
27764 after the ACL completes.
27765
27766 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
27767 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
27768 Note also that headers cannot be
27769 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
27770 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
27771
27772 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
27773 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
27774 before the entire message has been received from the source.
27775
27776 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
27777 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
27778 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
27779 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode the log line
27780 is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears before the acceptance "<="
27781 line.
27782
27783 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a (possibly faked)
27784 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
27785
27786
27787 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
27788 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
27789 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
27790 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
27791 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
27792 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
27793 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
27794 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
27795 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
27796 contexts):
27797 .code
27798 control = debug
27799 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
27800 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
27801 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
27802 .endd
27803
27804
27805 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
27806 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
27807 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
27808 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
27809 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27810
27811
27812 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
27813 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
27814 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
27815 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
27816 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
27817 strings or to numeric value.
27818 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
27819 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
27820 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
27821
27822 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
27823 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
27824 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
27825 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
27826 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
27827
27828
27829 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
27830 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
27831 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
27832 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
27833 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
27834 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
27835 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
27836 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
27837
27838 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27839 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
27840 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
27841 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
27842 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
27843 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
27844 work with.
27845
27846
27847 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
27848 .cindex "fake defer"
27849 .cindex "defer, fake"
27850 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
27851 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
27852 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
27853 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
27854 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
27855
27856 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
27857 .cindex "fake rejection"
27858 .cindex "rejection, fake"
27859 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
27860 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
27861 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
27862 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
27863 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27864 the same SMTP connection.
27865
27866 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
27867 message is supplied, the following is used:
27868 .code
27869 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
27870 550-kept for evaluation.
27871 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
27872 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
27873 .endd
27874 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
27875
27876 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
27877 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
27878 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27879 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27880 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
27881 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
27882 SMTP connection.
27883
27884 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
27885 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
27886 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
27887 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
27888
27889 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
27890 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
27891 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
27892 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27893 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
27894 disables such output flushing.
27895
27896 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
27897 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27898 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
27899 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27900 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
27901 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
27902
27903 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
27904 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
27905 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
27906 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
27907 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
27908 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
27909 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27910 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
27911 to be useful in production.
27912
27913 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
27914 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
27915 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
27916 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
27917 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
27918
27919 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
27920 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
27921 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
27922 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
27923 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
27924 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
27925
27926 .ilist
27927 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
27928 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
27929 verification failed"&) is sent.
27930 .next
27931 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
27932 line is output.
27933 .endlist
27934
27935 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
27936 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
27937
27938 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
27939 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
27940 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
27941 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
27942 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
27943 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
27944 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
27945
27946 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
27947 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
27948 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
27949 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27950 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27951 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
27952 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
27953 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
27954 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
27955 same SMTP connection.
27956
27957 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
27958 .cindex "message" "submission"
27959 .cindex "submission mode"
27960 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
27961 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
27962 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
27963 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
27964 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
27965 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
27966 late (the message has already been created).
27967
27968 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
27969 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
27970 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
27971 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
27972 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
27973
27974 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
27975 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
27976 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
27977 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
27978 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
27979
27980 .ilist
27981 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
27982 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
27983 .next
27984 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
27985 .next
27986 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
27987 .endlist ilist
27988
27989 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
27990 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
27991 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27992 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
27993 data is read.
27994
27995 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
27996 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
27997 .endlist vlist
27998
27999
28000 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28001 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28002
28003 .ilist
28004 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28005 .next
28006 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28007 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28008 .next
28009 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28010 .next
28011 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28012 .endlist
28013
28014
28015
28016 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28017 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28018 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28019 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28020 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28021 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28022 .code
28023 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28024 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28025 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28026 .endd
28027 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28028 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28029 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28030 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28031 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28032 RCPT ACL).
28033
28034 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28035 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28036
28037 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28038 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28039 contains one or more newlines that
28040 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28041 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28042 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28043
28044 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28045 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28046 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28047 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28048 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28049 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28050 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28051 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28052 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28053 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28054 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28055
28056 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28057 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28058 of message headers
28059 until they are added to the
28060 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28061 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28062 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28063 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28064 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28065 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28066 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28067
28068 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28069
28070 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28071 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28072 .display
28073 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28074 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28075
28076 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28077 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28078 .endd
28079 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28080 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28081 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28082 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28083 honoured.
28084
28085 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28086 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28087 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28088 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28089 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28090 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28091 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28092 specifications.
28093
28094 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28095 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28096 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28097 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28098 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28099
28100 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28101 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28102 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28103 to be a header name first.) For example:
28104 .code
28105 warn add_header = \
28106 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28107 .endd
28108 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28109 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28110 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28111 up in reverse order.
28112
28113 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28114 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28115 system filter or in a router or transport.
28116
28117
28118
28119 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28120 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28121 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28122 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28123 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28124 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28125 .code
28126 warn message = Remove internal headers
28127 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28128 .endd
28129 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28130 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28131 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28132 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28133 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28134 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28135
28136 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28137 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28138
28139 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28140 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28141 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28142 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28143 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28144 .code
28145 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28146 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28147 warn message = Remove internal headers
28148 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28149 .endd
28150 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28151 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28152 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28153 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28154 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28155 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28156 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28157 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28158 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28159 would have been removed.
28160
28161 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28162 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28163 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28164 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28165 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28166 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28167 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28168 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28169 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28170
28171 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28172 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28173 .display
28174 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28175 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28176
28177 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28178 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28179 .endd
28180 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28181 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28182 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28183 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28184 are honoured.
28185
28186 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28187 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28188 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28189
28190
28191
28192
28193 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28194 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28195 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28196 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28197 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28198 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28199
28200 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28201 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28202 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28203 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28204 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28205 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28206 The conditions are as follows:
28207
28208
28209 .vlist
28210 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28211 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28212 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28213 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28214 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28215 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28216 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28217 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28218 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28219 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28220 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28221 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28222
28223 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28224 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28225 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28226 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28227 The name and values are expanded separately.
28228
28229 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28230 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28231 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28232 conditions are tested.
28233
28234 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28235 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28236 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28237 for different local users or different local domains.
28238
28239 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28240 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28241 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28242 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28243 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28244 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28245 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28246 .code
28247 authenticated = *
28248 .endd
28249
28250 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28251 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28252 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28253 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28254 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28255 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28256 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28257 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28258 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28259 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28260 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28261 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28262 negative.
28263
28264 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28265 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28266 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28267 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28268 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28269 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28270 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28271 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28272
28273 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28274 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28275 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28276 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28277 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28278
28279 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28280 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28281 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28282 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28283 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28284 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28285 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28286 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28287 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28288 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28289
28290 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28291 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28292 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28293 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28294 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28295 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28296 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28297 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28298 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28299 &%domains%& test.
28300
28301 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28302 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28303
28304
28305 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28306 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28307 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28308 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28309 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28310 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28311 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28312 .code
28313 encrypted = *
28314 .endd
28315
28316
28317 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28318 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28319 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28320 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28321 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28322 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28323 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28324 .code
28325 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28326 .endd
28327 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28328 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28329 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28330
28331 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28332 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28333 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28334 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28335 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28336 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28337
28338 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28339 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28340 .code
28341 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28342 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28343 .endd
28344 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28345 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28346 statement can then check the IP address.
28347
28348 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28349 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28350 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28351 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28352 .code
28353 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28354 message = $host_data
28355 .endd
28356 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28357
28358 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28359 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28360 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28361 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28362 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28363 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28364 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28365 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28366 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28367 the next &%local_parts%& test.
28368
28369 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
28370 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
28371 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
28372 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
28373 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28374 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
28375 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28376
28377 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28378 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
28379 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28380 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28381 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28382 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
28383 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
28384 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28385
28386 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
28387 .cindex "rate limiting"
28388 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
28389 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
28390
28391 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28392 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
28393 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
28394 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
28395 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
28396 recipient address against a list of recipients.
28397
28398 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28399 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
28400 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28401 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28402 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
28403 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
28404 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28405
28406 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28407 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
28408 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28409 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
28410 .vindex "&$domain$&"
28411 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
28412 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
28413 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
28414 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
28415 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
28416 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
28417 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
28418 influence the sender checking.
28419
28420 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28421 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28422
28423 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28424 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
28425 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28426 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
28427 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
28428 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
28429 .code
28430 senders = :
28431 .endd
28432 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28433 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28434
28435 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
28436 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
28437 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
28438 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28439 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
28440 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28441
28442 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
28443 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28444 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28445 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28446 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
28447 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
28448 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
28449 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
28450 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
28451 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28452
28453 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
28454 .cindex "CSA verification"
28455 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
28456 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
28457 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
28458
28459 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
28460 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28461 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28462 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28463 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
28464 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28465 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28466 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
28467 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
28468 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
28469
28470 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
28471 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
28472 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
28473
28474 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
28475 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28476 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
28477 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
28478 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
28479 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
28480 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28481 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28482 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
28483 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
28484 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
28485 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
28486 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
28487 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
28488 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
28489
28490 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
28491 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
28492 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
28493 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
28494 .code
28495 deny senders = :
28496 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
28497 !verify = header_sender
28498 .endd
28499
28500 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
28501 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28502 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
28503 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
28504 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
28505 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28506 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28507 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
28508 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
28509 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
28510 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
28511 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
28512 appropriate.
28513
28514 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
28515 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
28516 .code
28517 To: @
28518 .endd
28519 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
28520 common as they used to be.
28521
28522 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
28523 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28524 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
28525 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
28526 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
28527 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
28528 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
28529 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
28530 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
28531 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
28532 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
28533 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
28534 independently of this condition.
28535
28536 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
28537 option), this condition is always true.
28538
28539
28540 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
28541 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
28542 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
28543 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
28544 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
28545 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
28546 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
28547 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
28548 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
28549
28550 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
28551 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
28552
28553
28554 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
28555 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28556 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
28557 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
28558 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
28559 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28560 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
28561 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
28562 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
28563 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
28564 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
28565 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
28566 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
28567 value for the child address.
28568
28569 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
28570 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28571 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
28572 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
28573 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
28574 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
28575 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
28576 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
28577 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
28578 original IP address.
28579
28580 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
28581 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
28582
28583 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
28584 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28585 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
28586 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
28587 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
28588 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
28589 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
28590 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
28591 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
28592
28593 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28594 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
28595 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
28596 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
28597 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
28598 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
28599 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
28600
28601 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
28602 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
28603 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
28604
28605 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
28606 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28607 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
28608 verified as a sender.
28609 .endlist
28610
28611
28612
28613 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
28614 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28615 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28616 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28617 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
28618 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
28619 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
28620 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
28621 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
28622 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
28623 .code
28624 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
28625 dialups.mail-abuse.org
28626 .endd
28627 the following records are looked up:
28628 .code
28629 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28630 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
28631 .endd
28632 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
28633 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
28634 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
28635 use two separate conditions:
28636 .code
28637 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28638 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28639 .endd
28640 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
28641 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
28642 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
28643 processed.
28644
28645 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
28646 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
28647 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
28648 following special items in the list:
28649 .display
28650 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
28651 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
28652 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
28653 .endd
28654 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
28655 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
28656 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
28657 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
28658 .code
28659 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
28660 .endd
28661 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
28662 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
28663 .code
28664 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28665 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
28666 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28667 .endd
28668 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
28669 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
28670 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
28671 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
28672
28673
28674
28675 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
28676 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
28677 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
28678 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
28679 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
28680 .code
28681 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
28682 .endd
28683 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
28684 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
28685 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
28686 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
28687
28688
28689
28690
28691 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
28692 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
28693 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
28694 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
28695 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
28696 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
28697 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
28698 .code
28699 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
28700 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28701 .endd
28702 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
28703 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
28704 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
28705 up by this example is
28706 .code
28707 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
28708 .endd
28709 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
28710 addresses. For example:
28711 .code
28712 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28713 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28714 .endd
28715 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
28716 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
28717
28718
28719
28720
28721 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
28722 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
28723 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
28724 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
28725 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
28726 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
28727 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
28728 either to double the separators like this:
28729 .code
28730 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
28731 .endd
28732 or to change the separator character, like this:
28733 .code
28734 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
28735 .endd
28736 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
28737 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
28738 occurs. Consider this condition:
28739 .code
28740 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
28741 .endd
28742 The DNS lookups that occur are:
28743 .code
28744 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
28745 a.domain.black.list.tld
28746 .endd
28747 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
28748 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
28749 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
28750 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
28751 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
28752 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
28753 error for a previous item.
28754
28755 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
28756 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
28757 .code
28758 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
28759 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
28760 .endd
28761 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
28762 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
28763 .code
28764 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
28765 $sender_address_domain \
28766 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
28767 see $dnslist_text.
28768 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
28769 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
28770 $sender_address_domain} }} }
28771 .endd
28772 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
28773 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
28774 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
28775 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
28776 .code
28777 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
28778 .endd
28779 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
28780 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
28781
28782 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
28783 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
28784
28785
28786
28787
28788 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
28789 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
28790 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
28791 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
28792 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
28793 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
28794 .display
28795 127.1.0.1 RBL
28796 127.1.0.2 DUL
28797 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
28798 127.1.0.4 RSS
28799 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
28800 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
28801 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
28802 .endd
28803 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
28804 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
28805 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
28806
28807
28808 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
28809 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
28810 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
28811 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
28812 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
28813 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
28814 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
28815 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
28816 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
28817 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
28818 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
28819 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
28820 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
28821 cases, for example:
28822 .code
28823 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
28824 .endd
28825 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
28826 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
28827 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
28828 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
28829 .code
28830 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
28831 .endd
28832 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
28833 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
28834
28835 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
28836 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
28837 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
28838 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
28839 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
28840 information.
28841
28842 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
28843 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
28844 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
28845 .code
28846 deny hosts = !+local_networks
28847 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
28848 at $dnslist_domain
28849 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
28850 .endd
28851
28852
28853
28854 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
28855 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
28856 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
28857 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
28858 For example,
28859 .code
28860 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
28861 .endd
28862 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
28863 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
28864 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
28865 describes how multiple records are handled.
28866
28867 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
28868 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
28869 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
28870 .code
28871 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28872 .endd
28873 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
28874 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
28875 first. For example:
28876 .code
28877 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
28878 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
28879 .endd
28880
28881 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
28882 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
28883 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
28884 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
28885 tested. For example:
28886 .code
28887 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
28888 .endd
28889 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
28890 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
28891 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
28892 .code
28893 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28894 .endd
28895 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
28896 an odd number.
28897
28898
28899
28900 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
28901 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
28902 condition. Whereas
28903 .code
28904 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28905 .endd
28906 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28907 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
28908 .code
28909 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28910 .endd
28911 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28912 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
28913 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
28914 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
28915
28916 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
28917 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
28918
28919 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
28920 previous example is precisely equivalent to
28921 .code
28922 deny dnslists = a.b.c
28923 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28924 .endd
28925 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
28926 Consider this example:
28927 .code
28928 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28929 list.dsbl.org : \
28930 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
28931 relays.ordb.org
28932 .endd
28933 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
28934 .code
28935 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28936 list.dsbl.org
28937 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
28938 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
28939 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
28940 .endd
28941 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
28942
28943
28944
28945
28946 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
28947 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
28948 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
28949 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
28950 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
28951 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
28952 .code
28953 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
28954 .endd
28955 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
28956 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
28957 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
28958 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
28959 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
28960 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
28961
28962 .ilist
28963 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
28964 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
28965 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28966 .next
28967 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
28968 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
28969 changed to:
28970 .code
28971 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
28972 .endd
28973 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28974 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
28975 .code
28976 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
28977 .endd
28978 for the condition to be true.
28979 .endlist
28980
28981 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
28982 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
28983 .ilist
28984 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
28985 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
28986 .code
28987 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
28988 .endd
28989 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28990 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28991 .next
28992 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
28993 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
28994 .code
28995 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
28996 .endd
28997 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28998 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
28999 .code
29000 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29001 .endd
29002 for the condition to be false.
29003 .endlist
29004 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29005 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29006
29007
29008
29009
29010 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29011 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29012 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29013 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29014 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29015 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29016 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29017 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29018 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29019 lists.
29020
29021 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29022 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29023 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29024 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29025 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29026 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29027 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29028 .code
29029 reject message = \
29030 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29031 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29032 dnslists = \
29033 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29034 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29035 .endd
29036 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29037 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29038 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29039 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29040 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29041 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29042
29043 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29044 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29045 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29046 .code
29047 reject dnslists = \
29048 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29049 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29050 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29051 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29052 .endd
29053 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29054 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29055 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29056
29057
29058
29059 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29060 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29061 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29062 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29063 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29064 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29065 .code
29066 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29067 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29068 .endd
29069 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29070 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29071 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29072 .code
29073 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29074 .endd
29075 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29076 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29077
29078 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29079 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29080 .code
29081 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29082 dnslists = some.list.example
29083 .endd
29084
29085 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29086 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29087 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29088 .code
29089 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29090 .endd
29091
29092 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29093 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29094 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29095 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29096 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29097 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29098 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29099 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29100 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29101 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29102 .display
29103 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29104 .endd
29105 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29106 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29107
29108 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29109 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29110 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29111 of &'p'&.
29112
29113 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29114 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29115 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29116 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29117 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29118 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29119 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29120 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29121 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29122
29123 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29124 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29125 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29126 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29127
29128 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29129 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29130 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29131 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29132 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29133 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29134 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29135 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29136 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29137 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29138
29139 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29140 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29141 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29142 ACL.
29143
29144 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29145 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29146 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29147 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29148 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29149 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29150
29151 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29152 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29153 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29154 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29155 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29156 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29157 the &%count=%& option.
29158
29159
29160 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29161 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29162 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29163 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29164 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29165
29166 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29167 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29168 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29169 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29170
29171 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29172 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29173 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29174 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29175 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29176 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29177 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29178
29179 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29180 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29181 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29182 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29183 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
29184 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29185 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29186
29187 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29188 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29189 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29190 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29191 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29192
29193 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29194 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29195 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29196 multiple different commands.
29197
29198 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29199 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29200 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29201 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29202 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29203
29204 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29205
29206
29207 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29208 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29209 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29210 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29211 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29212
29213 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29214 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29215
29216 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29217 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29218 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29219 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29220 new rate.
29221 .code
29222 acl_check_connect:
29223 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29224 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29225 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29226 # ...
29227 acl_check_mail:
29228 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29229 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29230 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29231 .endd
29232
29233 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29234 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29235 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29236 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29237 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29238 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29239 checks.
29240
29241 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29242 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29243 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29244 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29245 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29246
29247
29248 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29249 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29250 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29251 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29252 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29253 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29254 rest of the ACL.
29255
29256 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29257 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29258 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29259 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29260 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29261 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29262 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29263 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29264 from getting any email through.
29265
29266 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29267 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29268 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29269 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29270 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29271 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29272 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29273 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29274 .code
29275 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29276 .endd
29277
29278
29279 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29280 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29281 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29282 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29283 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29284 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29285 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29286 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29287 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29288
29289 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29290 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29291 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29292 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29293 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29294 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29295
29296 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29297 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29298 rate.
29299
29300 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29301 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29302 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29303 required increases with larger limits.
29304
29305 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29306 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29307 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29308 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29309 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29310 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29311 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29312 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29313 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29314 as intended.
29315
29316
29317 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29318 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29319 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29320 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29321 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29322 message. For example:
29323 .code
29324 # Log all senders' rates
29325 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29326 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29327
29328 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29329 # at the decimal point.
29330 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29331 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29332 $sender_rate_limit }s
29333
29334 # Keep authenticated users under control
29335 deny authenticated = *
29336 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29337
29338 # System-wide rate limit
29339 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29340 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29341
29342 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29343 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29344 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29345 messages per $sender_rate_period
29346 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29347 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29348 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29349 .endd
29350 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29351 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29352 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29353 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29354 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29355 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29356 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29357
29358
29359
29360 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29361 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29362 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
29363 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
29364 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
29365 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
29366 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
29367 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
29368 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
29369 .code
29370 verify = sender/callout
29371 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
29372 .endd
29373 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
29374 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
29375 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
29376 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
29377 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
29378 The available options are as follows:
29379
29380 .ilist
29381 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
29382 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
29383 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
29384 .next
29385 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
29386 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
29387 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
29388 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
29389 .next
29390 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
29391 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
29392 .next
29393 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
29394 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
29395 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
29396 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
29397 .endlist
29398
29399 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
29400 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
29401 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
29402 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29403 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
29404 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
29405 coding like this:
29406 .code
29407 warn !verify = sender
29408 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
29409 .endd
29410 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
29411 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
29412 verification failure.
29413
29414 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
29415 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
29416
29417 .ilist
29418 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
29419 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
29420 .next
29421 &%route%&: Routing failed.
29422 .next
29423 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
29424 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
29425 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
29426 .next
29427 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
29428 .next
29429 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
29430 .endlist
29431
29432 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
29433 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
29434
29435
29436
29437
29438 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
29439 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
29440 .cindex "callout" "verification"
29441 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
29442 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
29443 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
29444 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
29445 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
29446 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
29447 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
29448 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
29449 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
29450 sender's domain.
29451
29452 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
29453 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
29454 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
29455 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
29456 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
29457 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
29458
29459 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
29460 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
29461 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
29462 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
29463 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
29464
29465 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
29466 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
29467 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
29468 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
29469 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
29470 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
29471 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
29472 supplies a host list.
29473 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
29474
29475 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
29476 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
29477 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
29478 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
29479 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
29480 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
29481 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
29482
29483 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
29484 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
29485 following SMTP commands are sent:
29486 .display
29487 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
29488 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
29489 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
29490 &`QUIT`&
29491 .endd
29492 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
29493 set to &"lmtp"&.
29494
29495 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
29496 settings.
29497
29498 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
29499 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
29500 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
29501 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
29502 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
29503 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
29504
29505 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
29506 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
29507 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
29508 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
29509 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
29510
29511 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29512 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
29513 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
29514 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
29515 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
29516
29517
29518
29519
29520 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
29521 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
29522 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
29523 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
29524 .code
29525 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
29526 .endd
29527 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
29528 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
29529 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
29530
29531
29532 .vlist
29533 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
29534 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
29535 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
29536 For example:
29537 .code
29538 verify = sender/callout=5s
29539 .endd
29540 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
29541 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
29542 the &%connect%& parameter.
29543
29544
29545 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29546 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
29547 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
29548 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
29549 .code
29550 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
29551 .endd
29552 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
29553
29554 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
29555 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
29556 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
29557 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
29558 updated in this circumstance.
29559
29560 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
29561 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
29562 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
29563 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
29564 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
29565 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
29566
29567
29568 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29569 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
29570 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
29571 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
29572 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
29573 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
29574 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
29575 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
29576 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
29577 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
29578 .code
29579 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
29580 .endd
29581 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
29582
29583
29584 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29585 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
29586 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
29587 For example:
29588 .code
29589 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
29590 .endd
29591 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
29592 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
29593 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
29594 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
29595 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
29596
29597
29598 .vitem &*no_cache*&
29599 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
29600 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
29601 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
29602
29603 .vitem &*postmaster*&
29604 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
29605 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
29606 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
29607 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
29608 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
29609 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
29610 made, until the cache record expires.
29611
29612 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29613 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
29614 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
29615 For example:
29616 .code
29617 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
29618 .endd
29619 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
29620 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
29621 .code
29622 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
29623 .endd
29624 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
29625 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
29626 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
29627 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
29628
29629
29630 .vitem &*random*&
29631 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
29632 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
29633 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
29634 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
29635 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
29636 .code
29637 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
29638 .endd
29639 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
29640 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
29641 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
29642 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
29643 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
29644
29645 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
29646 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
29647 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29648 .code
29649 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
29650 .endd
29651 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29652 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
29653 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
29654 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
29655 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
29656
29657 .vitem &*use_sender*&
29658 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29659 .code
29660 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
29661 .endd
29662 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
29663 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
29664 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
29665 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
29666 usefulness of callout caching.
29667 .endlist
29668
29669 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
29670 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
29671 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
29672 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
29673 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
29674 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
29675 these circumstances.
29676
29677 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
29678 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
29679 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
29680 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
29681 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
29682 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
29683 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
29684
29685 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
29686 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
29687 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
29688 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
29689
29690
29691
29692
29693 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
29694 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
29695 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
29696 .cindex "caching" "callout"
29697 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
29698 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
29699 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
29700 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
29701 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
29702 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
29703
29704 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
29705 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
29706 is not available.
29707
29708 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
29709 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
29710 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
29711
29712 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
29713 commands up to and including
29714 .code
29715 MAIL FROM:<>
29716 .endd
29717 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
29718 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
29719 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
29720 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
29721 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
29722 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
29723 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
29724
29725 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
29726 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
29727 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
29728 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
29729 will eventually be noticed.
29730
29731 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
29732 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
29733 behaviour will be the same.
29734
29735
29736
29737 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
29738 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
29739 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
29740 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
29741 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
29742 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
29743 you might see:
29744 .code
29745 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
29746 250 OK
29747 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
29748 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
29749 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
29750 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
29751 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
29752 550 Sender verification failed
29753 .endd
29754 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
29755 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
29756 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
29757 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
29758 example:
29759 .code
29760 verify = sender/no_details
29761 .endd
29762
29763 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
29764 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
29765 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
29766 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
29767 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
29768 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
29769 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
29770
29771 .ilist
29772 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
29773 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
29774 verification also fails.
29775 .next
29776 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
29777 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
29778 .endlist
29779
29780 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
29781 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
29782 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
29783 .code
29784 A.Wol: aw123
29785 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
29786 .endd
29787 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
29788 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
29789 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
29790 verification to succeed.
29791
29792 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
29793 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
29794 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
29795 option. For example:
29796 .code
29797 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
29798 .endd
29799 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
29800 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
29801
29802 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
29803 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
29804 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
29805 address and a report is output for each of them.
29806
29807
29808
29809 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
29810 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
29811 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
29812 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
29813 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
29814 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
29815 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
29816 .code
29817 verify = csa
29818 .endd
29819 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
29820 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
29821 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
29822 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
29823 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
29824 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
29825
29826 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
29827 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
29828 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
29829 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
29830
29831 .ilist
29832 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
29833 .next
29834 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
29835 .next
29836 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
29837 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
29838 .next
29839 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
29840 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
29841 .endlist
29842
29843 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
29844 use for the DNS query. The default is:
29845 .code
29846 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
29847 .endd
29848 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
29849 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
29850 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
29851 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
29852 meaningful to say:
29853 .code
29854 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
29855 .endd
29856 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
29857 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
29858 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
29859
29860 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
29861 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
29862 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
29863 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
29864 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
29865 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
29866 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
29867 of legitimate HELO domains.
29868
29869 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
29870 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
29871 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
29872 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
29873 lookup such as:
29874 .code
29875 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
29876 .endd
29877 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
29878 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
29879 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
29880
29881
29882
29883
29884 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
29885 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
29886 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
29887 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
29888 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
29889 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
29890 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
29891 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
29892
29893 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
29894 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
29895 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
29896 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
29897 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
29898 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
29899 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
29900
29901 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
29902 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
29903 like this:
29904 .code
29905 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
29906 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
29907 }{$value}}
29908 .endd
29909 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
29910 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
29911 use this:
29912 .code
29913 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
29914 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
29915 senders = :
29916 recipients = +batv_senders
29917
29918 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
29919 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
29920 senders = :
29921 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
29922 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
29923 !condition = $prvscheck_result
29924 .endd
29925 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
29926 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
29927 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
29928 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
29929 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
29930
29931 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
29932 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
29933 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
29934 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
29935 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
29936 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
29937 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
29938
29939 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
29940 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
29941 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
29942 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
29943 .code
29944 batv_redirect:
29945 driver = redirect
29946 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
29947 .endd
29948 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
29949 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
29950 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
29951 local addresses.
29952
29953 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
29954 can be used:
29955 .code
29956 external_smtp_batv:
29957 driver = smtp
29958 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
29959 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
29960 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
29961 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
29962 {$value}fail}}}
29963 .endd
29964 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
29965
29966
29967
29968 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
29969 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
29970 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
29971 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
29972 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
29973 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
29974 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
29975 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
29976 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
29977 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
29978
29979 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
29980 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
29981 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
29982 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
29983 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
29984 same host is fulfilling both functions,
29985 . ///
29986 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
29987 . ///
29988 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
29989 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
29990 system to arbitrary domains.
29991
29992
29993 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
29994 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
29995 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
29996 example, suppose you want to do the following:
29997
29998 .ilist
29999 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30000 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30001 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30002 .next
30003 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30004 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30005 .next
30006 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30007 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30008 .endlist
30009
30010
30011 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30012 .code
30013 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30014 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30015 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30016 .endd
30017 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30018 command:
30019 .code
30020 acl_check_rcpt:
30021 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30022 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30023 .endd
30024 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30025 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30026 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30027 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30028 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30029 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30030 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30031
30032
30033
30034 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30035 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30036 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30037 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30038 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30039
30040 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30041 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30042 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30043 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30044 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30045 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30046 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30047 .ecindex IIDacl
30048
30049
30050
30051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30052 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30053
30054 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30055 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30056 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30057 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30058 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30059 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30060 specification.
30061
30062 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30063 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30064 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30065 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30066 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30067
30068 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30069 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30070 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30071
30072 .ilist
30073 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30074 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30075 .next
30076 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30077 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30078 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30079 .next
30080 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30081 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30082 .next
30083 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30084 conditions.
30085 .next
30086 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30087 .endlist
30088
30089 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30090 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30091 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30092
30093 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30094 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30095 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30096 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30097 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30098 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30099
30100 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30101 temporarily created in a file called:
30102 .display
30103 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30104 .endd
30105 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30106 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30107 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30108 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30109 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30110 .code
30111 control = no_mbox_unspool
30112 .endd
30113 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30114 same directory by default.
30115
30116
30117
30118 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30119 .cindex "virus scanning"
30120 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30121 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30122 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30123 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30124 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30125 in memory and thus are much faster.
30126
30127
30128 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30129 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
30130 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30131 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30132 .display
30133 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30134 .endd
30135 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30136 .code
30137 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30138 .endd
30139 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30140 before use.
30141 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30142 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30143
30144 .vlist
30145 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30146 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30147 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30148 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30149 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30150 example:
30151 .code
30152 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30153 .endd
30154
30155
30156 .vitem &%clamd%&
30157 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30158 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30159 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30160 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30161 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
30162 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
30163 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
30164 .code
30165 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30166 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30167 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30168 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30169 .endd
30170 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
30171 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30172 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30173 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30174 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30175 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30176 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30177
30178 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30179 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30180 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30181 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30182 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30183 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30184 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30185 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30186 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30187 .code
30188 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30189 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30190 (Connection refused)
30191 .endd
30192
30193 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30194 contributing the code for this scanner.
30195
30196 .vitem &%cmdline%&
30197 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30198 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30199 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30200 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30201
30202 .olist
30203 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30204 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30205
30206 .next
30207 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30208 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30209 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30210 the &"trigger"& expression.
30211
30212 .next
30213 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30214 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30215 &"name"& expression.
30216 .endlist olist
30217
30218 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30219 .code
30220 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30221 .endd
30222 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30223 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30224 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30225 configuration setting:
30226 .code
30227 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30228 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30229 found in file:'(.+)'
30230 .endd
30231 .vitem &%drweb%&
30232 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30233 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
30234 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
30235 separated by white space, as in these examples:
30236 .code
30237 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30238 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30239 .endd
30240 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30241 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30242
30243 .vitem &%fsecure%&
30244 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30245 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30246 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30247 .code
30248 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30249 .endd
30250 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30251 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30252
30253 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30254 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30255 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30256 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30257 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30258 For example:
30259 .code
30260 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30261 .endd
30262 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30263
30264 .vitem &%mksd%&
30265 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30266 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30267 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30268 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30269 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30270 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30271 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30272 .code
30273 av_scanner = mksd:2
30274 .endd
30275 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30276
30277 .vitem &%sock%&
30278 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30279 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30280 running on the local machine.
30281 There are four options:
30282 an address (which may be an IP addres and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30283 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30284 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30285 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30286 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30287 For example:
30288 .code
30289 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
30290 .endd
30291 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
30292 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
30293 Both regular-expressions are required.
30294
30295 .vitem &%sophie%&
30296 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
30297 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
30298 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
30299 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
30300 client communication. For example:
30301 .code
30302 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
30303 .endd
30304 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
30305 the option.
30306 .endlist
30307
30308 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
30309 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
30310 ACL.
30311
30312 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
30313 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
30314 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
30315 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
30316 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
30317 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
30318 message.
30319
30320 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
30321 use. It can then be one of
30322
30323 .ilist
30324 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
30325 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
30326 recommended usage.
30327 .next
30328 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
30329 the condition fails immediately.
30330 .next
30331 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
30332 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
30333 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
30334 .endlist
30335
30336 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
30337 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
30338 causes the ACL to defer.
30339
30340 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
30341 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
30342 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
30343 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
30344 logging data.
30345
30346 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
30347 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
30348 &%malware%& condition.
30349
30350 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
30351 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
30352
30353 Here is a very simple scanning example:
30354 .code
30355 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30356 demime = *
30357 malware = *
30358 .endd
30359 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
30360 .code
30361 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30362 demime = *
30363 malware = */defer_ok
30364 .endd
30365 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
30366 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
30367 .code
30368 av_scanner = $acl_m0
30369 .endd
30370 in the main Exim configuration.
30371 .code
30372 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30373 set acl_m0 = sophie
30374 malware = *
30375
30376 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30377 set acl_m0 = aveserver
30378 malware = *
30379 .endd
30380
30381
30382 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
30383 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
30384 .cindex "spam scanning"
30385 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
30386 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
30387 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
30388 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
30389 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
30390 .code
30391 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
30392 .endd
30393 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
30394 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
30395 nicely, however.
30396
30397 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
30398 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
30399 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
30400 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
30401 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
30402 .code
30403 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
30404 .endd
30405 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
30406 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
30407 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
30408 address/port pair:
30409 .code
30410 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
30411 .endd
30412 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
30413 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
30414 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
30415 option, separated with colons:
30416 .code
30417 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
30418 192.168.2.11 783 : \
30419 192.168.2.12 783
30420 .endd
30421 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
30422 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
30423 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
30424 condition defers.
30425
30426 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
30427 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
30428
30429 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
30430 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
30431 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
30432 expansion.
30433
30434 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
30435 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
30436 .code
30437 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30438 spam = joe
30439 .endd
30440 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
30441 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
30442 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
30443 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
30444 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
30445
30446 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
30447 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
30448 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
30449 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
30450 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
30451 are not set.
30452
30453 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
30454 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
30455 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
30456
30457
30458 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
30459 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
30460 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
30461 example:
30462 .code
30463 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30464 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
30465 spam = nobody
30466 .endd
30467
30468 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
30469 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
30470 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
30471 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
30472
30473 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
30474 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
30475 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
30476 available for use at delivery time.
30477
30478 .vlist
30479 .vitem &$spam_score$&
30480 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
30481 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
30482
30483 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
30484 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
30485 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
30486 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
30487 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
30488
30489 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
30490 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
30491 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
30492 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
30493 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
30494
30495 .vitem &$spam_report$&
30496 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
30497 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
30498 .endlist
30499
30500 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
30501 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
30502 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
30503
30504 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
30505 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
30506 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
30507 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
30508 spam condition, like this:
30509 .code
30510 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30511 spam = joe/defer_ok
30512 .endd
30513 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
30514
30515 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
30516 condition:
30517 .code
30518 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
30519 warn spam = nobody:true
30520 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
30521 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
30522
30523 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
30524 # is over threshold
30525 warn spam = nobody
30526 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
30527
30528 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
30529 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
30530 spam = nobody:true
30531 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
30532 .endd
30533
30534
30535
30536 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
30537 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
30538 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30539 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
30540 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
30541 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
30542 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
30543 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
30544 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
30545 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
30546 cases.
30547
30548 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
30549 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
30550 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
30551 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
30552 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
30553 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
30554 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
30555
30556 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
30557 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
30558 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
30559 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
30560 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
30561
30562 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
30563 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
30564 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
30565 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
30566 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
30567 syntax is:
30568 .display
30569 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
30570 .endd
30571 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
30572 the value can be:
30573
30574 .olist
30575 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
30576 .next
30577 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
30578 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
30579 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
30580 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
30581 .next
30582 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
30583 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
30584 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
30585 the full path and file name.
30586 .next
30587 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
30588 filename, and the default path is then used.
30589 .endlist
30590 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
30591 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
30592 a file with its original, proposed filename using
30593 .code
30594 decode = $mime_filename
30595 .endd
30596 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
30597 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
30598 automatically unlinked.
30599
30600 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
30601 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
30602 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
30603 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
30604 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
30605
30606 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
30607 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
30608 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
30609
30610 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
30611 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
30612 available in the MIME ACL:
30613
30614 .vlist
30615 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
30616 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
30617 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
30618 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
30619 contains the empty string.
30620
30621 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
30622 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
30623 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
30624 .code
30625 us-ascii
30626 gb2312 (Chinese)
30627 iso-8859-1
30628 .endd
30629 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
30630 case-insensitively.
30631
30632 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
30633 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
30634 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
30635 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
30636 only used for display purposes.
30637
30638 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
30639 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
30640 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
30641
30642 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
30643 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
30644 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
30645
30646 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
30647 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30648 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
30649 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
30650 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
30651
30652 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
30653 This variable contains the normalized content of the
30654 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
30655 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
30656
30657 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
30658 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
30659 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
30660 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
30661 .code
30662 text/plain
30663 text/html
30664 application/octet-stream
30665 image/jpeg
30666 audio/midi
30667 .endd
30668 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
30669 empty string.
30670
30671 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
30672 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30673 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
30674 containing the decoded data.
30675 .endlist
30676
30677 .cindex "RFC 2047"
30678 .vlist
30679 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
30680 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
30681 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
30682 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
30683 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
30684 found, this variable contains the empty string.
30685
30686 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
30687 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
30688 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
30689 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
30690
30691 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
30692 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
30693 follows:
30694
30695 .olist
30696 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
30697
30698 .next
30699 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
30700 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
30701
30702 .next
30703 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
30704 and the rest are attachments.
30705
30706 .next
30707 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
30708 .endlist olist
30709
30710 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
30711 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
30712 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
30713 .code
30714 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
30715 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
30716 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
30717 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
30718 .endd
30719 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
30720 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
30721 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
30722 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
30723 want to carry out specific actions on them.
30724
30725 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
30726 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
30727 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
30728 decoding is fully recursive.
30729
30730 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
30731 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
30732 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
30733 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
30734 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
30735 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
30736 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
30737 .endlist
30738
30739
30740
30741 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
30742 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
30743 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
30744 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
30745 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
30746
30747 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
30748 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
30749 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
30750 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
30751 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
30752
30753 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
30754 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
30755 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
30756 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
30757 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
30758 32K characters are checked.
30759
30760 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
30761 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
30762 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
30763 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
30764 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
30765 .code
30766 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
30767 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
30768 .endd
30769 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
30770 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
30771 matching regular expression.
30772
30773 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
30774 CPU-intensive.
30775
30776
30777
30778
30779 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
30780 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
30781 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30782 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
30783 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
30784 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
30785 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
30786 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
30787 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
30788 use the &%demime%& condition.
30789
30790 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
30791 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
30792 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
30793 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
30794 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
30795 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
30796
30797 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
30798 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
30799 example:
30800 .code
30801 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
30802 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
30803 .endd
30804 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
30805 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
30806 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
30807 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
30808
30809 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
30810 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
30811 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
30812
30813 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
30814
30815 .vlist
30816 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
30817 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
30818 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
30819 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
30820 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
30821 zero, no error occurred.
30822
30823 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
30824 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
30825 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
30826 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
30827 .endlist
30828
30829 .vlist
30830 .vitem &$found_extension$&
30831 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
30832 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
30833 extension it found.
30834 .endlist
30835
30836 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
30837 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
30838
30839 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
30840 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
30841 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
30842 facility:
30843 .code
30844 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
30845 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
30846 demime = *
30847 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
30848
30849 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
30850 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
30851 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
30852 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
30853
30854 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
30855 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
30856 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
30857 demime = exe:doc
30858 control = freeze
30859 .endd
30860 .ecindex IIDcosca
30861
30862
30863
30864
30865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30867
30868 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
30869 "Local scan function"
30870 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
30871 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
30872 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
30873 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
30874 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
30875
30876 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
30877 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
30878 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
30879 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
30880 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
30881
30882 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
30883 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
30884 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
30885 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
30886
30887 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
30888 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
30889 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
30890 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
30891
30892 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
30893 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
30894 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
30895 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
30896 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
30897 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
30898 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
30899 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
30900 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
30901
30902
30903
30904 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
30905 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
30906 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
30907 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
30908 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
30909 directory, so you might set
30910 .code
30911 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
30912 .endd
30913 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
30914 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
30915 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
30916 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
30917 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
30918 _src/local_scan.c_.
30919
30920 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
30921 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
30922 .code
30923 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30924 .endd
30925 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
30926
30927
30928
30929
30930 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
30931 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
30932 You must include this line near the start of your code:
30933 .code
30934 #include "local_scan.h"
30935 .endd
30936 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
30937 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
30938 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
30939 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
30940 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
30941 strings and pointers to character strings:
30942 .code
30943 #define CS (char *)
30944 #define CCS (const char *)
30945 #define CSS (char **)
30946 #define US (unsigned char *)
30947 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
30948 #define USS (unsigned char **)
30949 .endd
30950 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
30951 .code
30952 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
30953 .endd
30954 The arguments are as follows:
30955
30956 .ilist
30957 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
30958 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
30959 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
30960
30961 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
30962 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
30963 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
30964 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
30965 case this changes in some future version.
30966 .next
30967 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
30968 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
30969 .endlist
30970
30971 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
30972
30973 .vlist
30974 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
30975 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
30976 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
30977 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
30978 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
30979 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
30980
30981 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
30982 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30983 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
30984
30985 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
30986 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30987 queued without immediate delivery.
30988
30989 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
30990 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
30991 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
30992 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
30993 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
30994 used.
30995
30996 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
30997 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
30998 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
30999 problem"& is used.
31000
31001 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31002 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31003 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31004 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31005 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31006 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31007 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31008
31009 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31010 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31011 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31012 .endlist
31013
31014 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31015 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31016 &%-oe%& command line options.
31017
31018
31019
31020 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31021 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31022 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31023 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31024 want to do this, you must have the line
31025 .code
31026 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31027 .endd
31028 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31029 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31030 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31031 to define them.
31032
31033 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31034 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31035 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31036 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31037 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31038 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31039 .code
31040 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31041 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31042
31043 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31044 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31045 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31046 };
31047
31048 int local_scan_options_count =
31049 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31050 .endd
31051 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31052 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31053 .code
31054 begin local_scan
31055 my_integer = 99
31056 my_string = some string of text...
31057 .endd
31058 The available types of option data are as follows:
31059
31060 .vlist
31061 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31062 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31063 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31064 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31065 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31066 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31067 values.)
31068
31069 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31070 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31071 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31072 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31073
31074 .vitem &*opt_int*&
31075 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31076 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31077 Exim.
31078
31079 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31080 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31081 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31082 printed with the suffix K or M.
31083
31084 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31085 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31086 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31087 always output in octal.
31088
31089 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31090 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31091 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31092
31093 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31094 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31095 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31096 .endlist
31097
31098 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31099 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31100
31101
31102
31103 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31104 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31105 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31106 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31107 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31108 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31109 C variables are as follows:
31110
31111 .vlist
31112 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31113 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31114
31115 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31116 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31117
31118 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31119 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31120 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31121 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31122
31123 .ilist
31124 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31125 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31126 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31127
31128 .next
31129 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31130 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31131 of debugging bits.
31132 .endlist ilist
31133
31134 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31135 selected, you should use code like this:
31136 .code
31137 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31138 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31139 .endd
31140 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31141 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31142 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31143
31144 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31145 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31146 discussed below.
31147
31148 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31149 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31150
31151 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31152 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31153
31154 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31155 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31156 &%-bh%& command line option.
31157
31158 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31159 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31160 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31161
31162 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31163 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31164 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31165 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31166
31167 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31168 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31169 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31170
31171 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31172 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31173
31174 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31175 The number of accepted recipients.
31176
31177 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31178 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31179 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31180 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31181 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31182 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31183 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31184 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31185 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31186 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
31187 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
31188 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
31189
31190 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
31191 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
31192
31193 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
31194 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
31195 locally-submitted messages.
31196
31197 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
31198 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
31199 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
31200
31201 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
31202 The name of the sending host, if known.
31203
31204 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
31205 The port on the sending host.
31206
31207 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
31208 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
31209
31210 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
31211 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
31212
31213 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
31214 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
31215 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
31216 .endlist
31217
31218
31219 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
31220 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
31221 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
31222 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
31223 their type to *.
31224
31225
31226 .vlist
31227 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
31228 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
31229
31230 .vitem &*int&~type*&
31231 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
31232 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
31233 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
31234 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
31235 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
31236 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
31237
31238 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
31239 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
31240 internal newlines.
31241
31242 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
31243 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
31244 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
31245 .endlist
31246
31247
31248
31249 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
31250 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
31251
31252 .vlist
31253 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
31254 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
31255
31256 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
31257 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
31258 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
31259 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
31260
31261 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
31262 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
31263 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
31264 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
31265 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
31266 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
31267 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
31268 is NULL for all recipients.
31269 .endlist
31270
31271
31272
31273 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
31274 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
31275 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
31276 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
31277 release:
31278
31279 .vlist
31280 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
31281 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
31282
31283 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
31284 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
31285 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
31286 for the process in &%newumask%&.
31287
31288 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
31289 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
31290 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
31291 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
31292 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
31293
31294 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
31295
31296 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
31297 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
31298 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
31299 return value is as follows:
31300
31301 .ilist
31302 >= 0
31303
31304 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
31305 ending status.
31306
31307 .next
31308 < 0 and > &--256
31309
31310 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
31311 signal number.
31312
31313 .next
31314 &--256
31315
31316 The process timed out.
31317 .next
31318 &--257
31319
31320 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
31321 .endlist
31322
31323 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
31324 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
31325 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
31326 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
31327 forks a subprocess that is running
31328 .code
31329 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
31330 .endd
31331 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
31332 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
31333 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
31334 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
31335
31336 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
31337 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
31338 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
31339 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
31340
31341
31342 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
31343 *sender_authentication)*&
31344 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
31345 that it runs is:
31346 .display
31347 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
31348 .endd
31349 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
31350
31351
31352 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
31353 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
31354 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
31355 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
31356 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
31357 .code
31358 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31359 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31360 .endd
31361
31362 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
31363 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
31364 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
31365 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
31366 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
31367 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
31368 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
31369 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
31370
31371 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
31372 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
31373 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
31374 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
31375 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
31376 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
31377
31378 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
31379 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
31380 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
31381 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
31382
31383 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
31384 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
31385 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
31386 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
31387 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
31388 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
31389 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
31390 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
31391 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
31392 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
31393 .code
31394 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
31395 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
31396 .endd
31397 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
31398 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
31399
31400
31401 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
31402 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
31403 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
31404 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
31405 match the specification, the function does nothing.
31406
31407
31408 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
31409 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
31410 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
31411 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
31412 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
31413 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
31414 .code
31415 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
31416 .endd
31417 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
31418 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
31419 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
31420 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
31421 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
31422 zero-terminated.
31423
31424 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
31425 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
31426 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
31427 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
31428 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
31429 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
31430 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
31431 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
31432
31433 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
31434 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
31435 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
31436 .display
31437 &`OK `& match succeeded
31438 &`FAIL `& match failed
31439 &`DEFER `& match deferred
31440 .endd
31441 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
31442 inability to contact a database.
31443
31444 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31445 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
31446 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
31447 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
31448 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
31449
31450 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31451 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
31452 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
31453 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
31454 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
31455
31456 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
31457 uschar&~*list)*&"
31458 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
31459 expected to be
31460 .code
31461 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
31462 .endd
31463 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
31464 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
31465 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
31466 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
31467 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
31468 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
31469 failed.
31470
31471 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
31472 *format,&~...)*&"
31473 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
31474 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
31475 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
31476 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
31477 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
31478 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
31479
31480
31481 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
31482 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
31483 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
31484 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
31485
31486 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
31487 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
31488 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
31489 value afterwards. For example:
31490 .code
31491 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
31492 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
31493 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
31494 .endd
31495
31496 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
31497 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
31498 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
31499 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
31500 address.
31501 .endlist
31502
31503
31504 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31505 .vlist
31506 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
31507 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
31508 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
31509 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
31510 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
31511 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
31512 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
31513 binary string is returned with an error message.
31514
31515 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
31516 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
31517 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
31518
31519 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
31520 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
31521 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
31522 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
31523 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
31524
31525 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
31526 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
31527 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
31528
31529 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
31530 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
31531 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
31532 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
31533 with translation.
31534
31535
31536 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
31537 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
31538 below.
31539
31540 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
31541 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
31542 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
31543 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
31544 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
31545 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
31546 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
31547 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
31548 is involved.
31549
31550 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
31551 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
31552
31553 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
31554 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
31555 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
31556 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
31557 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
31558 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
31559 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
31560 .code
31561 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
31562 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
31563 .endd
31564 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
31565 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
31566 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
31567 multiple output lines.
31568
31569 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
31570 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
31571 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
31572 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
31573 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
31574 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
31575 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
31576 is an error.
31577
31578 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
31579 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
31580 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
31581 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31582
31583 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
31584 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
31585 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31586
31587 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
31588 See below.
31589
31590 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
31591 See below.
31592
31593 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
31594 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
31595 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
31596 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
31597 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
31598 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
31599 more discussion.
31600 .endlist
31601
31602
31603
31604 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
31605 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
31606 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
31607 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
31608 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
31609 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
31610 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
31611 terminates.
31612
31613 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
31614 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
31615 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
31616 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
31617
31618 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
31619 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
31620 .code
31621 store_pool = POOL_PERM
31622 .endd
31623 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
31624 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
31625 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
31626 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
31627
31628 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
31629 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
31630 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
31631 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
31632 &%store_pool%&.
31633 .ecindex IIDlosca
31634
31635
31636
31637
31638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31640
31641 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
31642 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
31643 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
31644 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
31645 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
31646 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
31647 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
31648 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
31649
31650 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
31651 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
31652 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
31653 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
31654 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
31655
31656 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
31657 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
31658 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
31659 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
31660 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
31661 prevent it happening on retries.
31662
31663 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31664 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31665 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
31666 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
31667 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
31668 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
31669 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
31670 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
31671
31672
31673 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
31674 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
31675 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
31676 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
31677 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
31678 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
31679 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
31680 .code
31681 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
31682 system_filter_user = exim
31683 .endd
31684 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
31685 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
31686 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
31687 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
31688 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
31689 by the &%reply%& command.
31690
31691
31692 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
31693 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
31694 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
31695 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
31696
31697 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
31698 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
31699
31700
31701
31702 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
31703 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
31704 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
31705 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
31706 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
31707 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
31708 they cause errors.
31709
31710 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
31711 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
31712 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
31713 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
31714 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
31715 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
31716 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
31717
31718 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
31719 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
31720 succeed, it will not be tried again.
31721 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
31722 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
31723
31724 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
31725 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
31726 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
31727 to which users' filter files can refer.
31728
31729
31730
31731 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
31732 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
31733 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
31734 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
31735 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
31736
31737
31738
31739 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
31740 .cindex "freezing messages"
31741 .cindex "message" "freezing"
31742 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
31743 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
31744 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
31745 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
31746 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
31747 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
31748 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
31749 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
31750 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
31751 .code
31752 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
31753 .endd
31754 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
31755
31756 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
31757 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
31758 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
31759 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
31760 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
31761 run.
31762
31763 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
31764 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
31765 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
31766 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
31767
31768 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
31769 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
31770 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
31771 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
31772 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
31773 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
31774 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
31775 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
31776 message. For example:
31777 .code
31778 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
31779 because it contains attachments that we are \
31780 not prepared to receive."
31781 .endd
31782
31783 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
31784 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
31785 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
31786 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
31787 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
31788 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
31789 use, for example
31790 .code
31791 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
31792 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
31793 .endd
31794 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
31795 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
31796 generated by the filter.
31797
31798 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
31799 &%defer%&,
31800 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
31801 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
31802 as
31803 .code
31804 mail ...
31805 freeze
31806 .endd
31807 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
31808 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
31809 take place.
31810
31811
31812
31813 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
31814 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
31815 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
31816 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
31817 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
31818 .code
31819 headers add <string>
31820 headers remove <string>
31821 .endd
31822 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
31823 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
31824 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
31825 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
31826 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
31827
31828 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
31829 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
31830 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
31831 example:
31832 .code
31833 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
31834 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
31835 X-header-2: ...."
31836 .endd
31837 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
31838 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
31839 space after input continuations is ignored.
31840
31841 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
31842 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
31843 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
31844 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
31845 header with the same name, they are all removed.
31846
31847 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
31848 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
31849 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
31850 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
31851 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
31852 used for all recipients of the message.
31853
31854 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
31855 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
31856 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
31857 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
31858 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
31859 until the message is actually being written (see section
31860 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
31861
31862 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
31863 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
31864 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
31865 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
31866 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
31867 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
31868 modified more than once.
31869
31870 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
31871 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
31872 For example:
31873 .code
31874 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
31875 headers remove "Subject"
31876 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
31877 headers remove "Old-Subject"
31878 .endd
31879
31880
31881
31882 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
31883 .cindex "envelope sender"
31884 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
31885 .code
31886 errors_to <some address>
31887 .endd
31888 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
31889 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
31890 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
31891 might use
31892 .code
31893 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
31894 .endd
31895 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
31896 address if its delivery failed.
31897
31898
31899
31900 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
31901 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31902 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31903 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
31904 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
31905 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
31906 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
31907 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
31908 which implements such a filter:
31909 .code
31910 central_filter:
31911 check_local_user
31912 driver = redirect
31913 domains = +local_domains
31914 file = /central/filters/$local_part
31915 no_verify
31916 allow_filter
31917 allow_freeze
31918 .endd
31919 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
31920 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
31921 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
31922 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
31923
31924 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
31925 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
31926 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
31927 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
31928 normal way.
31929 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
31930 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
31931 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
31932
31933
31934
31935
31936
31937
31938 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31939 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31940
31941 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
31942 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
31943 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
31944 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
31945 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
31946 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
31947 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
31948 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
31949
31950 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
31951 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
31952 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
31953 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
31954 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
31955
31956 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
31957 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
31958 loopback interface specially in any way.
31959
31960 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
31961 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
31962
31963
31964
31965
31966 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
31967 .cindex "message" "submission"
31968 .cindex "submission mode"
31969 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
31970 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
31971 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
31972 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
31973 .code
31974 control = submission
31975 .endd
31976 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
31977 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
31978 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
31979 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
31980 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
31981 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
31982 .code
31983 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
31984 control = submission
31985 .endd
31986 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
31987 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
31988 is used to separate options. For example:
31989 .code
31990 control = submission/sender_retain
31991 .endd
31992 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
31993 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
31994 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
31995 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
31996 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
31997 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
31998 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
31999
32000 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32001 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32002 example:
32003 .code
32004 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32005 .endd
32006 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32007 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32008 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32009 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32010 .code
32011 accept authenticated = *
32012 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32013 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32014 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32015 .endd
32016 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32017 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32018 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32019 .code
32020 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32021 .endd
32022 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32023 line would be:
32024 .code
32025 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32026 .endd
32027 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32028 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32029 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32030 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32031
32032 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32033 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32034 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32035 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32036 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32037 spoof another's address.
32038
32039 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32040 .cindex "line endings"
32041 .cindex "carriage return"
32042 .cindex "linefeed"
32043 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32044 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32045 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32046 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32047 use CRLF or just CR.
32048
32049 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32050 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32051 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32052 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32053 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32054 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32055 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32056 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32057 follows:
32058
32059 .ilist
32060 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32061 .next
32062 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32063 is ignored.
32064 .next
32065 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32066 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32067 terminator.
32068 .next
32069 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32070 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32071 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32072 people trying to play silly games.
32073 .next
32074 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32075 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32076 line.
32077 .endlist
32078
32079
32080
32081
32082
32083 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32084 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32085 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32086 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32087 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32088 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32089 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32090 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32091
32092 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32093 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32094 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32095 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32096 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32097
32098 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32099 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32100 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32101 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32102 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32103 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32104 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32105 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32106
32107
32108
32109
32110 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32111 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32112 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32113 .cindex "sender" "address"
32114 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32115 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32116 .cindex "envelope sender"
32117 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32118 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32119 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32120 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32121 .code
32122 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32123 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32124 .endd
32125 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32126 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32127 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32128 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32129 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32130 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32131 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32132 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32133 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32134
32135 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32136 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32137 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32138 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32139 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32140 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32141 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32142
32143 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32144 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32145 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32146
32147 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32148 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32149 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32150 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32151
32152
32153
32154 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32155 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32156 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32157 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32158 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32159 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32160 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32161
32162 .blockquote
32163 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32164 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32165 .endblockquote
32166
32167 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32168 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32169 follows:
32170
32171 .ilist
32172 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32173 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32174 .next
32175 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32176 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32177 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32178 .next
32179 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32180 also removed.
32181 .next
32182 For a locally-submitted message,
32183 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32184 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32185 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32186 included in log lines in this case.
32187 .next
32188 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
32189 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
32190 .endlist
32191
32192
32193
32194
32195 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
32196 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
32197 includes the header line:
32198 .code
32199 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
32200 .endd
32201
32202 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
32203 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
32204 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
32205 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
32206 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
32207 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
32208
32209
32210 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
32211 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
32212 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
32213 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
32214 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
32215
32216 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
32217 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
32218 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
32219 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
32220 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
32221 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
32222 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
32223 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
32224 messages.
32225
32226
32227 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
32228 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
32229 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
32230 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
32231 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
32232 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
32233 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
32234 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
32235 messages.
32236
32237
32238 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
32239 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
32240 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32241 .cindex "message" "submission"
32242 .cindex "submission mode"
32243 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
32244 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
32245
32246 .ilist
32247 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
32248 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
32249 .next
32250 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
32251 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
32252 .olist
32253 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32254 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
32255 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
32256 .next
32257 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
32258 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
32259 .next
32260 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
32261 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
32262 .endlist
32263 .endlist
32264
32265 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
32266
32267 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
32268 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
32269 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
32270 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32271 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
32272 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
32273 &%qualify_domain%&.
32274
32275 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
32276 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
32277 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
32278 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32279
32280
32281 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
32282 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
32283 .cindex "message" "submission"
32284 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
32285 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
32286 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
32287 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
32288 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
32289 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
32290 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
32291 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
32292 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
32293 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
32294
32295
32296 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
32297 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
32298 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
32299 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
32300 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
32301
32302 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
32303 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
32304 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
32305 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
32306
32307 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
32308 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
32309 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
32310
32311
32312 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
32313 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
32314 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
32315 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
32316 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
32317 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
32318 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
32319 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
32320 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
32321 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
32322 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
32323
32324
32325
32326 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
32327 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
32328 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
32329 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
32330 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
32331 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
32332 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
32333 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
32334
32335
32336
32337 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
32338 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
32339 .cindex "message" "submission"
32340 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
32341 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
32342 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
32343 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
32344 control setting.
32345
32346 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
32347 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
32348 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
32349 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
32350 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
32351 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
32352 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
32353 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
32354 line is added to the message.
32355
32356 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
32357 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
32358 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
32359 options true at the same time.
32360
32361 .cindex "submission mode"
32362 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
32363 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
32364 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
32365 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
32366
32367 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
32368 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
32369 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
32370 created as follows:
32371
32372 .ilist
32373 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32374 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
32375 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
32376 .next
32377 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
32378 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
32379 .next
32380 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
32381 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
32382 .endlist
32383
32384 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
32385 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
32386 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
32387 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
32388
32389 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
32390 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
32391 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
32392 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
32393
32394
32395
32396 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
32397 "SECTheadersaddrem"
32398 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
32399 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
32400 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
32401 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
32402 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
32403 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
32404 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
32405
32406 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
32407 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
32408 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
32409 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
32410 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
32411 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
32412
32413 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
32414 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
32415 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
32416
32417 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
32418 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
32419 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
32420 .code
32421 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
32422 X-added-second: another added header line
32423 .endd
32424 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
32425
32426 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
32427 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
32428 Each header-line is separately expanded.
32429
32430 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
32431 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
32432 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
32433 not part of the names. For example:
32434 .code
32435 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
32436 .endd
32437
32438 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
32439 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
32440 Each item is separately expanded.
32441
32442 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
32443 items are expanded at routing time,
32444 and then associated with all addresses that are
32445 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
32446 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
32447 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
32448
32449 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
32450 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
32451 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
32452 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
32453
32454 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
32455 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
32456 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
32457 requirements.
32458
32459 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
32460 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
32461 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
32462 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
32463 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
32464 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
32465 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
32466
32467 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
32468 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
32469 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
32470 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
32471
32472 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
32473 the following consequences:
32474
32475 .ilist
32476 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
32477 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
32478 to it, at all times.
32479 .next
32480 Header lines that are added by a router's
32481 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
32482 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
32483 .next
32484 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
32485 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
32486 .next
32487 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
32488 a later router or by a transport.
32489 .next
32490 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
32491 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
32492 .code
32493 headers_remove = subject
32494 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
32495 .endd
32496 .endlist
32497
32498 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
32499 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
32500
32501
32502
32503
32504
32505 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
32506 .cindex "address" "constructed"
32507 .cindex "constructed address"
32508 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
32509 the form
32510 .display
32511 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
32512 .endd
32513 For example:
32514 .code
32515 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
32516 .endd
32517 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
32518 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
32519 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
32520 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
32521 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
32522 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
32523 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
32524 there is no password file entry.
32525
32526 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32527 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
32528 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
32529 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
32530 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
32531 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
32532 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
32533 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
32534 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
32535
32536
32537
32538 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
32539 .cindex "case of local parts"
32540 .cindex "local part" "case of"
32541 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
32542 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
32543 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
32544 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
32545 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
32546 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
32547 router option.
32548
32549 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
32550 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
32551 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
32552 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
32553 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
32554 .code
32555 correct_case:
32556 driver = redirect
32557 domains = +local_domains
32558 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
32559 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
32560 @$domain
32561 .endd
32562 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
32563 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
32564 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
32565 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
32566 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
32567
32568
32569
32570 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
32571 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
32572 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
32573 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
32574 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
32575 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
32576 empty components for compatibility.
32577
32578
32579
32580 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
32581 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
32582 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
32583 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
32584 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
32585 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
32586
32587 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
32588 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
32589 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
32590 example, a header such as
32591 .code
32592 To: hare@teaparty
32593 .endd
32594 might get rewritten as
32595 .code
32596 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
32597 .endd
32598 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
32599 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
32600 been routed.
32601
32602 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
32603 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
32604 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
32605 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
32606 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
32607 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
32608 .ecindex IIDmesproc
32609
32610
32611
32612 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32613 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32614
32615 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
32616 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
32617 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
32618 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
32619 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
32620 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
32621 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
32622
32623 .ilist
32624 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
32625 .next
32626 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
32627 .next
32628 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
32629 .endlist
32630
32631 For mail delivery, the following are available:
32632
32633 .ilist
32634 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
32635 .next
32636 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
32637 &"lmtp"&);
32638 .next
32639 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
32640 transport);
32641 .next
32642 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
32643 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
32644 .endlist
32645
32646 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
32647 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
32648 used to contain the envelope information.
32649
32650
32651
32652 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
32653 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
32654 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
32655 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
32656 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
32657 .cindex "EHLO"
32658 .cindex "HELO"
32659 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32660 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
32661 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
32662 processing is the same in both cases.
32663
32664 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
32665 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
32666 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
32667 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
32668 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
32669 .cindex "transport" "filter"
32670 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
32671 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
32672 suppressed.
32673
32674 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
32675 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
32676 required for the transaction.
32677
32678 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
32679 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
32680 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
32681 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
32682 is called for verification.
32683
32684 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
32685 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
32686 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
32687
32688 .cindex "carriage return"
32689 .cindex "linefeed"
32690 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32691 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
32692 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32693 line terminator.
32694
32695 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
32696 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
32697 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
32698 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
32699 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
32700 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
32701 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
32702 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
32703 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
32704
32705 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
32706 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
32707 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
32708 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
32709
32710 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
32711 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
32712 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
32713 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
32714
32715 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32716 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
32717 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
32718 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
32719 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
32720 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
32721 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
32722 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
32723 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
32724 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
32725
32726 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
32727 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
32728
32729 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32730 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
32731 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
32732 square bracket of the IP address.
32733
32734
32735
32736
32737 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
32738 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
32739 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
32740 .cindex "host" "error"
32741 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
32742 message errors, and recipient errors.
32743
32744 .vlist
32745 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
32746 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
32747 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
32748
32749 .ilist
32750 Connection refused or timed out,
32751 .next
32752 Any error response code on connection,
32753 .next
32754 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
32755 .next
32756 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
32757 .next
32758 I/O errors at any time,
32759 .next
32760 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
32761 the &"."& at the end of the data.
32762 .endlist ilist
32763
32764 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
32765 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
32766 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
32767 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
32768 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
32769 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
32770 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
32771 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
32772
32773 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
32774 .cindex "message" "error"
32775 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
32776 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
32777 message errors are:
32778
32779 .ilist
32780 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
32781 the data,
32782 .next
32783 Timeout after MAIL,
32784 .next
32785 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
32786 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
32787 connection at any other time.
32788 .endlist ilist
32789
32790 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
32791 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
32792 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
32793 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
32794 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
32795 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
32796 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
32797 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
32798 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
32799 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
32800
32801 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
32802 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
32803 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
32804 response to MAIL.
32805
32806 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
32807 .cindex "recipient" "error"
32808 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
32809 recipient errors are:
32810
32811 .ilist
32812 Any error response to RCPT,
32813 .next
32814 Timeout after RCPT.
32815 .endlist
32816
32817 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
32818 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
32819 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
32820 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
32821 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
32822 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
32823 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
32824 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
32825 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
32826 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
32827 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
32828 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
32829 the retry clock is reset.
32830
32831 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
32832 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
32833 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
32834 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
32835 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
32836 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
32837 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
32838 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
32839 recipient's retry time.
32840 .endlist
32841
32842 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
32843 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
32844 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
32845 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
32846 until the next delivery attempt.
32847
32848 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
32849 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
32850 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
32851 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
32852 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
32853 is created.
32854
32855 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
32856 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
32857 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
32858 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
32859 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
32860 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
32861 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
32862
32863 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
32864 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
32865 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
32866 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
32867 then to be treated as a host error.
32868
32869 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
32870 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
32871 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
32872 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
32873 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
32874
32875
32876
32877
32878 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
32879 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
32880 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
32881 .cindex "inetd"
32882 .cindex "daemon"
32883 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
32884 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
32885 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
32886 .code
32887 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
32888 .endd
32889 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
32890 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
32891 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
32892 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
32893 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
32894 stream and exits with an error code.
32895
32896 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
32897 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
32898 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
32899 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
32900
32901 .cindex "carriage return"
32902 .cindex "linefeed"
32903 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32904 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
32905 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32906 line terminator.
32907 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
32908 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
32909 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
32910
32911 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
32912 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
32913 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
32914 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
32915 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
32916 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
32917 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
32918 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
32919
32920 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32921 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
32922 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
32923 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
32924 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
32925 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
32926 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
32927 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
32928 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
32929
32930 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
32931 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
32932 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
32933
32934 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
32935 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
32936 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
32937 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
32938 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
32939
32940 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
32941 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
32942 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
32943 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
32944 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
32945 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
32946 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
32947
32948 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
32949 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
32950 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
32951 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
32952 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
32953
32954 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
32955 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
32956 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
32957 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
32958 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
32959 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
32960 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
32961 a delivery process.
32962
32963 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
32964 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
32965 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
32966 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
32967 however, available with &'inetd'&.
32968
32969 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
32970 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
32971 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
32972 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
32973
32974 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
32975 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
32976 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
32977
32978
32979
32980 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
32981 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
32982 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
32983 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
32984 the error response to the last command. The default value for
32985 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
32986 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
32987 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
32988
32989
32990 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
32991 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
32992 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
32993 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
32994 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
32995 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
32996 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
32997 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
32998 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
32999 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33000 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33001
33002
33003
33004 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33005 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33006 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33007 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33008 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33009 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33010 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33011 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33012
33013 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33014 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33015 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33016 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33017 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33018 counted.
33019
33020 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33021 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33022 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33023
33024 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33025 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33026 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33027 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33028 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33029
33030
33031
33032
33033 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33034 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33035 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33036 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33037 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33038
33039 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33040 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33041 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33042
33043 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33044 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33045 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33046 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33047 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33048 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33049 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33050 RCPT failures.
33051
33052
33053
33054 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33055 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33056 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33057 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33058 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33059 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33060 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33061
33062 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33063 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33064 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33065 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33066 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33067 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33068 argument. For example,
33069 .code
33070 ETRN #brigadoon
33071 .endd
33072 runs the command
33073 .code
33074 exim -R brigadoon
33075 .endd
33076 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33077 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33078 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33079 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33080 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33081
33082 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33083 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33084 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33085 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33086 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33087 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33088 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33089 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33090
33091 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33092 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33093 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33094 whatever the form of its argument. For
33095 example:
33096 .code
33097 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33098 $sender_host_address
33099 .endd
33100 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33101 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33102 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33103 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33104 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33105 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33106 for it to change them before running the command.
33107
33108
33109
33110 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33111 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33112 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33113 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33114 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33115 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33116 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33117 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33118 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33119 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33120 runs for RCPT commands:
33121 .code
33122 accept hosts = :
33123 .endd
33124 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33125
33126
33127
33128 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33129 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33130 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33131 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33132 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33133 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33134 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33135 envelope along with the message.
33136
33137 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33138 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33139 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33140 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33141 can be used to specify it.
33142
33143 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33144 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33145 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33146 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33147 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33148
33149 .vindex "&$host$&"
33150 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33151 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33152 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33153 router:
33154 .code
33155 begin routers
33156 route_append:
33157 driver = manualroute
33158 transport = smtp_appendfile
33159 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33160
33161 begin transports
33162 smtp_appendfile:
33163 driver = appendfile
33164 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33165 batch_max = 1000
33166 use_bsmtp
33167 user = exim
33168 .endd
33169 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33170 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33171 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33172
33173
33174
33175 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33176 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33177 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
33178 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33179 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33180 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33181 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33182 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33183 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
33184 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
33185
33186 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
33187 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
33188
33189 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
33190 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
33191 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
33192 make some use of automatically, for example:
33193 .code
33194 554 Unexpected end of file
33195 Transaction started in line 10
33196 Error detected in line 14
33197 .endd
33198 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
33199 file, for example:
33200 .code
33201 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
33202 The error message was:
33203
33204 501 '>' missing at end of address
33205
33206 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
33207 The error was detected in line 12.
33208 The SMTP command at fault was:
33209
33210 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
33211
33212 1 previous message was successfully processed.
33213 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
33214 .endd
33215 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
33216 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
33217 accepted.
33218 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
33219 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
33220
33221
33222
33223 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33224 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33225
33226 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
33227 "Customizing messages"
33228 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
33229 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
33230 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
33231 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
33232 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
33233
33234 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
33235 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
33236 option. Exim also adds the line
33237 .code
33238 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
33239 .endd
33240 to all warning and bounce messages,
33241
33242
33243 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
33244 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
33245 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
33246 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
33247 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
33248 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
33249 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
33250
33251 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
33252 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
33253 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
33254 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
33255 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
33256 item.
33257
33258 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
33259 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
33260 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
33261 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
33262 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
33263 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
33264 option, rounded to a whole number.
33265
33266 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
33267
33268 .ilist
33269 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
33270 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
33271 .next
33272 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
33273 failing addresses with their error messages.
33274 .next
33275 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
33276 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
33277 .next
33278 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
33279 as part of the error report.
33280 .next
33281 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
33282 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
33283 .next
33284 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
33285 .endlist
33286
33287 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
33288 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
33289 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
33290 .code
33291 Subject: Mail delivery failed
33292 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33293 {: returning message to sender}}
33294 ****
33295 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
33296
33297 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33298 {that you sent }{sent by
33299
33300 <$sender_address>
33301
33302 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
33303 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
33304 ****
33305 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
33306 ****
33307 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
33308 ------
33309 ****
33310 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
33311 only the first
33312 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
33313 ****
33314 .endd
33315 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
33316 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
33317 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
33318 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
33319 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
33320 text sections:
33321
33322 .ilist
33323 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
33324 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
33325 .next
33326 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
33327 the delayed addresses.
33328 .next
33329 The third item then ends the message.
33330 .endlist
33331
33332 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
33333 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
33334 .code
33335 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
33336 $warn_message_delay
33337 ****
33338 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
33339
33340 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
33341 {that you sent }{sent by
33342
33343 <$sender_address>
33344
33345 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
33346 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
33347
33348 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
33349 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
33350 The date of the message is: $h_date
33351
33352 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
33353 ****
33354 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
33355 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
33356 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
33357 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
33358 the message will be returned to you.
33359 .endd
33360 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
33361 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
33362 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
33363 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
33364 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
33365 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
33366 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
33367 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
33368 handled them.
33369
33370
33371
33372
33373 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33374 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33375
33376 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
33377 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
33378 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
33379
33380
33381
33382 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
33383 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
33384 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
33385 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
33386 routing explicitly:
33387 .code
33388 send_to_smart_host:
33389 driver = manualroute
33390 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
33391 transport = remote_smtp
33392 .endd
33393 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
33394 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
33395 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
33396 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
33397 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
33398
33399
33400
33401
33402 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
33403 .cindex "mailing lists"
33404 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
33405 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
33406 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
33407
33408 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
33409 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
33410 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
33411 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
33412 .code
33413 lists:
33414 driver = redirect
33415 domains = lists.example
33416 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
33417 forbid_pipe
33418 forbid_file
33419 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
33420 no_more
33421 .endd
33422 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
33423 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
33424 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
33425 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
33426
33427 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
33428 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
33429 a mailing list.
33430
33431 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
33432 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
33433 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
33434 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
33435 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
33436
33437 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
33438 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
33439 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
33440 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
33441 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
33442 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
33443 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
33444 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
33445 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
33446
33447
33448
33449 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
33450 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
33451 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
33452 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
33453 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
33454 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
33455 addresses are not rigorously checked.
33456
33457 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
33458 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
33459 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
33460 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
33461 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
33462
33463
33464
33465 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
33466 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
33467 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
33468 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
33469 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
33470 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
33471 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
33472 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
33473 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
33474 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
33475
33476 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
33477 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
33478 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
33479 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
33480 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
33481 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
33482 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
33483 pre-existing messages.
33484
33485 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
33486 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
33487 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
33488 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
33489 one level of expansion anyway.
33490
33491
33492
33493 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
33494 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
33495 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
33496 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
33497 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
33498 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
33499
33500 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
33501 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
33502 .code
33503 lists_request:
33504 driver = redirect
33505 domains = lists.example
33506 local_part_suffix = -request
33507 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
33508 no_more
33509
33510 lists_post:
33511 driver = redirect
33512 domains = lists.example
33513 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
33514 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
33515 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
33516 forbid_pipe
33517 forbid_file
33518 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
33519 no_more
33520
33521 lists_closed:
33522 driver = redirect
33523 domains = lists.example
33524 allow_fail
33525 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
33526 .endd
33527 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
33528 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
33529 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
33530 mailing list.
33531
33532 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
33533 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
33534 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
33535 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
33536 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
33537 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
33538 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
33539 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
33540 &"unrouteable address"& error.
33541
33542 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
33543 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
33544 the address, giving a suitable error message.
33545
33546
33547
33548
33549 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
33550 .cindex "VERP"
33551 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
33552 .cindex "envelope sender"
33553 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
33554 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
33555 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
33556 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
33557 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
33558 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
33559
33560 .oindex &%errors_to%&
33561 .oindex &%return_path%&
33562 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
33563 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
33564 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
33565 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
33566 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
33567 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
33568 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
33569 .code
33570 verp_smtp:
33571 driver = smtp
33572 max_rcpt = 1
33573 return_path = \
33574 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33575 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33576 .endd
33577 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
33578 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
33579 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
33580 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
33581 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
33582 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
33583 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
33584 rewritten as
33585 .code
33586 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
33587 .endd
33588 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33589 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
33590 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
33591 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
33592 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
33593 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
33594
33595 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
33596 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
33597 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
33598 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
33599 .code
33600 dnslookup:
33601 driver = dnslookup
33602 domains = ! +local_domains
33603 transport = \
33604 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33605 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
33606 no_more
33607 .endd
33608 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
33609 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
33610 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
33611 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
33612 address.
33613
33614 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
33615 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
33616 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
33617 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
33618 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
33619 .code
33620 verp_dnslookup:
33621 driver = dnslookup
33622 domains = ! +local_domains
33623 transport = remote_smtp
33624 errors_to = \
33625 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
33626 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33627 no_more
33628 .endd
33629 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
33630 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
33631 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
33632 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
33633 them.
33634
33635 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
33636 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
33637 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
33638 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
33639 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
33640 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
33641 used).
33642
33643
33644
33645
33646
33647
33648 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
33649 .cindex "virtual domains"
33650 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
33651 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
33652 meanings:
33653
33654 .ilist
33655 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
33656 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
33657 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
33658 .next
33659 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
33660 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
33661 have login accounts on that host.
33662 .endlist
33663
33664 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
33665 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
33666 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
33667 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
33668 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
33669 to a router of this form:
33670 .code
33671 virtual:
33672 driver = redirect
33673 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
33674 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
33675 no_more
33676 .endd
33677 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
33678 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
33679 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
33680 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
33681 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
33682 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
33683
33684 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
33685 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
33686 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
33687 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
33688
33689 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
33690 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
33691 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
33692 .code
33693 my_domains:
33694 driver = accept
33695 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
33696 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
33697 transport = my_mailboxes
33698 .endd
33699 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
33700 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
33701 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
33702 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
33703 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
33704 follows:
33705 .code
33706 my_mailboxes:
33707 driver = appendfile
33708 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
33709 user = mail
33710 .endd
33711 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
33712 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
33713
33714 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
33715 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
33716 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
33717 information about the domains.
33718
33719
33720
33721 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
33722 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
33723 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
33724 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
33725 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
33726 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
33727 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
33728 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
33729 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
33730 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
33731 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
33732 example, consider this router:
33733 .code
33734 userforward:
33735 driver = redirect
33736 check_local_user
33737 file = $home/.forward
33738 local_part_suffix = -*
33739 local_part_suffix_optional
33740 allow_filter
33741 .endd
33742 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
33743 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
33744 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
33745 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
33746 .code
33747 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
33748 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
33749 endif
33750 .endd
33751 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
33752 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
33753 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
33754 control over which suffixes are valid.
33755
33756 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
33757 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
33758 another MTA:
33759 .code
33760 userforward:
33761 driver = redirect
33762 check_local_user
33763 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
33764 local_part_suffix = -*
33765 local_part_suffix_optional
33766 allow_filter
33767 .endd
33768 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
33769 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
33770 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
33771 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
33772 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
33773
33774
33775
33776 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
33777 .cindex "vacation processing"
33778 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
33779 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
33780 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
33781 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
33782 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
33783
33784 .ilist
33785 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
33786 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
33787 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
33788 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
33789 .code
33790 spqr, vacation-spqr
33791 .endd
33792 .next
33793 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
33794 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
33795 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
33796 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
33797 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
33798 message.
33799 .endlist
33800
33801 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
33802 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
33803
33804
33805
33806 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
33807 .cindex "message" "copying every"
33808 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
33809 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
33810 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
33811 each day's messages.
33812
33813 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
33814 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
33815 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
33816 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
33817
33818
33819
33820 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
33821 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
33822 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
33823 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
33824 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
33825 permanently connected.
33826
33827 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
33828 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
33829 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
33830
33831
33832 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
33833 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
33834 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
33835 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
33836 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
33837 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
33838 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
33839 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
33840
33841 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
33842 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
33843 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
33844 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
33845 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
33846 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
33847 if required.
33848
33849 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
33850 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
33851 intermittent host. For example:
33852 .code
33853 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
33854 .endd
33855 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
33856 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
33857 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
33858 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
33859 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
33860 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
33861 immediately.
33862
33863 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
33864 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
33865 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
33866 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
33867 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
33868 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
33869 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
33870
33871
33872
33873 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
33874 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
33875 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
33876 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
33877 delivered immediately.
33878
33879 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33880 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
33881 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
33882 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
33883 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
33884 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
33885 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
33886 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
33887 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
33888 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
33889 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
33890 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
33891 single SMTP connection.
33892
33893
33894
33895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33896 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33897
33898 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
33899 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
33900 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
33901 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
33902 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
33903 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
33904 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
33905 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
33906 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
33907 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
33908 messages this way.
33909
33910 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
33911 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
33912 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
33913 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
33914 email is not desirable.
33915
33916 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
33917 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
33918 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
33919 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
33920 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
33921 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
33922 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
33923
33924 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
33925 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
33926 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
33927 before sending a message to the smart host.
33928
33929 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
33930 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
33931 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
33932
33933 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
33934 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
33935 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
33936 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
33937 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
33938 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
33939 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
33940
33941 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
33942 following ways:
33943
33944 .ilist
33945 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
33946 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
33947 .next
33948 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
33949 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
33950 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
33951 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
33952 successful, a zero return code is given.
33953 .next
33954 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
33955 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
33956 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
33957 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
33958 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
33959 are.
33960 .next
33961 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
33962 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
33963 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
33964 .next
33965 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
33966 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
33967 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
33968 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
33969 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
33970 .next
33971 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
33972 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
33973 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
33974 .next
33975 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
33976 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
33977 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
33978 are ever generated.
33979 .next
33980 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
33981 .next
33982 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
33983 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
33984 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
33985 .endlist
33986
33987 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
33988 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
33989 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
33990 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
33991 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
33992 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
33993
33994
33995
33996
33997 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33998 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33999
34000 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34001 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34002 .cindex "log" "types of"
34003 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34004 and the panic log:
34005
34006 .ilist
34007 .cindex "main log"
34008 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34009 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34010 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34011 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34012 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34013 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34014 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34015 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34016 .next
34017 .cindex "reject log"
34018 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34019 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34020 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34021 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34022 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34023 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34024 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34025 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34026 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34027 false.
34028 .next
34029 .cindex "panic log"
34030 .cindex "system log"
34031 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34032 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34033 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34034 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34035 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34036 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34037 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34038 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34039 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34040 .endlist
34041
34042 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34043 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34044 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34045 .code
34046 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34047 by QUIT
34048 .endd
34049 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34050 ways of changing this:
34051
34052 .ilist
34053 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34054 you set
34055 .code
34056 timezone = UTC
34057 .endd
34058 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34059 .next
34060 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34061 example:
34062 .code
34063 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34064 .endd
34065 .endlist
34066
34067 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34068 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34069 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34070 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34071 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34072 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34073
34074
34075
34076
34077 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34078 .cindex "log" "destination"
34079 .cindex "log" "to file"
34080 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34081 .cindex "syslog"
34082 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34083 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34084 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34085 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34086 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34087 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34088 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34089
34090 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34091 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34092 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34093 references to the host name:
34094 .code
34095 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34096 .endd
34097 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34098 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34099 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34100 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34101 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34102 log at all.
34103
34104 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34105 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34106 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34107 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34108 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34109 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34110 implying the use of a default path.
34111
34112 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34113 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34114 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34115 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34116 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34117 equivalent to the setting:
34118 .code
34119 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34120 .endd
34121 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
34122 logs are written.
34123
34124 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34125 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34126
34127 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34128 .display
34129 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34130 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34131 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34132 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34133 .endd
34134 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34135 error is logged.
34136
34137
34138
34139 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34140 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34141 .cindex "cycling logs"
34142 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34143 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34144 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34145 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34146 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34147 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34148 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34149
34150 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34151 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34152 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34153 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34154 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34155 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34156 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34157 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34158 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34159 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34160 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34161 renamed.
34162
34163
34164
34165 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34166 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34167 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34168 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34169 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34170 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34171 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34172 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34173 .code
34174 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34175 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34176 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34177 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34178 .endd
34179 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34180 examples of names generated by the above examples:
34181 .code
34182 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34183 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34184 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34185 /var/log/exim/main.200212
34186 .endd
34187 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
34188 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
34189 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
34190 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
34191
34192 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
34193 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
34194 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
34195 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
34196 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
34197 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
34198 log names:
34199 .code
34200 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34201 /var/log/exim-panic.log
34202 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34203 /var/log/exim/panic
34204 .endd
34205
34206
34207 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
34208 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
34209 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
34210 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
34211 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
34212 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
34213 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
34214 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
34215 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
34216 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
34217 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
34218 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
34219 the time and host name to each line.
34220 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
34221
34222 .ilist
34223 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
34224 .next
34225 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
34226 .next
34227 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
34228 .endlist
34229
34230 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
34231 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
34232 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
34233 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
34234
34235 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
34236 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
34237 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
34238 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
34239 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
34240 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
34241 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
34242 RFC 3164, you should set
34243 .code
34244 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
34245 .endd
34246 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
34247 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
34248
34249 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
34250 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
34251 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
34252 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
34253 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
34254 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
34255 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
34256 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
34257 name, and pid as added by syslog:
34258 .code
34259 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
34260 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
34261 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
34262 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
34263 [5/5] mple>)
34264 .endd
34265 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
34266 (LOG_NOTICE):
34267 .code
34268 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
34269 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
34270 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
34271 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
34272 [5\18] .example>)
34273 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
34274 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
34275 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
34276 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
34277 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
34278 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
34279 [12\18] F From: <>
34280 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
34281 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
34282 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
34283 [16\18] le>
34284 [17\18] B Bcc:
34285 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
34286 .endd
34287 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
34288 without modification.
34289
34290 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
34291 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
34292 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
34293 where it is.
34294
34295
34296
34297 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
34298 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
34299 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
34300 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
34301 timestamp. The flags are:
34302 .display
34303 &`<=`& message arrival
34304 &`=>`& normal message delivery
34305 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
34306 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
34307 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
34308 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
34309 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
34310 .endd
34311
34312
34313 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
34314 .cindex "log" "reception line"
34315 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
34316 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
34317 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
34318 .code
34319 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
34320 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
34321 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
34322 .endd
34323 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
34324 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
34325 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
34326 .code
34327 R=<message id>
34328 .endd
34329 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
34330
34331 .cindex "HELO"
34332 .cindex "EHLO"
34333 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
34334 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
34335 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
34336 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
34337 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
34338 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
34339 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
34340 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
34341 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
34342 name in parentheses.
34343
34344 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
34345 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
34346 the log containing text like these examples:
34347 .code
34348 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
34349 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
34350 .endd
34351 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
34352 on.
34353
34354 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
34355 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
34356 of Exim.
34357
34358 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
34359 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
34360 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
34361 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
34362 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
34363 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
34364 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
34365 suite that was used.
34366
34367 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
34368 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
34369 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
34370 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
34371 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
34372 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
34373 authenticator name.
34374
34375 .cindex "size" "of message"
34376 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
34377 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
34378 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
34379 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
34380 other).
34381
34382 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
34383 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
34384
34385
34386
34387 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
34388 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
34389 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
34390 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
34391 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
34392 to fit it on the page:
34393 .code
34394 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
34395 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
34396 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
34397 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
34398 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
34399 .endd
34400 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
34401 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
34402 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
34403 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
34404 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
34405
34406 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
34407 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
34408 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
34409 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
34410
34411 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
34412 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
34413 .display
34414 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
34415 .endd
34416 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
34417 parentheses afterwards.
34418
34419 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34420 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
34421 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
34422 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
34423 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
34424 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
34425
34426 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
34427 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
34428 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
34429 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
34430 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
34431
34432 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
34433 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
34434
34435 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
34436 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
34437
34438
34439 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
34440 .cindex "discarded messages"
34441 .cindex "message" "discarded"
34442 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
34443 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
34444 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
34445 .code
34446 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
34447 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
34448 .endd
34449 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
34450 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
34451 .code
34452 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
34453 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
34454 .endd
34455
34456
34457 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
34458 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
34459 .code
34460 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
34461 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
34462 .endd
34463 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
34464 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
34465 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
34466 .code
34467 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
34468 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
34469 .endd
34470 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
34471 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
34472 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
34473
34474
34475
34476 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
34477 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
34478 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
34479 following form is logged:
34480 .code
34481 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
34482 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
34483 .endd
34484 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
34485 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
34486 .code
34487 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
34488 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
34489 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
34490 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
34491 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
34492 .endd
34493 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
34494 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
34495 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
34496 flagged with &`**`&.
34497
34498
34499
34500 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
34501 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
34502 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
34503 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
34504 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
34505
34506
34507
34508 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
34509 A line of the form
34510 .code
34511 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
34512 .endd
34513 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
34514 at the end of its processing.
34515
34516
34517
34518
34519 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
34520 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
34521 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
34522 the following table:
34523 .display
34524 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
34525 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
34526 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34527 &`CV `& certificate verification status
34528 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34529 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
34530 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
34531 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
34532 &`H `& host name and IP address
34533 &`I `& local interface used
34534 &`id `& message id for incoming message
34535 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
34536 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
34537 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
34538 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
34539 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
34540 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
34541 &`S `& size of message
34542 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
34543 &`ST `& shadow transport name
34544 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
34545 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
34546 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
34547 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
34548 .endd
34549
34550
34551 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
34552 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
34553 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
34554
34555 .ilist
34556 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
34557 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
34558 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
34559 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
34560 during the first delivery attempt.
34561 .next
34562 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
34563 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
34564 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
34565 .next
34566 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
34567 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
34568 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
34569 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
34570 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
34571 doing.
34572 .next
34573 .cindex "error" "ignored"
34574 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
34575 message:
34576 .olist
34577 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
34578 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
34579 .next
34580 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
34581 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34582 .next
34583 A delivery set up by a router configured with
34584 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
34585 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
34586 .code
34587 errors_to = <>
34588 .endd
34589 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34590 .endlist olist
34591 .endlist ilist
34592
34593
34594
34595
34596
34597 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
34598 .cindex "log" "selectors"
34599 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
34600 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
34601 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
34602 example:
34603 .code
34604 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
34605 .endd
34606 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
34607 selection marked by asterisks:
34608 .display
34609 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
34610 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
34611 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
34612 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
34613 &` arguments `& command line arguments
34614 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
34615 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
34616 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
34617 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
34618 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
34619 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
34620 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
34621 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
34622 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
34623 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
34624 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
34625 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
34626 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
34627 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
34628 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
34629 &` pid `& Exim process id
34630 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
34631 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
34632 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
34633 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
34634 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
34635 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
34636 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
34637 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
34638 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
34639 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
34640 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
34641 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
34642 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
34643 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
34644 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
34645 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
34646 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
34647 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
34648 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
34649 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
34650 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
34651 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
34652
34653 &` all `& all of the above
34654 .endd
34655 More details on each of these items follows:
34656
34657 .ilist
34658 .cindex "8BITMIME"
34659 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
34660 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
34661 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
34662 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
34663 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
34664 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
34665 .next
34666 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
34667 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
34668 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
34669 this log selector is set.
34670 .next
34671 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
34672 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
34673 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
34674 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
34675 such users cannot access the log).
34676 .next
34677 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
34678 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
34679 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
34680 parentheses between them.
34681 .next
34682 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
34683 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
34684 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
34685 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
34686 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
34687 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
34688 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
34689 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
34690 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
34691 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
34692 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
34693 between the caller and Exim.
34694 .next
34695 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
34696 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
34697 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
34698 .next
34699 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
34700 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
34701 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
34702 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
34703 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
34704 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
34705 .next
34706 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
34707 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
34708 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
34709 .next
34710 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
34711 .cindex "size" "of message"
34712 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
34713 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
34714 .next
34715 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
34716 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
34717 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
34718 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
34719 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
34720 .next
34721 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
34722 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
34723 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
34724 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
34725 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
34726 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
34727 .next
34728 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
34729 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
34730 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
34731 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
34732 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
34733 .next
34734 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
34735 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
34736 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
34737 client's ident port times out.
34738 .next
34739 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
34740 .cindex "interface" "logging"
34741 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
34742 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
34743 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
34744 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
34745 rejection lines.
34746 .next
34747 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
34748 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
34749 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
34750 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
34751 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
34752 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
34753 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
34754 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
34755 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
34756 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
34757 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
34758 .next
34759 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
34760 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
34761 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
34762 .next
34763 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
34764 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
34765 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
34766 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
34767 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
34768 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
34769 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
34770 .next
34771 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34772 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34773 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
34774 immediately after the time and date.
34775 .next
34776 .cindex "log" "queue run"
34777 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
34778 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
34779 .next
34780 .cindex "log" "queue time"
34781 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
34782 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
34783 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
34784 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
34785 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
34786 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
34787 message has been successfully received.
34788 .next
34789 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
34790 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
34791 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
34792 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
34793 .next
34794 .cindex "log" "recipients"
34795 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
34796 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
34797 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
34798 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
34799 has taken place.
34800 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
34801 in the list.
34802 .next
34803 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
34804 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
34805 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
34806 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
34807 .next
34808 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
34809 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
34810 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
34811 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
34812 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
34813 .next
34814 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
34815 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
34816 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
34817 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
34818 attempt.
34819 .next
34820 .cindex "log" "return path"
34821 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
34822 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
34823 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
34824 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
34825 .next
34826 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
34827 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
34828 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
34829 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
34830 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
34831 .next
34832 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
34833 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
34834 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
34835 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
34836 detail is lost.
34837 .next
34838 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
34839 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
34840 it is too big.
34841 .next
34842 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
34843 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
34844 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
34845 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
34846 it.
34847 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
34848 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
34849 .next
34850 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
34851 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
34852 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
34853 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
34854 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
34855 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
34856 response.
34857 .next
34858 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
34859 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
34860 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
34861 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
34862 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
34863 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
34864 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
34865 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
34866 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
34867 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
34868
34869 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
34870 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
34871 reset if the daemon is restarted.
34872 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
34873 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
34874 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
34875 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
34876 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
34877 .next
34878 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
34879 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
34880 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
34881 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
34882 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
34883 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
34884 .next
34885 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
34886 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
34887 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
34888 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
34889 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
34890 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
34891 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
34892 already have their own log lines.
34893
34894 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
34895 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
34896 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
34897 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
34898 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
34899 the same logging options.
34900
34901 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
34902 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
34903 .code
34904 C=EHLO,QUIT
34905 .endd
34906 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
34907 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
34908 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
34909 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
34910 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
34911 .next
34912 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
34913 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
34914 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
34915 was accepted or used.
34916 .next
34917 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
34918 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
34919 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
34920 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
34921 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
34922 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
34923 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
34924 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
34925 .next
34926 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
34927 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
34928 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
34929 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
34930 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
34931 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
34932 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
34933 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
34934 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
34935 .next
34936 .cindex "log" "subject"
34937 .cindex "subject, logging"
34938 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
34939 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
34940 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
34941 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
34942 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
34943 .next
34944 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
34945 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
34946 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
34947 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
34948 .next
34949 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
34950 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
34951 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34952 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
34953 .next
34954 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
34955 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
34956 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34957 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
34958 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
34959 .next
34960 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
34961 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
34962 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
34963 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
34964 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
34965 .next
34966 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
34967 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
34968 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
34969 .endlist
34970
34971
34972 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
34973 .cindex "message" "log file for"
34974 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
34975 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
34976 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
34977 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
34978 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
34979 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
34980 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
34981 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
34982 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
34983 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
34984 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
34985
34986 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
34987 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
34988 &%message_logs%& option false.
34989 .ecindex IIDloggen
34990
34991
34992
34993
34994 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34995 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34996
34997 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
34998 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
34999 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35000 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35001 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35002
35003 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35004 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35005 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35006 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35007 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35008 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35009 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35010 various criteria"
35011 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35012 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35013 "extract statistics from the log"
35014 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35015 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35016 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35017 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35018 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35019 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35020 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35021 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35022 .endtable
35023
35024 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35025 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35026 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35027
35028
35029
35030
35031 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35032 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35033 .cindex "process, querying"
35034 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
35035 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35036 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35037 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35038 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35039 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35040 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35041 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35042 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35043
35044 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35045 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35046 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35047
35048
35049 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35050 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35051 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35052 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35053 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35054 options:
35055 .display
35056 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35057 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35058 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35059 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35060 .endd
35061 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35062 .code
35063 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35064 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35065 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35066 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35067 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35068 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35069 .endd
35070 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35071 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35072
35073
35074
35075 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35076 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35077 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35078 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35079 .code
35080 exim -bpu
35081 .endd
35082 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35083 .code
35084 exim -bp
35085 .endd
35086 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35087 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35088
35089 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35090 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35091
35092 .vlist
35093 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35094 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35095 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35096 .code
35097 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35098 .endd
35099 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35100 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
35101 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35102
35103 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35104 Match against the size field.
35105
35106 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35107 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35108
35109 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35110 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35111
35112 .vitem &*-z*&
35113 Match only frozen messages.
35114
35115 .vitem &*-x*&
35116 Match only non-frozen messages.
35117 .endlist
35118
35119 The following options control the format of the output:
35120
35121 .vlist
35122 .vitem &*-c*&
35123 Display only the count of matching messages.
35124
35125 .vitem &*-l*&
35126 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35127 the default.
35128
35129 .vitem &*-i*&
35130 Display message ids only.
35131
35132 .vitem &*-b*&
35133 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35134
35135 .vitem &*-R*&
35136 Display messages in reverse order.
35137
35138 .vitem &*-a*&
35139 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35140 .endlist
35141
35142 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35143
35144
35145
35146 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35147 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35148 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35149 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35150 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35151 running a command such as
35152 .code
35153 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35154 .endd
35155 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35156 it, as in the following example:
35157 .code
35158 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35159 .endd
35160 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35161 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35162 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35163 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35164
35165 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
35166 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
35167 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
35168 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
35169 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
35170 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
35171 sender.
35172
35173 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
35174 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
35175 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
35176 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
35177 level"& addresses).
35178
35179
35180
35181
35182 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
35183 "SECTextspeinf"
35184 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
35185 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
35186 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
35187 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
35188 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
35189 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
35190 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
35191 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
35192 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
35193 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
35194 .display
35195 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
35196 .endd
35197 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
35198
35199 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
35200 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
35201 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
35202
35203 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
35204 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
35205 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
35206 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
35207 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
35208
35209 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
35210 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
35211 regular expression.
35212
35213 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
35214 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
35215
35216 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
35217 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
35218 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
35219
35220
35221 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
35222 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
35223 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
35224 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
35225 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
35226 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
35227 the &%--help%& option.
35228
35229
35230 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
35231 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35232 .cindex "cycling logs"
35233 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35234 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
35235 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
35236 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
35237 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
35238 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
35239 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
35240 .ilist
35241 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
35242 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
35243 .next
35244 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
35245 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
35246 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
35247 configuration.
35248 .endlist
35249
35250 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
35251 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
35252 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
35253 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
35254 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
35255 logs are handled similarly.
35256
35257 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
35258 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
35259 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
35260 any existing log files.
35261
35262 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
35263 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
35264 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
35265 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
35266 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
35267 .code
35268 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
35269 .endd
35270 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
35271 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
35272
35273
35274
35275 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
35276 .cindex "statistics"
35277 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
35278 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
35279 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
35280 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
35281 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
35282
35283 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
35284 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
35285 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
35286 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
35287 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
35288 .code
35289 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
35290 .endd
35291 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
35292 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
35293 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
35294 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
35295 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
35296 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
35297 also produced per user.
35298
35299 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
35300 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
35301 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
35302 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
35303 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
35304
35305 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
35306 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
35307 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
35308 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
35309 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
35310 an entirely separate message.
35311
35312 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
35313 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
35314 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
35315 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
35316 least one address that failed.
35317
35318 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
35319 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
35320 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
35321 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
35322 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
35323 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
35324 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
35325
35326 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
35327 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
35328 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
35329
35330 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
35331 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
35332 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
35333 .code
35334 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
35335 .endd
35336
35337 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
35338 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
35339 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
35340 .cindex "checking access"
35341 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
35342 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
35343 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
35344 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
35345 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
35346 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
35347
35348 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
35349 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
35350 .code
35351 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
35352 .endd
35353 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
35354 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
35355 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
35356 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
35357 .code
35358 Rejected:
35359 550 Relay not permitted
35360 .endd
35361 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
35362 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
35363 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
35364 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
35365 you can use:
35366 .code
35367 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
35368 -f himself@there.example
35369 .endd
35370 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
35371 mandatory arguments.
35372
35373 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
35374 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
35375 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
35376
35377
35378
35379 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
35380 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
35381 .cindex "building DBM files"
35382 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
35383 .cindex "lower casing"
35384 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
35385 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
35386 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
35387 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
35388 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
35389 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
35390
35391 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
35392 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
35393 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
35394 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
35395 files.
35396
35397 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
35398 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
35399 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
35400 well.
35401
35402 .cindex "USE_DB"
35403 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
35404 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
35405 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
35406 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
35407 .code
35408 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
35409 .endd
35410 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
35411 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
35412
35413 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
35414 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
35415 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
35416 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
35417 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
35418 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
35419
35420 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
35421 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
35422 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
35423 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
35424 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
35425 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
35426 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
35427 return code is 2.
35428
35429
35430
35431
35432 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
35433 .cindex "retry" "times"
35434 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
35435 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
35436 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
35437 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
35438 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
35439 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
35440 output. For example:
35441 .code
35442 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
35443 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
35444 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35445 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35446 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
35447 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
35448 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
35449 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
35450 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
35451 past final cutoff time
35452 .endd
35453 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
35454 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
35455 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
35456 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
35457 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
35458 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
35459 run very often.
35460
35461 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
35462 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
35463 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
35464 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
35465 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
35466 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
35467
35468
35469
35470 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
35471 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
35472 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
35473 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
35474 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
35475 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
35476 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
35477
35478 .ilist
35479 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
35480 .next
35481 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
35482 for remote hosts
35483 .next
35484 &'callout'&: the callout cache
35485 .next
35486 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
35487 .next
35488 &'misc'&: other hints data
35489 .endlist
35490
35491 The &'misc'& database is used for
35492
35493 .ilist
35494 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
35495 .next
35496 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
35497 &(smtp)& transport)
35498 .endlist
35499
35500
35501
35502 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
35503 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
35504 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
35505 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
35506 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
35507 .code
35508 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
35509 .endd
35510 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
35511 .code
35512 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
35513 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
35514 .endd
35515 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
35516 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
35517 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
35518 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
35519 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
35520 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
35521 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
35522 and a textual description of the error.
35523
35524 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
35525 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
35526 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
35527 exceeded.
35528
35529 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
35530 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
35531 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
35532 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
35533 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
35534 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
35535 cross-references.
35536
35537
35538
35539 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
35540 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
35541 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
35542 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
35543 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
35544 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
35545 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
35546 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
35547 updated sufficiently often.
35548
35549 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
35550 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
35551 the retry database:
35552 .code
35553 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
35554 .endd
35555 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
35556 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
35557 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
35558 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
35559 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
35560 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
35561 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
35562 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
35563 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
35564 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
35565 whenever it removes information from the database.
35566
35567 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
35568 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
35569 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
35570 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
35571 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
35572
35573 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
35574 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
35575 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
35576 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
35577 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
35578 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
35579 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
35580 tidied.
35581
35582 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
35583 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
35584
35585
35586
35587
35588 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
35589 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
35590 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
35591 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
35592 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
35593 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
35594 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
35595 displayed.
35596
35597 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
35598 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
35599 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
35600 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
35601 by new data, for example:
35602 .code
35603 > 4 951102:1000
35604 .endd
35605 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
35606 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
35607 used as optional separators.
35608
35609
35610
35611
35612 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
35613 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
35614 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
35615 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
35616 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
35617 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
35618 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
35619 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
35620 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
35621 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
35622 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
35623 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
35624 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
35625
35626 .vlist
35627 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
35628 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
35629
35630 .vitem &%-flock%&
35631 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
35632 supports it.
35633
35634 .vitem &%-interval%&
35635 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
35636 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
35637
35638 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
35639 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
35640
35641 .vitem &%-mbx%&
35642 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
35643
35644 .vitem &%-q%&
35645 Suppress verification output.
35646
35647 .vitem &%-retries%&
35648 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
35649 the lock (default 10).
35650
35651 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
35652 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
35653 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
35654 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
35655 subsequently sees.
35656
35657 .vitem &%-timeout%&
35658 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
35659 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
35660 default), a non-blocking call is used.
35661
35662 .vitem &%-v%&
35663 Generate verbose output.
35664 .endlist
35665
35666 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
35667 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
35668 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
35669 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
35670 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
35671 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
35672 more than 30 minutes old.
35673
35674 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
35675 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
35676 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
35677 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
35678 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
35679 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
35680
35681 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
35682 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
35683 suppresses all output except error messages.
35684
35685 A command such as
35686 .code
35687 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
35688 .endd
35689 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
35690 .display
35691 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
35692 <&'some commands'&>
35693 &`End`&
35694 .endd
35695 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
35696 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
35697 such as
35698 .code
35699 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
35700 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
35701 .endd
35702 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
35703 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
35704 .ecindex IIDutils
35705
35706
35707 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35708 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35709
35710 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
35711 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
35712 .cindex "X-windows"
35713 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
35714 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
35715 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
35716 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
35717 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
35718 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
35719 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
35720 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
35721
35722
35723
35724 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
35725 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
35726 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
35727 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
35728 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
35729 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
35730 parameters are for.
35731
35732 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
35733 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
35734 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
35735 .code
35736 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
35737 .endd
35738 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
35739 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
35740 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
35741 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
35742 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
35743
35744 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
35745 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
35746 .code
35747 Eximon*background: gray94
35748 .endd
35749 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
35750 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
35751 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
35752 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
35753 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
35754 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
35755 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
35756 .code
35757 xrdb -merge <<End
35758 Eximon*highlight: gray
35759 End
35760 .endd
35761 .cindex "admin user"
35762 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
35763 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
35764
35765 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
35766 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
35767 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
35768 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
35769 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
35770
35771 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
35772 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
35773 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
35774 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
35775 different parts of the display.
35776
35777
35778
35779
35780 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
35781 .cindex "stripchart"
35782 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
35783 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35784 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
35785 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
35786 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
35787 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
35788 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
35789 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
35790 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35791
35792 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
35793 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
35794 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
35795 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
35796
35797 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
35798 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
35799 to a single partition.
35800
35801 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
35802 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
35803 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
35804 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
35805 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
35806 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35807 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35808
35809
35810
35811
35812 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
35813 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
35814 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
35815 .cindex "window size"
35816 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
35817 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
35818 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
35819 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
35820 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
35821 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
35822
35823 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
35824 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
35825 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
35826 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
35827
35828 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
35829 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
35830 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
35831 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
35832 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
35833 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35834
35835 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
35836 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
35837 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35838
35839
35840
35841 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
35842 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
35843 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
35844 the main log is maintained.
35845 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
35846 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
35847 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
35848 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
35849 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
35850
35851 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
35852 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
35853 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
35854 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
35855 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
35856 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
35857 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
35858 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
35859 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
35860 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
35861 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35862
35863 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
35864 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
35865 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
35866 It cannot go further back up the log.
35867
35868 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
35869 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
35870 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
35871 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
35872 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
35873 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
35874
35875 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
35876 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
35877 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
35878 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
35879 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
35880 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
35881
35882 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
35883 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
35884 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
35885 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
35886 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
35887 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
35888 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
35889 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
35890 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
35891 window.
35892
35893
35894
35895 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
35896 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
35897 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
35898 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
35899 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
35900 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
35901 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
35902 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
35903 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
35904 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
35905
35906 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
35907 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
35908 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
35909 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
35910 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
35911 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
35912 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
35913
35914 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
35915 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
35916 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
35917 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
35918 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
35919 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
35920 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
35921
35922 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
35923 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
35924 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
35925 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
35926
35927 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
35928 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
35929 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
35930 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
35931 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
35932 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
35933 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
35934 not shown.
35935
35936 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
35937 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
35938
35939 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
35940 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
35941 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
35942 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
35943 display is updated.
35944
35945
35946
35947 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
35948 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
35949 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
35950 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
35951 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
35952 any selected text.
35953
35954 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
35955 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
35956 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
35957 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
35958 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
35959 .code
35960 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
35961 .endd
35962 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
35963 follows:
35964
35965 .ilist
35966 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
35967 in a new text window.
35968 .next
35969 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
35970 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
35971 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
35972 .next
35973 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
35974 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
35975 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
35976 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
35977 .next
35978 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
35979 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
35980 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
35981 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
35982 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
35983 .next
35984 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
35985 that the message be frozen.
35986 .next
35987 .cindex "thawing messages"
35988 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
35989 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
35990 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
35991 that the message be thawed.
35992 .next
35993 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
35994 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
35995 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
35996 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
35997 .next
35998 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
35999 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36000 message.
36001 .next
36002 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36003 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36004 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36005 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36006 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36007 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36008 which case no action is taken.
36009 .next
36010 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36011 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36012 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36013 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36014 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36015 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36016 case no action is taken.
36017 .next
36018 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36019 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36020 .next
36021 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36022 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36023 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36024 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36025 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36026 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36027 the address is qualified with that domain.
36028 .endlist
36029
36030 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36031 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36032 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36033 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36034 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36035 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36036 if no output is generated.
36037
36038 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36039 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36040 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36041 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36042
36043 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36044 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36045 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36046 .ecindex IIDeximon
36047
36048
36049
36050
36051
36052 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36053 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36054
36055 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36056 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36057 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36058 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36059
36060 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36061 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36062 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36063 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36064 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36065 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36066
36067 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36068 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36069 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36070 as soon as possible.
36071
36072
36073 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36074 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36075 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36076 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36077 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36078 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36079
36080 .ilist
36081 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36082 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36083 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36084 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36085 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36086 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36087
36088 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36089 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36090 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36091 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36092 .next
36093
36094 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36095 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36096 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36097 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36098 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36099 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36100 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36101 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36102 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36103 separate commands.
36104
36105 .next
36106 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36107 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36108 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36109 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36110 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36111 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36112 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36113 .next
36114 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36115 is disabled.
36116 .next
36117 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36118 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36119 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36120 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36121 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36122 .endlist
36123
36124
36125
36126 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36127 .cindex "setuid"
36128 .cindex "root privilege"
36129 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36130 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36131 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36132 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36133 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36134 is required for two things:
36135
36136 .ilist
36137 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36138 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36139 not required.
36140 .next
36141 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36142 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36143 configuration.
36144 .endlist
36145
36146 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36147 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36148 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
36149 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
36150 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
36151 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
36152 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
36153 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
36154
36155 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
36156 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
36157 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
36158
36159 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
36160 uid and gid in the following cases:
36161
36162 .ilist
36163 .oindex "&%-C%&"
36164 .oindex "&%-D%&"
36165 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
36166 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
36167 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
36168 the calling process.
36169 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
36170 option may not be used at all.
36171 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
36172 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
36173 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
36174 .next
36175 .oindex "&%-be%&"
36176 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
36177 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
36178 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
36179 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
36180 calling process.
36181 .next
36182 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
36183 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
36184 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
36185 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
36186 testing address verification
36187 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
36188 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
36189 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
36190 option).
36191 .next
36192 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
36193 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
36194 .endlist
36195
36196 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
36197
36198 .ilist
36199 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
36200 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
36201 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
36202 will be used during message reception.
36203 .next
36204 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
36205 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
36206 .next
36207 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
36208 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
36209 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
36210 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
36211 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
36212 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
36213 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
36214 generating bounce and warning messages.
36215
36216 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
36217 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
36218 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
36219 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
36220 .next
36221 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
36222 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
36223 .endlist
36224
36225
36226
36227
36228 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
36229 .cindex "privilege, running without"
36230 .cindex "unprivileged running"
36231 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
36232 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
36233 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
36234 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
36235 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
36236 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
36237 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
36238 to any other uid.
36239
36240 .cindex SIGHUP
36241 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
36242 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
36243 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
36244 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
36245
36246 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
36247 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
36248 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
36249 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
36250 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
36251
36252 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
36253 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
36254 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
36255 effect.
36256
36257 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
36258 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
36259 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
36260
36261 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
36262 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
36263 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
36264 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
36265 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
36266 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
36267 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
36268 address this problem at this time.
36269
36270 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
36271 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
36272 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
36273 be used in the most straightforward way.
36274
36275 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
36276 number of restrictions on what you can do:
36277
36278 .ilist
36279 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
36280 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
36281 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
36282 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
36283 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
36284 .next
36285 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
36286 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
36287 .next
36288 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
36289 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
36290 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
36291 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
36292 .next
36293 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
36294 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
36295
36296 .olist
36297 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
36298 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
36299 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
36300 .next
36301 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
36302 owned by the Exim user.
36303 .next
36304 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
36305 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
36306 mailboxes need to be created manually.
36307 .endlist olist
36308 .endlist ilist
36309
36310
36311 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
36312 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
36313 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
36314 gives more security at essentially no cost.
36315
36316 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
36317 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
36318
36319
36320
36321
36322 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
36323 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
36324 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
36325
36326
36327
36328 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
36329 .cindex "security" "local commands"
36330 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
36331 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
36332 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
36333 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
36334 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
36335
36336 .ilist
36337 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
36338 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
36339 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
36340 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
36341 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
36342 .next
36343 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
36344 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
36345 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
36346 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
36347 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
36348 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
36349 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
36350 .next
36351 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
36352 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
36353 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
36354 .next
36355 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
36356 taint checking might apply to their usage.
36357 .next
36358 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
36359 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
36360 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
36361 .next
36362 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
36363 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
36364 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
36365 of opaque strings.
36366 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
36367 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
36368 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
36369 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
36370 .endlist
36371
36372
36373
36374
36375 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
36376 .cindex "security" "data sources"
36377 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
36378 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
36379 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
36380 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
36381 are some issues to be aware of:
36382
36383 .ilist
36384 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
36385 .next
36386 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
36387 .next
36388 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
36389 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
36390 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
36391 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
36392 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
36393 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
36394 data.
36395 .next
36396 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
36397 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
36398 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
36399 .next
36400 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
36401 expected to yield one result.
36402 .endlist
36403
36404
36405
36406
36407 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
36408 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
36409 .cindex "IP source routing"
36410 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
36411 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
36412 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
36413 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
36414
36415
36416
36417 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
36418 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
36419 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
36420
36421
36422
36423
36424 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
36425 .cindex "trusted users"
36426 .cindex "admin user"
36427 .cindex "privileged user"
36428 .cindex "user" "trusted"
36429 .cindex "user" "admin"
36430 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
36431 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
36432 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
36433 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
36434 permit a remote host to be specified.
36435
36436 .oindex "&%-f%&"
36437 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
36438 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
36439 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
36440 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
36441 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
36442 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
36443
36444 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
36445 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
36446 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
36447 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
36448 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
36449
36450 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
36451 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
36452 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
36453 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
36454 includes the contents of files on the spool.
36455
36456 .oindex "&%-M%&"
36457 .oindex "&%-q%&"
36458 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
36459 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
36460 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
36461 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
36462 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
36463 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
36464
36465 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
36466 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
36467 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
36468 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
36469 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
36470 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
36471 files.
36472
36473
36474
36475 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
36476 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
36477 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
36478 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
36479 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
36480 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
36481
36482
36483
36484 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
36485 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
36486 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
36487 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
36488 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
36489 this.
36490
36491
36492
36493 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
36494 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
36495 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
36496 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
36497 converted output.
36498
36499
36500
36501 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
36502 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
36503 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
36504 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
36505 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
36506
36507
36508
36509 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
36510 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
36511 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
36512 loading it.
36513
36514
36515 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
36516 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
36517 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
36518 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
36519 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
36520 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
36521 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
36522
36523 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
36524 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
36525 string.
36526
36527
36528
36529 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
36530 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
36531 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
36532 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
36533
36534
36535
36536 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
36537 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
36538 enough to hold the result.
36539 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
36540
36541
36542
36543
36544 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36546
36547 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
36548 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
36549 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
36550 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
36551 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
36552 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
36553 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
36554 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
36555 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
36556 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
36557 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
36558 themselves are recoverable.
36559
36560 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
36561 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
36562 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
36563
36564 .ilist
36565 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
36566 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
36567 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
36568 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
36569 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
36570 .next
36571 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
36572 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
36573 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
36574 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
36575 will always be the case.
36576 .next
36577 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
36578 .next
36579 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
36580 signature.
36581 .endlist
36582 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
36583
36584 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
36585 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
36586 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
36587 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
36588 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
36589 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
36590 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
36591 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
36592 attempt.
36593
36594 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
36595 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
36596 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
36597 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
36598 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
36599 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
36600 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
36601 normally the Exim user.
36602
36603 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
36604 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
36605 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
36606 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
36607 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
36608 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
36609 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
36610 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
36611
36612 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
36613 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
36614 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
36615 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
36616
36617 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
36618 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
36619
36620 .vlist
36621 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36622 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
36623 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
36624 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
36625 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
36626 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
36627 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
36628 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
36629 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
36630 newlines.
36631
36632 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36633 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
36634 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
36635 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36636 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36637 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36638
36639 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36640 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
36641 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
36642 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36643 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36644 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36645
36646 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
36647 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
36648 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
36649
36650 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
36651 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
36652 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
36653 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
36654 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36655
36656 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
36657 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
36658 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
36659 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
36660 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36661
36662 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
36663 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
36664 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
36665
36666 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
36667 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
36668 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
36669
36670 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36671 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
36672 present.
36673
36674 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36675 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
36676 present if the number is greater than zero.
36677
36678 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
36679 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
36680 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
36681
36682 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
36683 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
36684 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
36685
36686 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36687 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
36688 command.
36689
36690 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36691 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
36692 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
36693 messages.
36694
36695 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
36696 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
36697 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
36698 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
36699
36700 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
36701 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
36702 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
36703
36704 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36705 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
36706 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
36707 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
36708 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
36709 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
36710
36711 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
36712 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
36713 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
36714 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
36715 supplied by the remote host, if any.
36716
36717 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36718 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
36719 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
36720 generated messages.
36721
36722 .vitem &%-local%&
36723 The message is from a local sender.
36724
36725 .vitem &%-localerror%&
36726 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
36727
36728 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
36729 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
36730 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
36731 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
36732
36733 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
36734 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
36735 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
36736
36737 .vitem &%-N%&
36738 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
36739 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
36740 &%-N%& is assumed.
36741
36742 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
36743 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
36744 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
36745
36746 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
36747 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
36748 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
36749
36750 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
36751 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
36752 of &$spam_score_int$&.
36753
36754 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
36755 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
36756 certificate was verified by the server.
36757
36758 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
36759 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
36760 name of the cipher suite that was used.
36761
36762 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
36763 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
36764 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
36765 certificate.
36766 .endlist
36767
36768 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
36769 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
36770 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
36771 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
36772 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
36773 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
36774 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
36775 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
36776 addresses are complete.
36777
36778 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
36779 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
36780 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
36781 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
36782 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
36783 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
36784 .code
36785 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
36786 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
36787 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36788 .endd
36789 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
36790 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
36791 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
36792 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
36793 example:
36794 .code
36795 4
36796 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36797 darcy@austen.fict.example
36798 rdo@foundation
36799 alice@wonderland.fict.example
36800 .endd
36801 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
36802 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
36803 line is of the following form:
36804 .display
36805 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
36806 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
36807 .endd
36808 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
36809 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
36810 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
36811 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
36812 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
36813 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
36814 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
36815 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
36816
36817
36818 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
36819 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
36820 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
36821 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
36822 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
36823 following:
36824
36825 .table2 50pt
36826 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
36827 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
36828 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
36829 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
36830 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
36831 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
36832 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
36833 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
36834 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
36835 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
36836 .endtable
36837
36838 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
36839 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
36840 typical set of headers:
36841 .code
36842 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
36843 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36844 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
36845 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
36846 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
36847 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
36848 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
36849 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36850 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
36851 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36852 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36853 .endd
36854 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
36855 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
36856 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
36857 .ecindex IIDforspo1
36858 .ecindex IIDforspo2
36859 .ecindex IIDforspo3
36860
36861 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36863
36864 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
36865 "DKIM Support"
36866 .cindex "DKIM"
36867
36868 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
36869 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
36870 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
36871 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
36872
36873 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
36874 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
36875
36876 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
36877 .olist
36878 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
36879 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
36880 (including transport filters)
36881 except cutthrough delivery.
36882 .next
36883 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
36884 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
36885 different signature contexts.
36886 .endlist
36887
36888 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
36889 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
36890 Exim's standard controls.
36891
36892 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
36893 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
36894 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
36895 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
36896 .code
36897 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
36898 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
36899 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
36900 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
36901 .endd
36902 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
36903 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
36904 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
36905 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
36906 senders).
36907
36908
36909 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
36910 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
36911
36912 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
36913 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
36914
36915 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
36916 MANDATORY:
36917 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
36918 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
36919
36920 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
36921 MANDATORY:
36922 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
36923 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
36924 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
36925 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
36926
36927 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
36928 MANDATORY:
36929 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
36930 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
36931 The result can either
36932 .ilist
36933 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
36934 .next
36935 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
36936 the private key.
36937 .next
36938 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
36939 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
36940 is set.
36941 .endlist
36942
36943 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
36944 OPTIONAL:
36945 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
36946 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
36947 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
36948 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
36949
36950 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
36951 OPTIONAL:
36952 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
36953 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
36954 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
36955 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
36956 variables here.
36957
36958 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
36959 OPTIONAL:
36960 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
36961 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
36962 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
36963 used.
36964
36965
36966 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
36967 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
36968
36969 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
36970 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
36971 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
36972 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
36973 If any ACL call does not acccept, the message is not accepted.
36974 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
36975 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
36976
36977 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
36978 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
36979 runtime of the ACL.
36980
36981 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
36982 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
36983 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
36984 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
36985
36986 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
36987 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
36988 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
36989 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
36990 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
36991 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
36992 it defaults as:
36993 .code
36994 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
36995 .endd
36996 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
36997 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
36998 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
36999 .code
37000 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37001 .endd
37002 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37003 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37004 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37005 .code
37006 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37007 .endd
37008
37009 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37010 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37011
37012
37013 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37014 available (from most to least important):
37015
37016
37017 .vlist
37018 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37019 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37020 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37021 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37022 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37023 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37024 .ilist
37025 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37026 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37027 .next
37028 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37029 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37030 .next
37031 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37032 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37033 .next
37034 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37035 .endlist
37036 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37037 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37038 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37039 .ilist
37040 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37041 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37042 .next
37043 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37044 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37045 .next
37046 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37047 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37048 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37049 .next
37050 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37051 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37052 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37053 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37054 .endlist
37055 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37056 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37057 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37058 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37059 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37060 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37061 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37062 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37063 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37064 The key record selector string.
37065 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37066 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37067 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37068 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37069 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37070 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37071 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37072 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37073 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37074 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37075 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37076 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37077 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37078 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37079 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37080 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37081 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37082 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37083 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37084 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37085 integer size comparisons against this value.
37086 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37087 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37088 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37089 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37090 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37091 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37092 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37093 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37094 in the key record.
37095 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37096 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37097 in the key record.
37098 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37099 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37100 .endlist
37101
37102 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37103
37104 .vlist
37105 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37106 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37107 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37108 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37109 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37110
37111 .code
37112 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37113 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37114 sender_domains = gmail.com
37115 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37116 dkim_status = none
37117 .endd
37118
37119 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37120 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37121 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37122 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37123
37124 .code
37125 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37126 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37127 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37128 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37129 .endd
37130
37131 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37132 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37133 for more information of what they mean.
37134 .endlist
37135
37136 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37138
37139 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37140 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37141 .cindex "adding drivers"
37142 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
37143 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37144 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37145 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37146
37147 .olist
37148 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
37149 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
37150 .next
37151 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
37152 .display
37153 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
37154 .endd
37155 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
37156 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
37157 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
37158 .next
37159 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
37160 .code
37161 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
37162 .endd
37163 .next
37164 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
37165 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
37166 .next
37167 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
37168 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
37169 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
37170 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
37171 simple form that most lookups have.
37172 .next
37173 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
37174 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
37175 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
37176 .next
37177 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
37178 &_src_&.
37179 .next
37180 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
37181 as for other drivers and lookups.
37182 .endlist
37183
37184 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
37185 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
37186 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
37187 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
37188 searched using a binary chop procedure.
37189
37190 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
37191 the interface that is expected.
37192
37193
37194
37195
37196 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37197 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37198
37199 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37200 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
37201 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
37202 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
37203 . processors.
37204 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37205
37206 .literal xml
37207 <?sdop
37208 format="newpage"
37209 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
37210 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
37211 ?>
37212 .literal off
37213
37214 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
37215 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
37216 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
37217
37218
37219 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37220 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////